THK Profilsin Vezetekek Katalogus ENG PDF
THK Profilsin Vezetekek Katalogus ENG PDF
THK Profilsin Vezetekek Katalogus ENG PDF
LM Guide
General Catalog
A1-1
506E
LM Guide
General Catalog
A Product Descriptions
Classification Table of the LM Guides ... A1-8 Models SSR-XV and SSR-XVM ........... A1-112
Model SSR-XTB .................................... A1-114
Point of Selection ................................ A1-10 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-116
Flowchart for Selecting an LM Guide .... A1-10 • Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model SSR .. A1-117
Setting Conditions ................................. A1-12
• Conditions of the LM Guide ................... A1-12 Caged Ball LM Guide Ultra-heavy Load Type for Machine Tools Model SVR/SVS ... A1-118
Selecting a Type .................................... A1-28 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-119
• Types of LM Guides ............................. A1-28 • Types and Features ............................. A1-121
Calculating the Applied Load ................. A1-40
• Calculating an Applied Load .................. A1-40 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Calculating the Equivalent Load ............ A1-57 Models SVR-R and SVR-LR.................. A1-124
• Rated Load of an LM Guide in Each Direction .. A1-57 Models SVS-R and SVS-LR .................. A1-126
Calculating the Static Safety Factor ...... A1-61 Models SVR-C and SVR-LC.................. A1-128
Calculating the Average Load................ A1-62 Models SVS-C and SVS-LC .................. A1-130
Calculating the Nominal Life .................. A1-64 Models SVR-RH (Build to Order), SVR-LRH (Build to Order),
• Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Balls .. A1-64 SVS-RH (Build to Order), and SVS-LRH (Build to Order) ..... A1-132
• Nominal Life Equation for the Oil-Free LM Guide .. A1-64 Models SVR-CH (Build to Order), SVR-LCH (Build to Order),
• Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Rollers .. A1-65 SVS-CH (Build to Order), and SVS-LCH (Build to Order).... A1-134
Predicting the Rigidity ............................ A1-68 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-136
• Selecting a Radial Clearance (Preload) ... A1-68
• Service Life with a Preload Considered ... A1-69 Caged Ball LM Guide Wide Rail Model SHW ... A1-138
• Rigidity ............................................... A1-69 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-139
• Radial Clearance Standard for Each Model .. A1-70 • Types and Features ............................. A1-140
Determining the Accuracy...................... A1-74
• Accuracy Standards ............................. A1-74 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Guidelines for Accuracy Grades by Machine Type .. A1-75 Model SHW-CA ..................................... A1-142
• Accuracy Standard for Each Model......... A1-76 Models SHW-CR and SHW-HR ............ A1-144
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-146
Features and Dimensions of Each Model .. A1-87 • Greasing Hole ..................................... A1-147
Structure and Features of the Caged Ball LM Guide .. A1-88
• Advantages of the Ball Cage Technology .. A1-89 Caged Ball LM Guide Miniature Type Model SRS.... A1-148
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-149
Caged Ball LM Guide Global Standard Size Model SHS ... A1-94 • Types and Features ............................. A1-150
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-95 • Flatness of the LM Rail and the LM Block Mounting Surface .. A1-152
• Types and Features ............................. A1-96
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table Models SRS5M, SRS5WM .................... A1-154
Models SHS-C and SHS-LC.................. A1-98 Models SRS-M and SRS-N ................... A1-156
Models SHS-V and SHS-LV .................. A1-100 Models SRS-WM and SRS-WN ............ A1-158
Models SHS-R and SHS-LR.................. A1-102 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-160
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-104 • Greasing Hole ..................................... A1-161
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model SHS .. A1-105
Caged Ball LM Guide Cross LM Guide Model SCR .. A1-162
Caged Ball LM Guide Radial Type Model SSR ... A1-106 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-163
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-107 • Types and Features ............................. A1-164
• Types and Features ............................. A1-108
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table Model SCR ............................................ A1-166
Models SSR-XW and SSR-XWM .......... A1-110
A1-2
506E
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-168 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model SCR .. A1-169 Models NR-R and NR-LR ...................... A1-226
Models NRS-R and NRS-LR ................. A1-228
Caged Ball LM Guide Finite stroke Model EPF ... A1-170 Models NR-A and NR-LA....................... A1-230
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-171 Models NRS-A and NRS-LA .................. A1-232
• Types and Features ............................. A1-172 Models NR-B and NR-LB ...................... A1-234
• Accuracy of the Mounting Surface .......... A1-173 Models NRS-B and NRS-LB.................. A1-236
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-238
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Model EPF ............................................. A1-174 LM Guide Wide Rail Model HRW ........ A1-240
• Standard Length of the LM Rail .............. A1-176 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-241
• Types and Features ............................. A1-242
LM Guide Global Standard Size Model HSR .... A1-178
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-179 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Types ................................................. A1-180 Models HRW-CA and HRW-CAM .......... A1-244
Models HRW-CR, HRW-CRM and HRW-LRM .. A1-246
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-248
Models HSR-A and HSR-AM, Models HSR-LA and HSR-LAM .. A1-184 • Stopper .............................................. A1-248
Models HSR-B, HSR-BM, HSR-LB and HSR-LBM .. A1-186
Model HSR-C Grade Ct ......................... A1-188 LM Guide Miniature Types Model RSR .. A1-250
Model HSR-RM ..................................... A1-190 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-251
Models HSR-R, HSR-RM, HSR-LR and HSR-LRM .. A1-192 • Types and Features ............................. A1-252
Model HSR-R Grade Ct ......................... A1-194 • Comparison of Model RSR-W with Other Model Numbers .. A1-254
Models HSR-YR and HSR-YRM ........... A1-196 • Accuracy of the Mounting Surface .......... A1-255
Models HSR-CA, HSR-CAM, HSR-HA and HSR-HAM... A1-198
Models HSR-CB, HSR-CBM, HSR-HB and HSR-HBM .. A1-200 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Models HSR-HA, HSR-HB and HSR-HR .. A1-202 Models RSR-M, RSR-N and RSR-TN .. A1-256
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-204 Models RSR-M, RSR-KM, RSR-VM and RSR-N .. A1-258
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model HSR .. A1-205 Models RSR-WM(WTM) and RSR-WN(WTN) .. A1-260
• Stopper .............................................. A1-206 Models RSR-WV, RSR-WVM and RSR-WN .. A1-262
• Greasing Hole ..................................... A1-206 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-264
• Stopper .............................................. A1-264
LM Guide Radial Type Model SR ........ A1-208
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-209 LM Guide Miniature Type (Low Cost Type) Model RSR-Z ... A1-266
• Types and Features ............................. A1-210 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-267
• Characteristics of Model SR .................. A1-212 • Types and Features ............................. A1-268
• Accuracy of the Mounting Surface .......... A1-269
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Models SR-W, SR-WM, SR-V and SR-VM .. A1-214 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Models SR-TB, SR-TBM, SR-SB and SR-SBM .. A1-216 Model RSR-ZM ...................................... A1-270
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-218 Model RSR-WZM .................................. A1-272
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model SR... A1-219 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-274
• Stopper .............................................. A1-274
LM Guide Ultra-heavy Load Type for Machine Tools Model NR/NRS ... A1-220
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-221 LM Guide Separate Type (4-way Equal Load) Model HR .... A1-276
• Types and Features ............................. A1-222 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-277
• Characteristics of Models NR and NRS ... A1-224 • Types and Features ............................. A1-278
• Example of Clearance Adjustment .......... A1-279
• Comparison of Model Numbers with Cross-roller Guides .. A1-280
A1-3
506E
LM Guide Separate Type (Radial) Model GSR ... A1-290 LM Guide R Guide Model HCR ........... A1-332
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-291 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-333
• Types and Features ............................. A1-292 • Types and Features ............................. A1-334
• Example of Clearance Adjustment .......... A1-293
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table R Guide Model HCR .............................. A1-336
Models GSR-T and GSR-V ................... A1-294
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-296 LM Guide Straight-Curved Guide Model HMG.... A1-338
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model GSR .. A1-296 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-339
• Types and Features ............................. A1-341
LM Guide Separate Type (Radial) Model GSR-R ... A1-298 • Examples of Table Mechanisms ............. A1-342
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-299
• Types and Features ............................. A1-300 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Model HMG ........................................... A1-344
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table • Jointed LM rail ..................................... A1-346
Model GSR-R ........................................ A1-302
• Standard Length of the LM Rail .............. A1-304 LM Guide Self-aligning Type Model NSR-TBC ... A1-348
• Rack and Pinion .................................. A1-305 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-349
• Rack and Pinion Dimensional Drawing .... A1-308 • Types and Features ............................. A1-349
LM Guide Cross LM Guide Model CSR .. A1-310 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-311 Model NSR-TBC .................................... A1-350
• Types and Features ............................. A1-312 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-352
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table LM Guide High Temperature Type Model HSR-M1 ... A1-354
Model CSR ............................................ A1-314 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-355
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-316 • Types and Features ............................. A1-357
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model CSR .. A1-317 • Service Life ......................................... A1-358
LM Guide Miniature Cross Guide Model MX .... A1-318 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-319 Models HSR-M1A and HSR-M1LA ........ A1-360
• Types and Features ............................. A1-319 Models HSR-M1B and HSR-M1LB........ A1-362
Models HSR-M1R and HSR-M1LR ....... A1-364
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table Model HSR-M1YR ................................. A1-366
Model MX .............................................. A1-320 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-368
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-322
LM Guide High Temperature Type Model SR-M1 .... A1-370
LM Guide Structural Member Rail Model JR.... A1-324 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-371
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-325 • Thermal Characteristics of LM Rail and LM Block Materials .. A1-371
• Second Moment of Inertia of the LM Rail .. A1-325 • Types and Features ............................. A1-372
• Types and Features ............................. A1-326 • Service Life ......................................... A1-373
A1-4
506E
A1-5
506E
A1-6
506E
Features and Types ............................. B1-8 • Methods for Measuring Accuracy after Installation .. B1-101
Features of the LM Guide ...................... B1-8 • Recommended Tightening Torque for LM Rails .. B1-101
• Large Permissible Load and High Rigidity .. B1-9
• High Precision of Motion ....................... B1-11 Options ................................................. B1-103
• Accuracy Averaging Effect by Absorbing Mounting Surface Error .. B1-14 Seal and Metal scraper.......................... B1-104
• Easy Maintenance ............................... B1-16 Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS ......... B1-105
• Substantial Energy Savings ................... B1-17 Side Scraper .......................................... B1-107
• Low Total Cost ..................................... B1-18 Protector ................................................ B1-108
• Ideal Four Raceway, Circular-Arc Groove, Two-Point Contact Structure .. B1-19 Light-Resistance Contact Seal LiCS ..... B1-109
• Superb Error-Absorbing Capability with the DF Design .. B1-23 Dedicated bellows ................................. B1-110
Classification Table of the LM Guides ... B1-24 Dedicated LM Cover .............................. B1-110
Cap C .................................................... B1-111
Point of Selection ................................ B1-26 Cap GC.................................................. B1-112
Flowchart for Selecting an LM Guide .... B1-26 Plate Cover SV Steel Tape SP ............. B1-114
Setting Conditions ................................. B1-28 QZ Lubricator......................................... B1-117
• Conditions of the LM Guide ................... B1-28 Lubrication Adapter................................ B1-120
Selecting a Type .................................... B1-44 Removing/mounting Jig ......................... B1-121
• Types of LM Guides ............................. B1-44 End Piece EP ........................................ B1-122
Calculating the Applied Load ................. B1-56
• Calculating an Applied Load .................. B1-56 Model No. ............................................. B1-123
• Example of calculation .......................... B1-59 • Model Number Coding .......................... B1-123
Calculating the Equivalent Load ............ B1-66 • Notes on Ordering................................ B1-127
• Rated Load of an LM Guide in Each Direction .. B1-66
Calculating the Static Safety Factor ...... B1-68 Precautions on Use ............................. B1-129
Calculating the Average Load................ B1-69 Precautions on Using the LM Guide ...... B1-129
• Example of Calculating the Average Load (1) Precautions on Handling the LM Guide for Special Environment .. B1-131
- with Horizontal Mount and Acceleration/Deceleration Considered - .. B1-71 • LM Guide for Medium-to-Low Vacuum .... B1-131
• Example of Calculating the Average Load (2) • Oil-Free LM Guide ............................... B1-131
- When the Rails are Movable................... B1-72 Precautions on Using Options for the LM Guide .. B1-132
Calculating the Nominal Life .................. B1-73 • QZ Lubricator for the LM Guide .............. B1-132
• Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Balls .. B1-73 • Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS, Side Scraper for LM Guides .. B1-132
• Nominal Life Equation for the Oil-Free LM Guide .. B1-73 • Light Contact Seal LiCS for LM Guides ... B1-133
• Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Rollers .. B1-74 • Cap GC .............................................. B1-133
• Example of Calculating the Nominal Life (1)
- with Horizontal Mount and High-speed Acceleration .. B1-77
• Example of Calculating the Nominal Life (2)
- with Vertical Mount .............................. B1-82
Predicting the Rigidity ............................ B1-85
• Selecting a Radial Clearance (Preload) ... B1-85
• Service Life with a Preload Considered ... B1-86
• Rigidity ............................................... B1-86
Determining the Accuracy...................... B1-87
• Accuracy Standards ............................. B1-87
• Guidelines for Accuracy Grades by Machine Type .. B1-88
A1-7
506E
Ball Guide
Model NSR-TBC
Self-aligning
Wide Type
Model SHW Miniature Type
Low Center of Gravity
Model RSR Model RSR-Z
Ultra Compact Ultra Compact
High Corrosion Resistance
Miniature Type
Model SRS Model EPF Wide Type
Lightweight and Compact Finite stroke
Model HRW
Wide Rail
4-way Equal Load
Cross Type
Model SCR
4-way Equal Load
A1-8
506E
LM Guide
Roller Guide
Standard Type
Model HCR
Model JR Type
Straight-Curved Type
Model JR
Structural Member Rail
Model HMG
4-way Equal Load
A1-9
506E
Selection Starts
1 Setting Conditions Set conditions necessary for designing load on the LM Guide.
Change span, number
of LM blocks and Mounting orientation A1-12 Symbol for number of axes A1-13
number of LM rails
3 Calculating the Applied Load Calculate the applied load on the LM block.
Calculating the applied load A1-40 Load rating of the LM Guide in all directions A1-57
Judgment on the
static safety factor
NO
YES
Average the applied load fluctuating during operation
6 Calculating the Average Load to convert the value to an average load. A1-62
Selection Completed
A1-10
506E
Point of Selection
Flowchart for Selecting an LM Guide
LM Guide
•Space in the guide section
•Dimensions (span, number of LM blocks, number of LM rails, thrust)
•Installation direction (horizontal, vertical, slant mount, wall mount, suspended)
•Magnitude, direction and position of the working load
•Operating frequency (duty cycle)
•Speed (acceleration)
•Stroke length
•Required service life
•Precision of motion
•Environment
•In a special environment (vacuum, clean room, high temperature, environment exposed to
contaminated environment, etc.), it is necessary to take into account material, surface treatment,
lubrication and contamination protection.
A1-11
506E
Setting Conditions
Conditions of the LM Guide
[Mounting Orientation]
The LM Guide can be mounted in the following five orientations.
If the mounting orientation of the LM Guide is other than horizontal use, the lubricant may not reach
the raceway completely.
Be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block where the
grease nipple or the piping joint should be attached.
For the lubrication, see A24-2.
[Mounting Orientation]
Horizontal (symbol: H) Inverted (symbol: R) Wall mount (symbol: K)
Up Up Up
Up
Up
Down Down
A1-12
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
SHS25C2SSCO+1000LP -Ⅱ
Model number (details are given on the Symbol for number of axes
corresponding page of the model) ("II" indicates 2 axes. No symbol for a single axis)
Note: Note:
When placing an order, specify When placing an order, specify
the number in multiple of 2 axes. the number in multiple of 2 axes.
Note:
When placing an order, specify
the number in multiple of 3 axes.
Using 2 axes opposed
to each other
Note:
When placing an order, specify
the number in multiple of 4 axes.
A1-13
506E
[Service environment]
Lubrication
When using an LM system, it is necessary to provide effective lubrication. Without lubrication, the
rolling elements or the raceway may be worn faster and the service life may be shortened.
A lubricant has effects such as the following.
(1) Minimizes friction in moving elements to prevent seizure and reduce wear.
(2) Forms an oil film on the raceway to decrease stress acting on the surface and extend rolling fa-
tigue life.
(3) Covers the metal surface to prevent rust formation.
To fully bring out the LM Guide’s functions, it is necessary to provide lubrication according to the
conditions.
If the mounting orientation is other than horizontal use, the lubricant may not reach the raceway
completely.
Be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block where the
grease nipple or the piping joint should be attached. For the mounting orientations of LM Guides,
see A1-12. For the lubrication, see A24-2.
Even with an LM Guide with seals, the internal lubricant gradually seeps out during operation.
Therefore, the system needs to be lubricated at an appropriate interval according to the service con-
ditions.
Corrosion Prevention
Determining a Material
Any LM system requires a material that meets the environments. For use in environments where
corrosion resistance is required, some LM system models can use martensite stainless steel.
(Martensite stainless steel can be used for LM Guide models SSR, SHW, SRS, HSR, SR, HRW,
RSR, RSR-Z and HR.)
The HSR series includes HSR-M2, a highly corrosion resistant LM Guide using austenite stainless
steel, which has high anti-corrosive effect. For details, see A1-390.
Surface Treatment
The surfaces of the rails and shafts of LM systems can be treated for anti-corrosive or aesthetic pur-
poses.
THK offers THK-AP treatment, which is the optimum surface treatment for LM systems.
There are roughly three types of THK-AP treatment: AP-HC, AP-C and AP-CF. (See B0-20.)
A1-14
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
Contamination Protection
When foreign material enters an LM system, it will cause abnormal wear or shorten the service life,
and it is necessary to prevent foreign material from entering the system. When entrance of foreign
material is predicted, it is important to select an effective sealing device or dust-control device that
meets the environment conditions.
THK offers contamination protection accessories for LM Guides by model number, such as end
seals made of special synthetic rubber with high wear resistance, and side seals and inner seals for
LM Guide
further increasing dust-prevention effect.
In addition, for locations with adverse environment, Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS and dedicated
bellows are available by model number. Also, THK offers dedicated caps for LM rail mounting holes,
designed to prevent cutting chips from entering the LM rail mounting holes.
When it is required to provide contamination protection for a Ball Screw in an environment exposed
to cutting chips and moisture, we recommend using a telescopic cover that protects the whole sys-
tem or a large bellows.
For the options, see A1-478.
A1-15
506E
[Special environments]
Clean Room
In a clean environment generation of dust
from the LM system has to be reduced
Caged Ball LM Guide
and anti-rust oil cannot be used.
Therefore, it is necessary to increase the SHS SSR SVR/SVS
Supported
corrosion resistance of the LM system. In models
SHW SRS SCR EPF
addition, depending on the level of
cleanliness, a dust collector is required.
Corrosion Prevention
■Material-based Measure LM Guides for Special Environment
Stainless Steel LM Guide
This LM Guide uses martensite stainless Supported
High Corrosion Resistance HSR-M2
steel, which has corrosion resistant effect.
models
Oil-Free SR-MS
Highly Corrosion Resistant LM Guide
It uses austenite stainless steel, which has
a high corrosion resistant effect, in its LM
rail.
Surface Treatment
■Measure Through Surface Treatment
THK AP-HC, AP-C and AP-CF Treatment
The LM system is surface treated to
increase corrosion resistance.
Grease
A1-16
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
SRS SCR EPF
HSR-M2 SR-MS
A1-390 A1-404
B0-20
A24-12 A24-14
A1-17
506E
High Temperature
Vacuum
LM Guide
In a vacuum environment, measures are required
to prevent gas from being emitted from a resin
and the scattering of grease. Anti-rust oil cannot Supported HSR-M1 SR-M1
models
be used, therefore, it is necessary to select a RSR-M1
product with high corrosion resistance.
■Corrosion Prevention
Stainless Steel LM Guide
In a vacuum environment, use a stainless
steel LM Guide, which is highly corrosion
resistant.
Stainless Steel
High Temperature LM Guide LM Guide
If high temperature is predicted due to
baking, use a High Temperature LM Guide,
which is highly resistant to heat and
corrosion.
■Highly Corrosion Resistant LM Guide
Supported
models
HSR SR HRW HR RSR
This LM Guide uses austenite stainless
steel, which has a high anti-corrosion
effect, in the LM rail.
Vacuum Grease
Oil-Free
In environments susceptible to liquid lubricants, a
lubrication method other than grease or oil is required.
■Dry Lubricant
Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film
Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film is a fully dry lubricant developed
Oil-Free LM Guide
for use under atmospheric to high-vacuum environments.
It has superior characteristics in load carrying capacity, wear
resistance and sealability to other lubrication systems.
A1-18
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-354 A1-370 A1-380
HSR-M1VV SR-MS
A1-396 A1-404
HSR-M2
A1-390
HSR SR HRW
A1-276 A1-250
SR-MS
A1-404
A1-19
506E
Corrosion
Prevention
As with clean room applications, it is
necessary to increase corrosion
resistance through material selection and Stainless Steel
surface treatment. LM Guide
Surface Treatment
A1-20
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-106 A1-138 A1-148
HSR SR HRW
A1-276 A1-250
HSR-M2
A1-390
THK AP-HC
Treatment
B0-20
THK AP-C
Treatment
B0-20
THK AP-CF
Treatment
B0-20
A1-21
506E
High Speed
In a high speed environment, it is
necessary to apply an optimum Caged Ball LM Guide
lubrication method that reduces
heat generation during high speed
operation and increases grease Supported SHS SSR SVR/SVS
retention.
models
SHW SRS SCR EPF
Grease
A1-22
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-94 A1-106 A1-118 A1-138
SRS SCR EPF
QZ Lubricator
for the LM Guide
A1-502
A24-7 A24-20
A1-23
506E
Supported
SSR SHW SRS HSR SR
■Impact of Low Temperature on Resin Components models
HRW HR RSR
Stainless Steel LM Guide
The endplate (ball circulation path normally
made of resin) of the LM block is made of
stainless steel.
■Grease
Use THK AFC Grease, with which the rolling
resistance of the system little is consistent
even at low temperature.
Low Temperature
Grease
Micro Motion
Micro strokes cause the oil film to break, resulting in
poor lubrication and early wear. In such cases, select a
grease with which the oil film strength is high and an oil
film can easily be formed.
■Grease Grease
THK AFC Grease
AFC Grease is a urea-based grease that excels
in oil film strength and wear resistance.
A1-24
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-354 A1-370 A1-380 A1-396
A1-276 A1-250
B0-20
A24-10
A24-10
A1-25
506E
LM Guide
Foreign Matter
If foreign matter enters the LM system, it will
+Metal scraper
cause abnormal wear and shorten the service
life. Therefore, it is necessary to prevent such +Contact scraper LaCS
entrance of foreign matter.
Especially in an environment containing +Cap GC, etc.
small foreign matter or a water-soluble
coolant that a telescopic cover or a bellows
cannot remove, it is necessary to attach a
contamination protection accessory capable
of efficiently removing foreign matter.
QZ Lubricator
LaCS
■QZ Lubricator
Caged Roller LM Guide
QZ Lubricator is a lubrication system that
feeds the right amount of lubricant by +Metal scraper
closely contacting its highly oil-impregnated
fiber net to the ball raceway. +Contact scraper LaCS
■Metal Cap Dedicated for LM Rail Mounting Holes GC Cap +Cap GC, etc.
GC cap is a metallic cap that plugs the LM
rail mounting hole (article compliant with the
RoHS Directives). It prevents the entrance of
foreign material and coolant from the LM rail QZ Lubricator
■Protector
The protector minimizes the entrance of A1-473
foreign material even in harsh environ-
ments where foreign material such as fine Supported
SRG
models
particles and liquids are present.
A1-26
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-94 A1-106 A1-138
SRS SVR/SVS
A1-178 A1-220
A1-416
A1-27
506E
Selecting a Type
Types of LM Guides
THK offers a wide array of types and dimensions with LM Guides as standard so that you can select
the optimal product for any application. With the unit structure of each model, you can easily obtain
high running accuracy with no clearance simply by mounting the product on a plane surface with
bolts. We have a proven track record and know-how in extensive applications with LM Guides.
A1-28
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
LM Guide
External dimensions (mm)
Features Major application
Height Width
● Long service life, long-term ● Thin, compact design, large ● Surface grinder table
24 to 48 34 to 70 maintenance-free operation radial load capacity ● Tool grinder table
● Low dust generation, low noise, ● Superb in planar running accuracy ● Electric discharge machine
24 to 33 34 to 48 acceptable running sound ● Superb capability of ● Printed circuit board
● Superbly high speed absorbing mounting error drilling machine
● Smooth motion in all ● Stainless steel type also ● Chip mounter
24 to 33 52 to 73 mounting orientations available as standard ● High-speed transfer
equipment
24 to 135 34 to 250 ● Traveling unit of robots
● Machining center
● NC lathe
24 to 48 34 to 70 ● Five axis milling machine
● Conveyance system
24 to 48 34 to 70 ● Mold guide of pressing
● Thin, compact design, large radial load capacity machines
● Superb in planar running accuracy ● Inspection equipment
24 to 48 34 to 70 ● Testing machine
● Superb capability of absorbing mounting error
● Stainless steel type also available as standard ● Food-related machine
24 to 68 52 to 140 ● Type M1, achieving max service temperature of 150℃, also ● Medical equipment
available ● 3D measuring instrument
● Packaging machine
24 to 48 52 to 100 ● Injection molding machine
● Woodworking machine
24 to 48 52 to 100 ● Ultra precision table
● Semiconductor/liquid
crystal manufacturing
24 to 48 52 to 100 equipment
24 to 28 34 to 42 ● Photolithography machine
● Minimum generation of outgases (water, organic matter)
● Organic EL display
● Small amount of particles generated
manufacturing machine
24 to 28 34 to 42 ● Can be used at high temperature (up to 150℃)
● Ion implantation equipment
A1-29
506E
A1-30
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
31 to 105 72 to 260
31 to 105 72 to 260
● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
LM Guide
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● High vibration resistance and impact resistance due to
improved damping characteristics
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Thin, compact design, large radial load capacity
● Superb in planar running accuracy ● Machining center
● NC lathe
31 to 105 50 to 200 ● Grinding machine
● Five axis milling
machine
31 to 105 50 to 200 ● Jig borer
● Drilling machine
31 to 75 72 to 170 ● NC milling machine
● Long service life, long-term maintenance-free operation
● Horizontal milling
● Low dust generation, low noise, acceptable running sound
machine
31 to 75 72 to 170 ● Superbly high speed
● Mold processing
● Smooth motion in all mounting orientations
machine
● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
31 to 75 50 to 126 ● Graphite working
● Low profile, compact 4-way type
machine
● High vibration resistance and impact resistance due to
● Electric discharge
31 to 75 50 to 126 improved damping characteristics
machine
● Wire-cut electric
● Long service life, long-term ● 4-way type discharge machine
48 to 70 100 to 140 maintenance-free operation ● High vibration resistance
● Low dust generation, low and impact resistance
48 to 70 100 to 140 noise, acceptable running due to improved damping
sound characteristics
● Superbly high speed ● Has dimensions almost the
55 to 80 70 to 100 ● Smooth motion in all same as that of the full-ball
mounting orientations type LM Guide model HSR,
55 to 80 70 to 100 ● Ultra-heavy load capacity which is practically a global
optimal for machine tools standard size
A1-31
506E
A1-32
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
24 to 70 47 to 140
● Long service life, long-term maintenance-free operation
30 to 120 63 to 250 ● Low noise, acceptable running sound
● Superbly high speed
LM Guide
24 to 80 34 to 100 ● Smooth motion due to prevention of rollers from skewing
● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
30 to 90 44 to 126
● Machining center
44 to 63 100 to 140 ● NC lathe
● Grinding machine
44 to 75 100 to 170 ● Long service life, long-term maintenance-free operation ● Five axis milling
machine
● Low noise, acceptable running sound
● Jig borer
44 to 63 70 to 100 ● Superbly high speed
● Drilling machine
● Smooth motion due to prevention of rollers from skewing
● NC milling machine
● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
44 to 75 70 to 126 ● Horizontal milling
● Low center of gravity, ultra-high rigidity
machine
● Mold processing
70 to 150 135 to 300 machine
● Graphite working
machine
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Electric discharge
machine
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Wire-cut electric
discharge machine
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
● High vibration resistance and impact resistance due to
improved damping characteristics
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Low-Profile compact design, 4-way equal load
31 to 105 50 to 200
31 to 105 50 to 200
● Machining center
● NC lathe
24 to 90 47 to 170 ● XYZ axes of heavy
cutting machine tools
● Grinding head feeding
axis of grinding
machines
24 to 90 47 to 170 ● Components requiring a
heavy moment and high
accuracy
● NC milling machine
● Long service life, long-term maintenance-free operation ● Horizontal milling
24 to 90 34 to 126 ● Low dust generation, low noise, acceptable running sound machine
● Superbly high speed ● Gantry five axis milling
● Smooth motion in all mounting orientations machine
● Heavy load, high rigidity ● Z axis of electric
● Has dimensions almost the same as that of the full-ball type discharge machines
LM Guide model HSR, which is practically a global standard ● Wire-cut electric
24 to 90 34 to 126 size discharge machine
● Superb capability of absorbing mounting error ● Car elevator
● Food-related machine
● Testing machine
● Vehicle doors
28 to 80 34 to 100 ● Printed circuit board
drilling machine
● ATC
● Construction equipment
● Shield machine
28 to 80 34 to 100 ● Semiconductor/liquid
crystal manufacturing
equipment
A1-33
506E
LM Guide for
Medium-to-Low HSR-M1VV A1-400 8.33 13.5
Vacuum
Full-Complement
LM Guides -
JR-B A1-328 19.9 to 88.5 34.4 to 137
special LM rail
types
A1-34
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
24 to 110 47 to 215
24 to 48 47 to 100
● Machining center
LM Guide
● NC lathe
30 to 110 63 to 215
● XYZ axes of heavy cutting ma-
chine tools
30 to 48 63 to 100
● Grinding head feeding axis
of grinding machines
30 to 110 63 to 215
● Components requiring a
heavy moment and high ac-
30 to 145 63 to 350
curacy
● NC milling machine
24 to 110 47 to 215
● Heavy load, high rigidity ● Horizontal milling machine
● Practically a global standard size ● Gantry five axis milling ma-
24 to 48 47 to 100
● Superb capability of absorbing mounting error chine
● Stainless steel type also available as standard ● Z axis of electric discharge
30 to 110 63 to 215 ● Type M1, achieving max service temperature of 150℃,
also available machines
● Type M2, with high corrosion resistance, also available ● Wire-cut electric discharge
30 to 48 63 to 100 (Basic dynamic load rating: 2.33 to 5.57 kN) machine
(Basic static load rating: 2.03 to 5.16 kN) ● Car elevator
30 to 110 63 to 215
● Food-related machine
● Testing machine
30 to 145 63 to 350
● Vehicle doors
● Printed circuit board drilling
11 to 110 16 to 156
machine
● ATC
28 to 55 34 to 70 ● Construction equipment
● Shield machine
30 to 110 44 to 156 ● Semiconductor/liquid crystal
manufacturing equipment
30 to 55 44 to 70
A1-35
506E
Full-Complement
LM Guide CSR A1-314 8.33 to 80.4 13.5 to 127.5
orthogonal type
Straight sec-
tion
Full-ball Straight - 4.23 to 66.7
HMG A1-344 2.56 to 66.2
Curved Guide Curved sec-
tion
0.44 to 36.2
Caged Ball LM
Guides EPF A1-174 0.90 to 3.71 1.60 to 5.88
Finite stroke
Full-Complement
Ball LM Guide -
separate types GSR-T A1-294 5.69 to 25.1 8.43 to 33.8
Interchangeable
Full-Complement Ball
LM Guides -
GSR-R A1-302 10.29 to 25.1 12.65 to 33.8
LM rail-rack intergrated
type
A1-36
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
LM Guide
● Optical measuring ● Printed circuit board
maintenance-free operation instrument assembler
● Low dust generation, low noise, ● Automatic lathe ● Machine tool table
acceptable running sound ● Inspection equipment ● Electric discharge
● Superbly high speed ● Cartesian coordinate machine
● A compact XY structure is allowed due to robot ● XY axes of horizontal
an XY orthogonal, single-piece LM block ● Bonding machine machining center
47 to 118 38.8 to 129.8 ● Since a saddle-less structure
is allowed, the machine can be
lightweighted and compactly designed
● Long service life, long-term
12 to 50 40 to 162 maintenance-free operation
● Low dust generation, low noise,
acceptable running sound ● Z axis of IC printed ● APC
● Superbly high speed circuit board drilling ● Semiconductor/liquid
● Smooth motion in all mounting orientationsmachine crystal manufacturing
12 to 50 ● Z axis of small electric
30 to 130 ● Wide, low center of gravity, space saving structure equipment
discharge machine
● Stainless steel type also available as standard ● Measuring instrument
● Loader ● Wafer transfer
● Machining center equipment
17 to 60 60 to 200 ● 4-way equal load, thin and highly ● NC lathe ● Construction equipment
rigid ● Robot ● Railroad vehicle
● Wide, low center of gravity, space ● Wire-cut electric
saving structure discharge machine
● Stainless steel type also available
12 to 50 30 to 130 as standard
A1-37
506E
Full Complement
Ball LM Guide - MX A1-320 0.59 to 2.04 1.1 to 3.21
orthogonal type
Circular arc types
Full-Complement
HCR A1-336 4.7 to 141 8.53 to 215
Ball LM Guides
Self-aligning
types
Full-Complement
NSR-TBC A1-350 9.41 to 90.8 18.6 to 152
Ball LM Guides
A1-38
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
LM Guide
9 to 16 25 to 60 ● Smooth motion in all mounting orientations ● Wafer transfer ● Plotting machine
● Stainless steel type also available equipment ● Feed mechanism of IC
as standard ● Printed circuit board bonding machine
12 to 16 30 to 60 ● Lightweight and compact assembly table ● Inspection equipment
4 to 25 8 to 46
● Stainless steel type also available
10 to 25 20 to 46 as standard
● Long type with increased load
4 to 25 8 to 46 capacity also offered as standard
● Type M1, achieving max service ● IC/LSI manufacturing machine
temperature of 150℃, also ● Hard disc drive
10 to 25 20 to 46 available ● Slide unit of OA equipment
● Wafer transfer equipment
8 to 16 17 to 32 ● Printed circuit board assembly table
● Medical equipment
● Electronic components of electron microscope
4.5 to 16 12 to 60 ● Optical stage
● Stepper
● Stainless steel type also available ● Plotting machine
12 to 16 30 to 60 as standard ● Feed mechanism of IC bonding machine
● Long type with increased load ● Inspection equipment
4.5 to 16 12 to 60 capacity also offered as standard
● Type M1, achieving max service
temperature of 150℃, also
12 to 16 30 to 60 available
9 to 16 25 to 60
● IC/LSI manufacturing ● Feed mechanism of IC
machine bonding machine
● A compact XY structure is allowed ● Inspection equipment ● Printed circuit board
due to an XY orthogonal, ● Slide unit of OA assembly table
10 to 14.5 15.2 to 30.2 single-piece LM block equipment ● Medical equipment
● Stainless steel type also available ● Wafer transfer ● Electronic components
as standard equipment of electron microscope
● Optical stage
● Circular motion guide in a 4-way ● Large swivel base ● X-Ray machine
equal load design ● Pendulum vehicle for ● CT scanner
● Highly accurate circular motion railroad ● Medical equipment
without play ● Pantagraph ● Stage setting
18 to 90 39 to 170 ● Allows an efficient design with the ● Control unit ● Car elevator
LM block placed in the loading ● Optical measuring ● Amusement machine
point machine ● Turntable
● Large circular motion easily achieved ● Tool grinder ● Tool changer
● Can be used in rough mount due ● XY axes of ordinary industrial machinery
to self-aligning on the fit surface of ● Various conveyance systems
the case ● Automated warehouse
40 to 105 70 to 175 ● Preload can be adjusted ● Palette changer
● Can be mounted on a black steel ● Automatic coating machine
sheet ● Various welding machines
A1-39
506E
LM rail
Maximum applied load on a ball
Ball
displacement line Load distribution curve
Load distribution curve
A1-40
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
Equivalent Factor
Since the rated load is equivalent to the permissible moment, the equivalent factor to be multiplied
when equalizing the MA, MB and MC moments to the applied load per block is obtained by dividing
the rated loads in the corresponding directions.
With those models other than 4-way equal load types, however, the load ratings in the 4 directions
differ from each other. Therefore, the equivalent factor values for the MA and MC moments also differ
depending on whether the direction is radial or reverse radial.
LM Guide
Equivalent Factors for the MA Moment
PR=KAR•MA
Equivalent in the radial direction
PL=KAL•MA
Equivalent in the reverse-radial direction
Fig.3 Equivalent Factors for the MA Moment
C0 C0L
= =1
KAR•MA KAL•MA
PT=KB•MB
Equivalent in the lateral direction
PT=KB•MB
Equivalent in the lateral direction
Fig.4 Equivalent Factors for the MB Moment
C0T
=1
KB•MB
A1-41
506E
PR=KCR•MC
Equivalent in the radial direction
PL=KCL•MC
Equivalent in the reverse-radial direction
C0 C0L
= =1
KCR•MC KCL•MC
A1-42
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
Table1 Equivalent Factors (Models SHS, SSR, SVR, SVS, SHW and SRS)
Equivalent factor
Model No.
KAR1 KAL1 KAR2 KAL2 KB1 KB2 KCR KCL
15 1.38×10-1 2.69×10-2 1.38×10-1 2.69×10-2 1.50×10-1
15L 1.07×10-1 2.22×10-2 1.07×10-1 2.22×10-2 1.50×10-1
20 1.15×10-1 2.18×10-2 1.15×10-1 2.18×10-2 1.06×10-1
LM Guide
20L 8.85×10-2 1.79×10-2 8.85×10-2 1.79×10-2 1.06×10-1
-2 -2 -2 -2
25 9.25×10 1.90×10 9.25×10 1.90×10 9.29×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
25L 7.62×10 1.62×10 7.62×10 1.62×10 9.29×10-2
30 8.47×10-2 1.63×10-2 8.47×10-2 1.63×10-2 7.69×10-2
30L 6.52×10-2 1.34×10-2 6.52×10-2 1.34×10-2 7.69×10-2
SHS -2 -2 -2 -2
35 6.95×10 1.43×10 6.95×10 1.43×10 6.29×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
35L 5.43×10 1.16×10 5.43×10 1.16×10 6.29×10-2
45 6.13×10-2 1.24×10-2 6.13×10-2 1.24×10-2 4.69×10-2
45L 4.79×10-2 1.02×10-2 4.79×10-2 1.02×10-2 4.69×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
55 4.97×10 1.02×10 4.97×10 1.02×10 4.02×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
55L 3.88×10 8.30×10 3.88×10 8.30×10 4.02×10-2
65 3.87×10-2 7.91×10-3 3.87×10-2 7.91×10-3 3.40×10-2
65L 3.06×10-2 6.51×10-3 3.06×10-2 6.51×10-3 3.40×10-2
15XW (TB) 2.08×10-1 1.04×10-1 3.75×10-2 1.87×10-2 1.46×10-1 2.59×10-2 1.71×10-1 8.57×10-2
15XV 3.19×10-1 1.60×10-1 5.03×10-2 2.51×10-2 2.20×10-1 3.41×10-2 1.71×10-1 8.57×10-2
20XW (TB) 1.69×10-1 8.46×10-2 3.23×10-2 1.62×10-2 1.19×10-1 2.25×10-2 1.29×10-1 6.44×10-2
20XV 2.75×10-1 1.37×10-1 4.28×10-2 2.14×10-2 1.89×10-1 2.89×10-2 1.29×10-1 6.44×10-2
SSR
25XW (TB) 1.41×10-1 7.05×10-2 2.56×10-2 1.28×10-2 9.86×10-2 1.77×10-2 1.10×10-1 5.51×10-2
25XV 2.15×10-1 1.08×10-1 3.40×10-2 1.70×10-2 1.48×10-1 2.31×10-2 1.10×10-1 5.51×10-2
30XW 1.18×10-1 5.91×10-2 2.19×10-2 1.10×10-2 8.26×10-2 1.52×10-2 9.22×10-2 4.61×10-2
35XW 1.01×10-1 5.03×10-2 1.92×10-2 9.60×10-3 7.04×10-2 1.33×10-2 7.64×10-2 3.82×10-2
25 1.13×10-1 7.28×10-2 2.25×10-2 1.45×10-2 7.14×10-2 1.43×10-2 9.59×10-2 6.17×10-2
25L 9.14×10-2 5.88×10-2 1.85×10-2 1.19×10-2 5.80×10-2 1.17×10-2 9.59×10-2 6.17×10-2
30 1.01×10-1 6.50×10-2 1.89×10-2 1.21×10-2 6.36×10-2 1.19×10-2 8.45×10-2 5.43×10-2
30L 7.56×10-2 4.86×10-2 1.57×10-2 1.01×10-2 4.79×10-2 1.00×10-2 8.45×10-2 5.43×10-2
35 9.19×10-2 5.91×10-2 1.68×10-2 1.08×10-2 5.77×10-2 1.06×10-2 7.08×10-2 4.55×10-2
35L 6.80×10-2 4.37×10-2 1.39×10-2 8.97×10-3 4.31×10-2 8.86×10-3 7.08×10-2 4.55×10-2
SVR
45 6.73×10-2 4.33×10-2 1.35×10-2 8.71×10-3 4.25×10-2 8.59×10-3 5.32×10-2 3.42×10-2
45L 5.40×10-2 3.47×10-2 1.10×10-2 7.09×10-3 3.41×10-2 6.97×10-3 5.30×10-2 3.41×10-2
55 5.89×10-2 3.79×10-2 1.14×10-2 7.35×10-3 3.72×10-2 7.24×10-3 4.63×10-2 2.98×10-2
55L 4.55×10-2 2.92×10-2 9.45×10-3 6.08×10-3 2.89×10-2 6.02×10-3 4.63×10-2 2.98×10-2
65 4.85×10-2 3.12×10-2 1.01×10-2 6.48×10-3 3.06×10-2 6.40×10-3 3.91×10-2 2.51×10-2
65L 3.58×10-2 2.30×10-2 7.73×10-3 4.97×10-3 2.28×10-2 4.93×10-3 3.91×10-2 2.51×10-2
A1-43
506E
Equivalent factor
Model No.
KAR1 KAL1 KAR2 KAL2 KB1 KB2 KCR KCL
25 1.09×10-1 9.14×10-2 2.17×10-2 1.82×10-2 1.00×10-1 2.00×10-2 9.95×10-2 8.35×10-2
25L 8.82×10-2 7.40×10-2 1.78×10-2 1.50×10-2 8.13×10-2 1.64×10-2 9.95×10-2 8.35×10-2
30 9.71×10-2 8.15×10-2 1.82×10-2 1.52×10-2 8.95×10-2 1.67×10-2 8.78×10-2 7.37×10-2
30L 7.29×10-2 6.11×10-2 1.51×10-2 1.27×10-2 6.72×10-2 1.39×10-2 8.78×10-2 7.37×10-2
35 8.84×10-2 7.42×10-2 1.61×10-2 1.35×10-2 8.14×10-2 1.48×10-2 7.36×10-2 6.17×10-2
35L 6.56×10-2 5.50×10-2 1.34×10-2 1.13×10-2 6.04×10-2 1.24×10-2 7.36×10-2 6.17×10-2
SVS
45 6.48×10-2 5.44×10-2 1.30×10-2 1.09×10-2 5.98×10-2 1.20×10-2 5.45×10-2 4.57×10-2
45L 5.22×10-2 4.38×10-2 1.07×10-2 8.94×10-3 4.81×10-2 9.81×10-3 5.44×10-2 4.56×10-2
55 5.67×10-2 4.76×10-2 1.10×10-2 9.24×10-3 5.23×10-2 1.01×10-2 4.78×10-2 4.01×10-2
55L 4.39×10-2 3.68×10-2 9.12×10-3 7.65×10-3 4.05×10-2 8.40×10-3 4.78×10-2 4.01×10-2
65 4.67×10-2 3.92×10-2 9.72×10-3 8.15×10-3 4.30×10-2 8.95×10-3 4.04×10-2 3.39×10-2
65L 3.46×10-2 2.90×10-2 7.46×10-3 6.26×10-3 3.19×10-2 6.88×10-3 4.04×10-2 3.39×10-2
12 2.48×10-1 4.69×10-2 2.48×10-1 4.69×10-2 1.40×10-1
12HR 1.70×10-1 3.52×10-2 1.70×10-1 3.52×10-2 1.40×10-1
14 1.92×10-1 3.80×10-2 1.92×10-1 3.80×10-2 9.93×10-2
17 1.72×10-1 3.41×10-2 1.72×10-1 3.41×10-2 6.21×10-2
SHW -1 -2 -1 -2
21 1.59×10 2.95×10 1.59×10 2.95×10 5.57×10-2
-1 -2 -1 -2
27 1.21×10 2.39×10 1.21×10 2.39×10 4.99×10-2
35 8.15×10-2 1.64×10-2 8.15×10-2 1.64×10-2 3.02×10-2
50 6.22×10-2 1.24×10-2 6.22×10-2 1.24×10-2 2.30×10-2
-1 -2 -1 -2
5M 6.33×10 9.20×10 6.45×10 9.30×10 3.85×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
5WM 4.48×10 7.30×10 4.56×10 7.40×10 1.96×10-1
7 4.19×10-1 6.76×10-2 4.18×10-1 6.94×10-2 2.58×10-1
7W 3.01×10-1 5.32×10-2 3.00×10-1 5.46×10-2 1.36×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
9XS 4.86×10 6.89×10 5.04×10 7.11×10 2.17×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
9XM 2.95×10 5.27×10 3.06×10 5.43×10 2.17×10-1
9XN 2.13×10-1 4.12×10-2 2.19×10-1 4.23×10-2 2.17×10-1
9W 2.37×10-1 4.25×10-2 2.44×10-1 4.37×10-2 1.06×10-1
9WN 1.74×10-1 3.35×10-2 1.78×10-1 3.44×10-2 1.06×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
SRS 12 2.94×10 4.50×10 2.94×10 4.50×10 1.53×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
12N 1.86×10 3.51×10 1.86×10 3.51×10 1.53×10-1
12W 2.00×10-1 3.69×10-2 2.00×10-1 3.69×10-2 7.97×10-2
12WN 1.44×10-1 2.83×10-2 1.44×10-1 2.83×10-2 7.97×10-2
-1 -2 -1 -2
15 2.17×10 3.69×10 2.17×10 3.69×10 1.41×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
15N 1.43×10 2.73×10 1.43×10 2.73×10 1.41×10-1
15W 1.67×10-1 2.94×10-2 1.67×10-1 2.94×10-2 4.83×10-2
15WN 1.13×10-1 2.27×10-2 1.13×10-1 2.27×10-2 4.83×10-2
-1 -2 -1 -2
20 1.80×10 3.30×10 1.86×10 3.41×10 9.34×10-2
-1 -2 -1 -2
25 1.14×10 2.17×10 1.14×10 2.17×10 8.13×10-2
KAR1 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when one KB1 : MB Equivalent factor when one LM block is used
LM block is used KB2 : MB Equivalent factor when two LM blocks are used in
KAL1 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction close contact with each other
when one LM block is used KCR : Equivalent factor in the MC radial direction
KAR2 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when two KCL : Equivalent factor in the MC reverse radial direction
LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
KAL2 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction when
two LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
A1-44
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
Equivalent factor
Model No.
KAR1 KAL1 KAR2 KAL2 KB1 KB2 KCR KCL
15S 1.38×10-1 2.69×10-2 1.38×10-1 1.50×10-1
20S 1.15×10-1 2.18×10-2 1.15×10-1 1.06×10-1
20 8.85×10-2 1.79×10-2 8.85×10-2 1.06×10-1
LM Guide
25 9.25×10-2 1.90×10-2 9.25×10-2 1.90×10-2 9.29×10-2
SCR -2 -2 -2 -2
30 8.47×10 1.63×10 8.47×10 1.63×10 7.69×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
35 6.95×10 1.43×10 6.95×10 1.43×10 6.29×10-2
45 6.13×10-2 1.24×10-2 6.13×10-2 1.24×10-2 4.69×10-2
65 3.87×10-2 7.91×10-3 3.87×10-2 7.91×10-3 3.40×10-2
-1 -1
7M 3.55×10 — 3.55×10 2.86×10-1
-1 -1
9M 3.10×10 — 3.10×10 2.22×10-1
EPF
12M 2.68×10-1 — 2.68×10-1 1.67×10-1
15M 2.00×10-1 — 2.00×10-1 1.34×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
8 4.39×10 6.75×10 4.39×10 6.75×10 2.97×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
10 3.09×10 5.33×10 3.09×10 5.33×10 2.35×10-1
12 2.08×10-1 3.74×10-2 2.08×10-1 3.74×10-2 1.91×10-1
15 1.68×10-1 2.95×10-2 1.68×10-1 2.95×10-2 1.60×10-1
20 1.25×10-1 2.28×10-2 1.25×10-1 2.28×10-2 1.18×10-1
-2 -2 -2 -2
20L 9.83×10 1.91×10 9.83×10 1.91×10 1.18×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
25 1.12×10 2.01×10 1.12×10 2.01×10 1.00×10-1
25L 8.66×10-2 1.68×10-2 8.66×10-2 1.68×10-2 1.00×10-1
30 8.93×10-2 1.73×10-2 8.93×10-2 1.73×10-2 8.31×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
30L 7.02×10 1.43×10 7.02×10 1.43×10 8.31×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
35 7.81×10 1.55×10 7.81×10 1.55×10 6.74×10-2
35L 6.15×10-2 1.28×10-2 6.15×10-2 1.28×10-2 6.74×10-2
45 6.71×10-2 1.21×10-2 6.71×10-2 1.21×10-2 5.22×10-2
HSR
45L 5.20×10-2 1.00×10-2 5.20×10-2 1.00×10-2 5.22×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
55 5.59×10 1.03×10 5.59×10 1.03×10 4.27×10-2
55L 4.33×10-2 8.56×10 -3
4.33×10 -2
8.56×10 -3
4.27×10-2
65 4.47×10-2 9.13×10-3 4.47×10-2 9.13×10-3 3.69×10-2
65L 3.28×10-2 7.06×10-3 3.28×10-2 7.06×10-3 3.69×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
85 3.73×10 6.80×10 3.73×10 6.80×10 2.79×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
85L 2.89×10 5.68×10 2.89×10 5.68×10 2.79×10-2
100 2.60×10-2 5.15×10-3 2.60×10-2 5.15×10-3 2.25×10-2
120 2.36×10-2 4.72×10-3 2.36×10-2 4.72×10-3 1.97×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
150 2.17×10 4.35×10 2.17×10 4.35×10 1.61×10-2
-1 -2 -1 -2
15M2A 1.65×10 2.89×10 1.65×10 2.89×10 1.86×10-1
20M2A 1.23×10-1 2.23×10-2 1.23×10-1 2.23×10-2 1.34×10-1
25M2A 1.10×10-1 1.98×10-2 1.10×10-1 1.98×10-2 1.14×10-1
KAR1 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when one KAL2 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction when
LM block is used two LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
KAL1 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction KB1 : MB Equivalent factor when one LM block is used
when one LM block is used KB2 : MB Equivalent factor when two LM blocks are used in
KAR2 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when two close contact with each other
LM blocks are used in close contact with each other KCR : Equivalent factor in the MC radial direction
KCL : Equivalent factor in the MC reverse radial direction
A1-45
506E
Equivalent factor
Model No.
KAR1 KAL1 KAR2 KAL2 KB1 KB2 KCR KCL
15W (TB) 2.09×10-1 1.04×10-1 3.74×10-2 1.87×10-2 1.46×10-1 2.58×10-2 1.70×10-1 8.48×10-2
15V (SB) 3.40×10-1 1.70×10-1 4.94×10-2 2.47×10-2 2.35×10-1 3.32×10-2 1.70×10-1 8.48×10-2
20W (TB) 1.72×10-1 8.61×10-2 3.24×10-2 1.62×10-2 1.21×10-1 2.25×10-2 1.30×10-1 6.49×10-2
20V (SB) 2.72×10-1 1.36×10-1 4.33×10-2 2.16×10-2 1.88×10-1 2.94×10-2 1.30×10-1 6.49×10-2
25W (TB) 1.38×10-1 6.89×10-2 2.59×10-2 1.30×10-2 9.67×10-2 1.80×10-2 1.11×10-1 5.55×10-2
-1 -1 -2 -2 -1 -2 -1
25V (SB) 2.17×10 1.09×10 3.46×10 1.73×10 1.51×10 2.35×10 1.11×10 5.55×10-2
30W (TB) 1.15×10-1 5.74×10-2 2.22×10-2 1.11×10-2 8.06×10-2 1.55×10-2 9.22×10-2 4.61×10-2
30V (SB) 1.99×10-1 9.93×10-2 2.99×10-2 1.49×10-2 1.37×10-1 2.02×10-2 9.22×10-2 4.61×10-2
SR
35W (TB) 1.04×10-1 5.21×10-2 1.92×10-2 9.61×10-3 7.31×10-2 1.33×10-2 7.64×10-2 3.82×10-2
35V (SB) 1.70×10-1 8.51×10-2 2.61×10-2 1.31×10-2 1.17×10-1 1.77×10-2 7.64×10-2 3.82×10-2
45W (TB) 9.12×10-2 4.56×10-2 1.69×10-2 8.47×10-3 6.39×10-2 1.17×10-2 5.71×10-2 2.85×10-2
55W (TB) 6.89×10-2 3.44×10-2 1.39×10-2 6.93×10-3 4.84×10-2 9.66×10-3 5.46×10-2 2.73×10-2
15MSV 4.03×10-1 2.50×10-1 6.23×10-1 3.86×10-1 3.30×10-2 4.98×10-2 2.76×10-1 1.71×10-1
15MSW 2.43×10-1 1.50×10-1 3.88×10-1 2.40×10-1 2.46×10-2 3.84×10-2 2.74×10-1 1.70×10-1
20MSV 3.19×10-1 1.97×10-1 4.94×10-1 3.06×10-1 2.85×10-2 4.36×10-2 2.10×10-1 1.30×10-1
20MSW 1.99×10-1 1.24×10-1 3.18×10-1 1.97×10-1 2.11×10-2 3.33×10-2 2.09×10-1 1.30×10-1
25X 1.10×10-1 7.78×10-2 2.19×10-2 1.55×10-2 8.11×10-2 1.63×10-2 9.26×10-2 6.58×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2 -2
25XL 8.91×10 6.33×10 1.79×10 1.27×10 6.55×10 1.33×10-2 9.26×10-2 6.58×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2 -2
30 9.66×10 6.86×10 1.84×10 1.31×10 7.05×10 1.35×10-2 8.28×10-2 5.88×10-2
30L 7.43×10-2 5.27×10-2 1.52×10-2 1.08×10-2 5.47×10-2 1.13×10-2 8.28×10-2 5.88×10-2
35 8.82×10-2 6.26×10-2 1.64×10-2 1.16×10-2 6.42×10-2 1.20×10-2 6.92×10-2 4.91×10-2
35L 6.67×10-2 4.74×10-2 1.35×10-2 9.61×10-3 4.90×10-2 1.00×10-2 6.92×10-2 4.91×10-2
45 6.84×10-2 4.86×10-2 1.30×10-2 9.23×10-3 5.00×10-2 9.58×10-3 5.19×10-2 3.68×10-2
45L 5.11×10-2 3.62×10-2 1.08×10-2 7.66×10-3 3.79×10-2 8.07×10-3 5.19×10-2 3.68×10-2
55 5.75×10-2 4.08×10-2 1.11×10-2 7.90×10-3 4.21×10-2 8.21×10-3 4.44×10-2 3.15×10-2
NR
55L 4.53×10-2 3.22×10-2 9.16×10-3 6.51×10-3 3.34×10-2 6.79×10-3 4.44×10-2 3.15×10-2
65 4.97×10-2 3.53×10-2 9.74×10-3 6.91×10-3 3.64×10-2 7.18×10-3 3.75×10-2 2.66×10-2
65L 3.56×10-2 2.53×10-2 7.51×10-3 5.33×10-3 2.65×10-2 5.61×10-3 3.75×10-2 2.66×10-2
75 4.21×10-2 2.99×10-2 8.31×10-3 5.90×10-3 3.08×10-2 6.13×10-3 3.16×10-2 2.24×10-2
75L 3.14×10-2 2.23×10-2 6.74×10-3 4.78×10-3 2.33×10-2 5.04×10-3 3.16×10-2 2.24×10-2
85 3.70×10-2 2.62×10-2 7.31×10-3 5.19×10-3 2.71×10-2 5.40×10-3 2.80×10-2 1.99×10-2
85L 2.80×10-2 1.99×10-2 6.07×10-3 4.31×10-3 2.08×10-2 4.55×10-3 2.80×10-2 1.99×10-2
100 3.05×10-2 2.17×10-2 6.20×10-3 4.41×10-3 2.26×10-2 4.63×10-3 2.38×10-2 1.69×10-2
100L 2.74×10-2 1.95×10-2 5.46×10-3 3.87×10-3 2.00×10-2 4.00×10-3 2.38×10-2 1.69×10-2
KAR1 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when one KB1 : MB Equivalent factor when one LM block is used
LM block is used KB2 : MB Equivalent factor when two LM blocks are used in
KAL1 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction close contact with each other
when one LM block is used KCR : Equivalent factor in the MC radial direction
KAR2 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when two KCL : Equivalent factor in the MC reverse radial direction
LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
KAL2 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction when
two LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
A1-46
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
Equivalent factor
Model No.
KAR1 KAL1 KAR2 KAL2 KB1 KB2 KCR KCL
25X 1.05×10-1 2.11×10-2 1.05×10-1 2.11×10-2 9.41×10-2
25XL 8.60×10-2 1.73×10-2 8.60×10-2 1.73×10-2 9.41×10-2
30 9.30×10-2 1.77×10-2 9.30×10-2 1.77×10-2 8.44×10-2
LM Guide
30L 7.17×10-2 1.47×10-2 7.17×10-2 1.47×10-2 8.44×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
35 8.47×10 1.57×10 8.47×10 1.57×10 7.08×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
35L 6.44×10 1.31×10 6.44×10 1.31×10 7.08×10-2
45 6.58×10-2 1.25×10-2 6.58×10-2 1.25×10-2 5.26×10-2
45L 4.92×10-2 1.04×10-2 4.92×10-2 1.04×10-2 5.26×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
55 5.54×10 1.07×10 5.54×10 1.07×10 4.52×10-2
NRS -2 -3 -2 -3
55L 4.38×10 8.85×10 4.38×10 8.85×10 4.52×10-2
65 4.79×10-2 9.38×10-3 4.79×10-2 9.38×10-3 3.81×10-2
65L 3.43×10-2 7.25×10-3 3.43×10-2 7.25×10-3 3.81×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
75 4.05×10 8.01×10 4.05×10 8.01×10 3.20×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
75L 3.03×10 6.50×10 3.03×10 6.50×10 3.20×10-2
85 3.56×10-2 7.05×10-3 3.56×10-2 7.05×10-3 2.83×10-2
85L 2.70×10-2 5.87×10-3 2.70×10-2 5.87×10-3 2.83×10-2
100 2.93×10-2 5.97×10-3 2.93×10-2 5.97×10-3 2.41×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
100L 2.65×10 5.27×10 2.65×10 5.27×10 2.41×10-2
-1 -1 -2 -2 -1 -1
12 2.72×10 1.93×10 5.16×10 3.65×10 5.47×10 1.04×10 1.40×10-1 9.92×10-2
14 2.28×10-1 1.61×10-1 4.16×10-2 2.94×10-2 4.54×10-1 8.28×10-2 1.01×10-1 7.18×10-2
17 1.95×10-1 3.33×10-2 1.95×10-1 3.33×10-2 6.32×10-2
-1 -2 -1 -2
21 1.64×10 2.89×10 1.64×10 2.89×10 5.92×10-2
HRW -1 -2 -1 -2
27 1.30×10 2.33×10 1.30×10 2.33×10 5.12×10-2
35 8.66×10-2 1.59×10-2 8.66×10-2 1.59×10-2 3.06×10-2
50 6.50×10-2 1.21×10-2 6.50×10-2 1.21×10-2 2.35×10-2
60 5.77×10-2 8.24×10-3 5.77×10-2 8.24×10-3 1.77×10-2
KAR1 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when one KB1 : MB Equivalent factor when one LM block is used
LM block is used KB2 : MB Equivalent factor when two LM blocks are used in
KAL1 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction close contact with each other
when one LM block is used KCR : Equivalent factor in the MC radial direction
KAR2 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when two KCL : Equivalent factor in the MC reverse radial direction
LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
KAL2 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction when
two LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
A1-47
506E
Equivalent factor
Model No.
KAR1 KAL1 KAR2 KAL2 KB1 KB2 KCR KCL
3M 9.20×10-1 1.27×10-1 9.20×10-1 1.27×10-1 6.06×10-1
3N 6.06×10-1 1.01×10-1 6.06×10-1 1.01×10-1 6.06×10-1
3W 7.03×10-1 1.06×10-1 7.03×10-1 1.06×10-1 3.17×10-1
3WN 4.76×10-1 8.27×10-2 4.76×10-1 8.27×10-2 3.17×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
5M 6.67×10 9.06×10 6.67×10 9.06×10 3.85×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
5N/TN 5.21×10 8.00×10 5.21×10 8.00×10 3.85×10-1
5W/WT 4.85×10-1 7.28×10-2 4.85×10-1 7.28×10-2 1.96×10-1
5WN/WTN 3.44×10-1 5.93×10-2 3.44×10-1 5.93×10-2 1.96×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
7M 4.66×10 6.57×10 4.66×10 6.57×10 2.74×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
7Z 4.66×10 6.60×10 4.66×10 6.60×10 2.74×10-1
7N 2.88×10-1 5.01×10-2 2.88×10-1 5.01×10-2 2.74×10-1
7W/WT 3.07×10-1 5.30×10-2 3.07×10-1 5.30×10-2 1.40×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
7WZ 3.30×10 5.12×10 3.30×10 5.12×10 1.40×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
7WN/WTN 2.18×10 4.13×10 2.18×10 4.13×10 1.40×10-1
9K 3.06×10-1 5.19×10-2 3.06×10-1 5.19×10-2 2.15×10-1
9Z 3.06×10-1 5.23×10-2 3.06×10-1 5.23×10-2 2.15×10-1
9N 2.15×10-1 4.08×10-2 2.15×10-1 4.08×10-2 2.15×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
RSR 9WV 2.44×10 4.22×10 2.44×10 4.22×10 1.09×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
9WZ 2.44×10 4.22×10 2.44×10 4.22×10 1.09×10-1
9WN 1.73×10-1 3.32×10-2 1.73×10-1 4.22×10-2 1.09×10-1
12V 3.52×10-1 2.46×10-1 5.37×10-2 3.76×10-2 2.81×10-1 4.21×10-2 2.09×10-1 1.46×10-1
12Z 3.52×10-1 2.46×10-1 5.37×10-2 3.76×10-2 2.81×10-1 4.21×10-2 2.09×10-1 1.46×10-1
12N 2.30×10-1 1.61×10-1 4.08×10-2 2.85×10-2 1.85×10-1 3.25×10-2 2.09×10-1 1.46×10-1
12WV 2.47×10-1 1.73×10-1 4.38×10-2 3.07×10-2 1.99×10-1 3.49×10-2 1.02×10-1 7.15×10-2
12WZ 2.47×10-1 1.73×10-1 4.38×10-2 3.07×10-2 1.99×10-1 3.49×10-2 1.02×10-1 7.15×10-2
12WN 1.71×10-1 1.20×10-1 3.36×10-2 2.35×10-2 1.38×10-1 2.70×10-2 1.02×10-1 7.15×10-2
14WV 2.10×10-1 1.47×10-1 3.89×10-2 2.73×10-2 1.69×10-1 3.10×10-2 8.22×10-2 5.75×10-2
15V 2.77×10-1 1.94×10-1 4.38×10-2 3.07×10-2 2.21×10-1 3.45×10-2 1.69×10-1 1.18×10-1
15Z 2.77×10-1 1.94×10-1 4.38×10-2 3.07×10-2 2.21×10-1 3.45×10-2 1.69×10-1 1.18×10-1
15N 1.70×10-1 1.19×10-1 3.24×10-2 2.27×10-2 1.37×10-1 2.59×10-2 1.69×10-1 1.18×10-1
15WV 1.95×10-1 1.36×10-1 3.52×10-2 2.46×10-2 1.56×10-1 2.80×10-2 5.83×10-2 4.08×10-2
15WZ 1.95×10-1 1.36×10-1 3.52×10-2 2.46×10-2 1.56×10-1 2.80×10-2 5.83×10-2 4.08×10-2
15WN 1.34×10-1 9.41×10-2 2.68×10-2 1.88×10-2 1.09×10-1 2.16×10-2 5.82×10-2 4.08×10-2
20V 1.68×10-1 1.18×10-1 2.92×10-2 2.04×10-2 1.35×10-1 2.32×10-2 1.30×10-1 9.13×10-2
20N 1.20×10-1 8.39×10-2 2.30×10-2 1.61×10-2 9.68×10-2 1.84×10-2 1.30×10-1 9.13×10-2
KAR1 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when one KB1 : MB Equivalent factor when one LM block is used
LM block is used KB2 : MB Equivalent factor when two LM blocks are used in
KAL1 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction close contact with each other
when one LM block is used KCR : Equivalent factor in the MC radial direction
KAR2 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when two KCL : Equivalent factor in the MC reverse radial direction
LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
KAL2 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction when
two LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
A1-48
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
Equivalent factor
Model No.
KAR1 KAL1 KAR2 KAL2 KB1 KB2 KCR KCL
918 2.65×10-1 3.58×10-2 2.65×10-1 3.58×10-2 — —
1123 2.08×10-1 3.17×10-2 2.08×10-1 3.17×10-2 — —
1530 1.56×10-1 2.39×10-2 1.56×10-1 2.39×10-2 — —
LM Guide
2042 1.11×10-1 1.80×10-2 1.11×10-1 1.80×10-2 — —
2042T 8.64×10-2 1.53×10-2 8.64×10-2 1.53×10-2 — —
2555 7.79×10-2 1.38×10-2 7.79×10-2 1.38×10-2 — —
2555T 6.13×10-2 1.17×10-2 6.13×10-2 1.17×10-2 — —
3065 6.92×10-2 1.15×10-2 6.92×10-2 1.15×10-2 — —
HR
3065T 5.45×10-2 9.92×10-3 5.45×10-2 9.92×10-3 — —
3575 6.23×10-2 1.08×10-2 6.23×10-2 1.08×10-2 — —
3575T 4.90×10-2 9.42×10-3 4.90×10-2 9.42×10-3 — —
4085 5.19×10-2 9.53×10-3 5.19×10-2 9.53×10-3 — —
4085T 4.09×10-2 7.97×10-3 4.09×10-2 7.97×10-3 — —
50105 4.15×10-2 7.40×10-3 4.15×10-2 7.40×10-3 — —
50105T 3.27×10-2 6.26×10-3 3.27×10-2 6.26×10-3 — —
60125 2.88×10-2 5.18×10-3 2.88×10-2 5.18×10-3 — —
15T 1.61×10-1 1.44×10-1 2.88×10-2 2.59×10-2 1.68×10-1 3.01×10-2 — —
15V 2.21×10-1 1.99×10-1 3.54×10-2 3.18×10-2 2.30×10-1 3.68×10-2 — —
20T 1.28×10-1 1.16×10-1 2.34×10-2 2.10×10-2 1.34×10-1 2.44×10-2 — —
20V 1.77×10-1 1.59×10-1 2.87×10-2 2.58×10-2 1.84×10-1 2.99×10-2 — —
GSR
25T 1.07×10-1 9.63×10-2 1.97×10-2 1.77×10-2 1.12×10-1 2.06×10-2 — —
25V 1.47×10-1 1.33×10-1 2.42×10-2 2.18×10-2 1.53×10-1 2.52×10-2 — —
30T 9.17×10-2 8.26×10-2 1.68×10-2 1.51×10-2 9.59×10-2 1.76×10-2 — —
35T 8.03×10-2 7.22×10-2 1.48×10-2 1.33×10-2 8.39×10-2 1.55×10-2 — —
15 1.68×10-1 2.95×10-2 1.68×10-1 2.95×10-2 1.60×10-1
20S 1.25×10-1 2.28×10-2 1.25×10-1 2.28×10-2 1.18×10-1
-2 -2 -2 -2
20 9.83×10 1.91×10 9.83×10 1.91×10 1.18×10-1
-1 -2 -1 -2
25S 1.12×10 2.01×10 1.12×10 2.01×10 1.00×10-1
CSR 25 8.66×10-2 1.68×10-2 8.66×10-2 1.68×10-2 1.00×10-1
30S 8.93×10-2 1.73×10-2 8.93×10-2 1.73×10-2 8.31×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
30 7.02×10 1.43×10 7.02×10 1.43×10 8.31×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
35 6.15×10 1.28×10 6.15×10 1.28×10 6.74×10-2
45 5.20×10-2 1.00×10-2 5.20×10-2 1.00×10-2 5.22×10-2
5 4.27×10-1 7.01×10-2 4.27×10-1 7.01×10-2 3.85×10-1
MX -1 -2 -1 -2
7W 2.18×10 4.13×10 2.18×10 4.13×10 1.40×10-1
KAR1 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when one KB1 : MB Equivalent factor when one LM block is used
LM block is used KB2 : MB Equivalent factor when two LM blocks are used in
KAL1 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction close contact with each other
when one LM block is used KCR : Equivalent factor in the MC radial direction
KAR2 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when two KCL : Equivalent factor in the MC reverse radial direction
LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
KAL2 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction when
two LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
A1-49
506E
Table7 Equivalent Factors (Model JR, NSR, SRG, SRN and SRW)
Equivalent factor
Model No.
KAR1 KAL1 KAR2 KAL2 KB1 KB2 KCR KCL
25 1.12×10-1 2.01×10-2 1.12×10-1 2.01×10-2 1.00×10-1
35 7.81×10-2 1.55×10-2 7.81×10-2 1.55×10-2 6.74×10-2
JR
45 6.71×10-2 1.21×10-2 6.71×10-2 1.21×10-2 5.22×10-2
55 5.59×10-2 1.03×10-2 5.59×10-2 1.03×10-2 4.27×10-2
-1 -2 -1 -2
20TBC 2.29×10 2.68×10 2.29×10 2.68×10 — —
25TBC 2.01×10-1 2.27×10-2 2.01×10-1 2.27×10-2 — —
30TBC 1.85×10-1 1.93×10-2 1.85×10-1 1.93×10-2 — —
NSR
40TBC 1.39×10-1 1.60×10-2 1.39×10-1 1.60×10-2 — —
50TBC 1.24×10-1 1.42×10-2 1.24×10-1 1.42×10-2 — —
70TBC 9.99×10-2 1.15×10-2 9.99×10-2 1.15×10-2 — —
15 1.23×10-1 2.07×10-2 1.23×10-1 2.07×10-2 1.04×10-1
20 9.60×10-2 1.71×10-2 9.60×10-2 1.71×10-2 8.00×10-2
20L 7.21×10-2 1.42×10-2 7.21×10-2 1.42×10-2 8.00×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
25 8.96×10 1.55×10 8.96×10 1.55×10 7.23×10-2
25L 6.99×10-2 1.31×10-2 6.99×10-2 1.31×10-2 7.23×10-2
30 8.06×10-2 1.33×10-2 8.06×10-2 1.33×10-2 5.61×10-2
30L 6.12×10-2 1.11×10-2 6.12×10-2 1.11×10-2 5.61×10-2
35 7.14×10-2 1.18×10-2 7.14×10-2 1.18×10-2 4.98×10-2
SRG -2 -3 -2 -3
35L 5.26×10 9.67×10 5.26×10 9.67×10 4.98×10-2
45 5.49×10-2 9.58×10-3 5.49×10-2 9.58×10-3 3.85×10-2
45L 4.18×10-2 7.93×10-3 4.18×10-2 7.93×10-3 3.85×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
55 4.56×10 8.04×10 4.56×10 8.04×10 3.25×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
55L 3.37×10 6.42×10 3.37×10 6.42×10 3.25×10-2
65L 2.63×10-2 4.97×10-3 2.63×10-2 4.97×10-3 2.70×10-2
85LC 2.19×10-2 4.15×10-3 2.19×10-2 4.15×10-3 1.91×10-2
100LC 1.95×10-2 3.67×10-3 1.95×10-2 3.67×10-3 1.62×10-2
-2 -2 -2 -2
35 7.14×10 1.18×10 7.14×10 1.18×10 4.98×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
35L 5.26×10 9.67×10 5.26×10 9.67×10 4.98×10-2
45 5.49×10-2 9.58×10-3 5.49×10-2 9.58×10-3 3.85×10-2
SRN 45L 4.18×10-2 7.93×10-3 4.18×10-2 7.93×10-3 3.85×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
55 4.56×10 8.04×10 4.56×10 8.04×10 3.25×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
55L 3.37×10 6.42×10 3.37×10 6.42×10 3.25×10-2
65L 2.63×10-2 4.97×10-3 2.63×10-2 4.97×10-3 2.70×10-2
70 4.18×10-2 7.93×10-3 4.18×10-2 7.93×10-3 2.52×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
85 3.37×10 6.42×10 3.37×10 6.42×10 2.09×10-2
-2 -3 -2 -3
SRW 100 2.63×10 4.97×10 2.63×10 4.97×10 1.77×10-2
130 2.19×10-2 4.15×10-3 2.19×10-2 4.15×10-3 1.33×10-2
150 1.95×10-2 3.67×10-3 1.95×10-2 3.67×10-3 1.15×10-2
KAR1 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when one KB1 : MB Equivalent factor when one LM block is used
LM block is used KB2 : MB Equivalent factor when two LM blocks are used in
KAL1 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction close contact with each other
when one LM block is used KCR : Equivalent factor in the MC radial direction
KAR2 : Equivalent factor in the MA radial direction when two KCL : Equivalent factor in the MC reverse radial direction
LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
KAL2 : Equivalent factor in the MA reverse radial direction when
two LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
A1-50
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
[Double-axis Use]
Setting Conditions
Set the conditions needed to calculate the LM system’s applied load and service life in hours.
The conditions consist of the following items.
(1) Mass: m (kg)
(2) Direction of the working load
(3) Position of the working point (e.g., center of gravity): ℓ2, ℓ3, h1(mm)
LM Guide
(4) Thrust position: ℓ4, h2(mm)
(5) LM system arrangement: ℓ0, ℓ1(mm)
(No. of units and axes)
(6) Velocity diagram
Speed: V (mm/s)
Time constant: tn (s)
Acceleration: n(mm/s2)
V
(αn = tn )
Duty cycle
ℓ1
ℓ2
Speed (mm/s)
mg
V
h 1 ℓ0
h2
ℓ3 tn t1 tn (s)
ℓ4 ℓS (mm)
Velocity diagram
Fig.6 Condition
A1-51
506E
Calculate the load applied to the LM Guide in each of the examples 1 to 10 shown below.
m : Mass (kg)
ℓn : Distance (mm)
Fn : External force (N)
Pn : Applied load (radial/reverse radial direction) (N)
PnT : Applied load (lateral directions) (N)
g : Gravitational acceleration (m/s2)
(g =9.8m/s2)
V : Speed (m/s)
tn : Time constant (s)
n : Acceleration (m/s2)
V
(αn = tn )
[Example]
Condition Applied Load Equation
Horizontal mount
(with the block traveling) mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P1 = + –
Uniform motion or dwell 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
P3 ℓ1
ℓ2 mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
mg P2 = – –
P2 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
P4
1
mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P3 = – +
P1 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
ℓ0
ℓ3 mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P4 = + +
4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P2 P2 = – +
P4 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
2
P1 mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P3 = – –
ℓ0 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
mg ℓ2 mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
ℓ3 P4 = + –
4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
A1-52
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
Vertical mount
Uniform motion or dwell
ℓ2
LM Guide
P4 mg•ℓ2
mg P1 = P4 = –
2•ℓ0
P1T
mg•ℓ2
P1 P2 = P3 =
ℓ0 2•ℓ0
3 F
mg•ℓ3
ℓ3 P1T = P4T =
2•ℓ0
P2 mg•ℓ3
P2T = P3T = –
2•ℓ0
P2T
ℓ1
E.g.: Vertical axis of industrial
robot, automatic coating
machine, lifter
Wall mount
Uniform motion or dwell
ℓ0
P2T
mg•ℓ3
ℓ2 P2 ℓ1 P1 = P2 = –
2•ℓ1
P1T
ℓ3 mg•ℓ3
P3 = P4 =
P1 2•ℓ1
4
mg mg•ℓ2
P1T = P4T = +
4 2•ℓ0
P3
mg mg•ℓ2
P3T P2T = P3T = –
4 2•ℓ0
mg
P4
P4T
A1-53
506E
ℓ1
–ℓ1
P2
mg
P3 mg mg•ℓ1
P1 to P4 (max) = +
P1 4 2•ℓ0
5 mg mg•ℓ1
P4 P1 to P4 (min) = –
4 2•ℓ0
ℓ0
ℓ2
E.g.: XY table
sliding fork
A1-54
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
LM Guide
P1T = +
2•ℓ0
P3 mg•cosθ mg•cosθ •ℓ2
P2 = + –
h1 P2 4 2•ℓ0
mg mg•cosθ •ℓ3 mg•sinθ•h1
P2T – –
2•ℓ1 2•ℓ0
P4
P1 ℓ2 mg•sinθ •ℓ3
P2T = –
ℓ0 2•ℓ0
7
θ mg•cosθ mg•cosθ •ℓ2
P1T P3 = + –
ℓ3 4 2•ℓ0
ℓ1 mg•cosθ •ℓ3 mg•sinθ•h1
+ –
2•ℓ1 2•ℓ0
mg•sinθ •ℓ3
P3T = –
2•ℓ0
mg•cosθ mg•cosθ •ℓ2
P4 = + +
4 2•ℓ0
E.g.: NC lathe
mg•cosθ •ℓ3 mg•sinθ •h1
Tool rest + +
2•ℓ1 2•ℓ0
mg•sinθ •ℓ3
P4T = +
2•ℓ0
tn P1 = P4 = +
4 2•ℓ0
mg m•α 3•ℓ2
P2 = P3 = –
4 2•ℓ0
t1 t2 t3 Time (s) m•α 3•ℓ3
P1T = P4T = –
2•ℓ0
Velocity diagram E.g.: Conveyance truck
m•α 3•ℓ3
P2T = P3T =
2•ℓ0
A1-55
506E
mg•ℓ3
P2T = P3T = –
2•ℓ0
t1 t2 t3 Time (s) During deceleration
Velocity diagram m (g – α 3) ℓ2
P1 = P4 = –
E.g.: Conveyance lift 2•ℓ0
m (g – α 3) ℓ2
P2 = P3 =
2•ℓ0
m (g – α 3) ℓ3
P1T = P4T =
2•ℓ0
m (g – α 3) ℓ3
P2T = P3T = –
2•ℓ0
A1-56
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Equivalent Load
LM Guide
rated load in the radial direction. With the radial type LM Guide, the rated load in the radial direction
is different from that in the reverse radial and lateral directions. The basic load rating in the radial
direction is indicated in the specification table. The values in the reverse-radial and lateral directions
are obtained from Table8 on A1-58.
[Rated Loads in All Directions]
Type Load Distribution Curve
0
4-way Equal Load Type
– 1/2π 1/2π
0
Radial Type
– 1/2π 1/2π
A1-57
506E
Model No.
Classification
A1-58
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Equivalent Load
LM Guide
[Equivalent Load Equation]
When the LM block of the LM Guide receives loads simultaneously in the radial and lateral direc-
tions, or the reverse radial and lateral directions, the equivalent load is obtained from the equation
below.
PE=X•PR(L)+Y•PT
A1-59
506E
Model No.
Classification Equivalent in Equivalent in reverse
radial direction radial direction
Type Size X Y X Y
SHS 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
SHW 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
SRS 12,15,25 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
SCR 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
EPF 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
HSR 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
NRS 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
HRW 17,21,27,35,50,60 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
RSR 3,5,7,9 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
RSR-Z 7,9 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
4-way Equal CSR 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
Load MX 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
JR 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
HCR 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
HMG 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
HSR-M1 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
RSR-M1 9 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
HSR-M2 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
HSR-M1VV 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
SRG 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
SRN 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
SRW 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000
SSR — — 1.000 1.155
SVR — — 1.000 1.678
SR 15,20,25,30,35,45,55,70 — — 1.000 1.155
SR 85,100,120,150 — — 1.000 2.000
Radial NR — — 1.000 2.000
HRW 12,14 — — 1.000 2.000
NSR — — 1.000 1.155
SR-M1 — — 1.000 1.155
SR-MS — — 1.000 1.155
SVS 1.000 0.935 1.000 1.020
SRS 5,7,9,20 1.000 0.839 1.000 0.839
RSR 12,14,15,20 1.000 0.830 1.000 0.990
RSR-Z 12,15 1.000 0.830 1.000 0.990
Other
HR 1.000 0.500 1.000 0.500
GSR 1.000 1.280 1.000 1.000
GSR-R 1.000 1.280 1.000 1.280
RSR-M1 12,15 1.000 0.830 1.000 0.990
Note) If the radial type LM Guide receives radial and lateral loads simultaneously, study the safety static factor and the rated
load in the radial-load and lateral-load directions.
For types with no size indication in the table, the same factor is applied to all sizes.
Models HR, GSR and GSR-R cannot be used in single-axis applications.
A1-60
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Static Safety Factor
LM Guide
load (whether stationary or in motion). Table10 shows reference values for the static safety factor.
A1-61
506E
Pm
Load (P)
P2
Pn
L1 L2 Ln
A1-62
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Average Load
1
Pm (Pmin + 2•Pmax) …………(3)
3
Pmin : Minimum load (N)
Pmax : Maximum load (N)
LM Guide
Pmax
Pm
Load (P)
Pmin
Pmax Pmax
Pm Pm
Load (P)
Load (P)
A1-63
506E
L = ( f •ff • f
H T
W
C
•
C
PC ) 50
1.57
L = ( F0
fW •PC
) 50
A1-64
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Nominal Life
10
f H • fT • fC
L = ( fW
•
C
PC
)3
100
LM Guide
C : Basic dynamic load rating (N)
PC : Calculated load (N)
fH : Hardness factor (see Fig.8 on A1-66)
fT : Temperature factor
(see Fig.9 on A1-66)
fC : Contact factor (see Table11 on A1-66)
fW : Load factor (see Table12 on A1-67)
Once the nominal life (L) has been obtained, the service life time can be obtained using the follow-
ing equation if the stroke length and the number reciprocations are constant.
L 106
Lh =
2 ℓS n1 60
Lh : Service life time (h)
ℓs : Stroke length (mm)
n1 : Number of reciprocations per minute
(min-1)
A1-65
506E
Hardness factor fH
sic dynamic load rating and the basic static load 0.7
rating decrease. Therefore, it is necessary to 0.6
multiply each rating by the respective hardness 0.5
factor (fH). 0.4
Since the LM Guide has sufficient hardness, the 0.3
fH value for the LM Guide is normally 1.0 unless 0.2
otherwise specified. 0.1
60 50 40 30 20 10
Raceway hardness (HRC)
Fig.8 Hardness Factor (fH)
[fT:Temperature Factor]
If the temperature of the environment surround-
ing the operating LM Guide exceeds 100℃, 1.0
Temperature factor fT
A1-66
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Nominal Life
LM Guide
Weak 1.2 to 1.5
tion are estimated to be significant, divide the 0.25<V≦1m/s
basic dynamic load rating (C) by a load factor Medium
Medium 1.5 to 2
1<V≦2m/s
selected from Table12, which contains empiri-
High
cally obtained data. Strong
V>2m/s
2 to 3.5
A1-67
506E
• Automatic packaging machine • Automatic coating machine • Grinding stone feed axis of
• XY axes of general industrial • Industrial robot grinding machine
machinery • various kinds of material high • Milling machine
• Automatic sash-manufacturing speed feeder • Vertical/horizontal boring ma-
machine • NC drilling machine chine
• Welding machine • Vertical axis of general indus- • Tool rest guide
• Flame cutting machine trial machinery • Vertical axis of machine tool
• Tool changer • Printed circuit board drilling
• Various kinds of material feeder machine
• Electric discharge machine
• Measuring instrument
• Precision XY table
A1-68
506E
Point of Selection
Predicting the Rigidity
LM Guide
Rigidity
When the LM Guide receives a load, its rolling element, LM blocks and LM rails are elastically de-
formed within a permissible load range. The ratio between the displacement and the load is called
rigidity value. (Rigidity values are obtained using the equation shown below.) The LM Guide’s rigidity
increases according to the magnitude of the preload. Fig.10 shows rigidity difference between nor-
mal, C1 and C0 clearances.
The effect of a preload for a 4-way equal load type is translated into the calculated load approx. 2.8
times greater than the magnitude of the preload.
2δ 0 Normal clearance
Clearance C1
Deflection
δ0 Clearance C0
P0 Load 2.8P0
P0 : Magnitude of clearance C0
P
K=
δ
A1-69
506E
[Radial clearance for model SSR] [Radial clearance for models SVR/SVS
Unit: m and NR/NRS]
Indication Unit: m
Normal Light preload
symbol Indication Light Medium
Normal
Model No. No Symbol C1 symbol preload preload
15 –4 to +2 –10 to –4 Model No. No Symbol C1 C0
20 –5 to +2 –12 to –5 25 –3 to +2 –6 to –3 –9 to –6
25 –6 to +3 –15 to –6 30 –4 to +2 –8 to –4 –12 to –8
30 –7 to +4 –18 to –7 35 –4 to +2 –8 to –4 –12 to –8
35 –8 to +4 –20 to –8 45 –5 to +3 –10 to –5 –15 to –10
55 –6 to +3 –11 to –6 –16 to –11
65 –8 to +3 –14 to –8 –20 to –14
75 –10 to +4 –17 to –10 –24 to –17
85 –13 to +4 –20 to –13 –27 to –20
100 –14 to +4 –24 to –14 –34 to –24
[Radial clearance for model SHW] [Radial clearance for model SRS]
Unit: m Unit: m
Indication Light Medium Indication
Normal Normal Light preload
symbol preload preload symbol
Model No. No Symbol C1 C0 Model No. No Symbol C1
12 –1.5 to 0 –4 to –1 — 5 0 to +1.5 –1 to 0
14 –2 to 0 –5 to –1 — 7 –2 to +2 –3 to 0
17 –3 to 0 –7 to –3 — 9 –2 to +2 –4 to 0
21 –4 to +2 –8 to –4 — 12 –3 to +3 –6 to 0
27 –5 to +2 –11 to –5 — 15 –5 to +5 –10 to 0
35 –8 to +4 –18 to –8 –28 to –18 20 –5 to +5 –10 to 0
50 –10 to +5 –24 to –10 –38 to –24 25 –7 to +7 –14 to 0
A1-70
506E
Point of Selection
Predicting the Rigidity
LM Guide
12 –3 to +3 –6 to –2 — 65 –14 to +7 –32 to –14 –50 to –32
15 –4 to +2 –12 to –4 — 85 –16 to +8 –36 to –16 –56 to –36
20 –5 to +2 –14 to –5 –23 to –14 100 –19 to +9 –42 to –19 –65 to –42
25 –6 to +3 –16 to –6 –26 to –16 120 –21 to +10 –47 to –21 –73 to –47
30 –7 to +4 –19 to –7 –31 to –19 150 –23 to +11 –51 to –23 –79 to –51
35 –8 to +4 –22 to –8 –35 to –22
[Model HSR Grade Ct Radial Clearance] [Radial clearances for models SR and SR-M1]
Unit: m Unit: m
Indication symbol Normal Indication Light Medium
Normal
Model No. No Symbol symbol preload preload
15 –8 to +2 Model No. No Symbol C1 C0
20 –14 to +2 15 –4 to +2 –10 to –4 —
[Radial clearance for model HRW] [Radial clearance for models RSR, RSR-W,
Unit: m RSR-Z, RSR-WZ and RSR-M1]
Indication Light Medium Unit: m
Normal
symbol preload preload Indication
Normal Light preload
Model No. No Symbol C1 C0 symbol
12 –1.5 to +1.5 –4 to –1 — Model No. No Symbol C1
14 –2 to +2 –5 to –1 — 3 0 to +1 –0.5 to 0
17 –3 to +2 –7 to –3 — 5 0 to +1.5 –1 to 0
21 –4 to +2 –8 to –4 — 7 –2 to +2 –3 to 0
27 –5 to +2 –11 to –5 — 9 –2 to +2 –4 to 0
35 –8 to +4 –18 to –8 –28 to –18 12 –3 to +3 –6 to 0
50 –10 to +5 –24 to –10 –38 to –24 14 –5 to +5 –10 to 0
60 –12 to +5 –27 to –12 –42 to –27 15 –5 to +5 –10 to 0
20 –7 to +7 –14 to 0
A1-71
506E
[Radial clearance for model MX] [Radial clearance for model JR]
Unit: m Unit: m
Indication Indication symbol Normal
Normal Light preload
symbol Model No. No Symbol
Model No. No Symbol C1 25 0 to +30
5 0 to +1.5 –1 to 0 35 0 to +30
7 –2 to +2 –3 to 0 45 0 to +50
55 0 to +50
[Radial clearances for models HCR and HMG] [Radial clearance for model NSR-TBC]
Unit: m Unit: m
Indication Indication Light Medium
Normal Light preload Normal
symbol symbol preload preload
Model No. No Symbol C1 Model No. No Symbol C1 C0
12 –3 to +3 –6 to –2 20 –5 to +5 –15 to –5 –25 to –15
15 –4 to +2 –12 to –4 25 –5 to +5 –15 to –5 –25 to –15
25 –6 to +3 –16 to –6 30 –5 to +5 –15 to –5 –25 to –15
35 –8 to +4 –22 to –8 40 –8 to +8 –22 to –8 –36 to –22
45 –10 to +5 –25 to –10 50 –8 to +8 –22 to –8 –36 to –22
65 –14 to +7 –32 to –14 70 –10 to +10 –26 to –10 –42 to –26
[Radial clearance for model HSR-M2] [Radial clearances for models SRG and SRN]
Unit: m Unit: m
Indication Indication Light Medium
Normal Light preload Normal
symbol symbol preload preload
Model No. No Symbol C1 Model No. No Symbol C1 C0
15 –4 to +2 –12 to –4 15 –0.5 to 0 –1 to –0.5 –2 to –1
20 –5 to +2 –14 to –5 20 –0.8 to 0 –2 to –0.8 –3 to –2
25 –6 to +3 –16 to –6 25 –2 to –1 –3 to –2 –4 to –3
30 –2 to –1 –3 to –2 –4 to –3
35 –2 to –1 –3 to –2 –5 to –3
45 –2 to –1 –3 to –2 –5 to –3
55 –2 to –1 –4 to –2 –6 to –4
65 –3 to –1 –5 to –3 –8 to –5
85 –3 to –1 –7 to –3 –12 to –7
100 –3 to –1 –8 to –3 –13 to –8
[Radial clearance for model SRW] [Radial clearance for model EPF]
Unit: m Unit: m
Indication Light Medium Indication symbol Normal
Normal
symbol preload preload Model No. No Symbol
Model No. No Symbol C1 C0 7M
70 –2 to –1 –3 to –2 –5 to –3 9M
85 –2 to –1 –4 to –2 –6 to –4 0 or less
12M
100 –3 to –1 –5 to –3 –8 to –5 15M
130 –3 to –1 –7 to –3 –12 to –7
150 –3 to –1 –8 to –3 –13 to –8
A1-72
506E
Point of Selection
Predicting the Rigidity
LM Guide
A1-73
506E
[Running of Parallelism]
It refers to the tolerance for parallelism between the LM block and the LM rail reference surface
when the LM block travels the whole length of the LM rail with the LM rail secured on the reference
reference surface using bolts.
[Difference in Height M]
Indicates a difference between the minimum and maximum values of height (M) of each of the LM
blocks used on the same plane in combination.
Serial number
Note2) Accuracy measurements each represent the average value of the central point or the central area of the LM block.
Note3) The LM rail is smoothly curved so that the required accuracy is easily achieved by pressing the rail to the reference
surface of the machine.
If it is mounted on a less rigid base such as an aluminum base, the curve of the rail will affect the accuracy of the ma-
chine. Therefore, it is necessary to define straightness of the rail in advance.
A1-74
506E
Point of Selection
Determining the Accuracy
LM Guide
Type of machine
Ct7 Ct5 Normal H P SP UP
Machining center ● ●
Lathe ● ●
Milling machine ● ●
Boring machine ● ●
Jig borer ● ●
Grinding machine ● ●
Machine tool
Cartesian coordinate ● ● ●
robot
Cylindrical coordinate ● ●
Wire bonding machine ● ●
Semiconductor
manufacturing
equipment
Prober ● ●
Electronic component inserter ● ●
Printed circuit board drilling ● ● ●
machine
Injection molding machine ● ●
3D measuring instrument ● ●
Office equipment ● ● ● ●
Other equipment
Conveyance system ● ● ● ●
XY table ● ● ●
Coating machine ● ● ● ●
Welding machine ● ● ● ●
Medical equipment ● ●
Digitizer ● ● ●
Inspection equipment ● ● ●
Ct7 : Grade Ct7 P : Precision grade
Ct5 : Grade Ct5 SP : Super precision grade
Normal : Normal grade UP : Ultra precision grade
H : High accuracy grade
A1-75
506E
A B
W2
Fig.13
A1-76
506E
Point of Selection
Determining the Accuracy
Table16 Accuracy Standards for Models SHS, SSR, SVR/SVS, SHW, HSR, SR, NR/NRS, HRW, NSR-TBC,
HSR-M1, HSR-M1VV, SR-M1, HSR-M2, SRG, and SRN.
Unit: mm
High- Super Ultra
Grade Grade Normal Precision
Model Accuracy standards accuracy precision precision
Ct7 Ct5 grade grade
No. grade grade grade
Item Ct7 Ct5 No Symbol H P SP UP
Dimensional tolerance in height M — — 0.07 0.03 0.015 0.007 —
LM Guide
Difference in height M — — 0.015 0.007 0.005 0.003 —
8 Dimensional tolerance in width W2 — — 0.04 0.02 0.01 0.007 —
10 Difference in width W2 — — 0.02 0.01 0.006 0.004 —
12 Running parallelism of surface C
14 against surface A C (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
Running parallelism of surface D
against surface B D (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
0 0 0
Dimensional tolerance in height M 0.12 0.12 0.07 0.03
–0.03 –0.015 –0.008
Difference in height M 0.025 0.025 0.02 0.01 0.006 0.004 0.003
15 0 0 0
Dimensional tolerance in width W2 0.12 0.12 0.06 0.03
17 –0.02 –0.015 –0.008
20 Difference in width W2 0.025 0.025 0.02 0.01 0.006 0.004 0.003
21 Running parallelism of surface C
against surface A C (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
Running parallelism of surface D
against surface B D (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
0 0 0
Dimensional tolerance in height M 0.12 0.12 0.08 0.04
–0.04 –0.02 –0.01
Difference in height M 0.025 0.025 0.02 0.015 0.007 0.005 0.003
25 0 0 0
Dimensional tolerance in width W2 0.12 0.12 0.07 0.03
27 –0.03 –0.015 –0.01
30 Difference in width W2 0.035 0.035 0.025 0.015 0.007 0.005 0.003
35 Running parallelism of surface C
against surface A C (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
Running parallelism of surface D
against surface B D (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
0 0 0
Dimensional tolerance in height M — — 0.08 0.04
–0.05 –0.03 –0.015
Difference in height M — — 0.025 0.015 0.007 0.005 0.003
40
0 0 0
45 Dimensional tolerance in width W2 — — 0.07 0.04
–0.04 –0.025 –0.015
50
55 Difference in width W2 — — 0.03 0.015 0.007 0.005 0.003
60 Running parallelism of surface C
against surface A C (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
Running parallelism of surface D
against surface B
D (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
0 0 0
Dimensional tolerance in height M — — 0.08 0.04
–0.05 –0.04 –0.03
65 Difference in height M — — 0.03 0.02 0.01 0.007 0.005
70
0 0 0
75 Dimensional tolerance in width W2 — — 0.08 0.04
–0.05 –0.04 –0.03
85
100 Difference in width W2 — — 0.03 0.02 0.01 0.007 0.005
120 Running parallelism of surface C
against surface A
C (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
150
Running parallelism of surface D
against surface B
D (as shown in Table15 A1-76)
Note) XFor models SRG and SRN, only precision or higher grades apply. (Ct7 grade, Ct5 grade, normal grade and high ac-
curacy grade are not available.)
Note) Ct7 and Ct5 class are only applicable for model HSR.
Note) The difference between Ct7 grade and Ct5 grade pairs with a height M and a width W2 is the value for one shaft.
A1-77
506E
D
C
A
W2
B
Fig.14
Table17 Model HMG Accuracy Standard Table18 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism
Unit: mm by Accuracy Standard
Model Accuracy Standards Normal grade Unit: m
No. Item No symbol LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
Dimensional tolerance in Above Or less Normal grade
0.1
height M — 125 30
Difference in height M 0.02 125 200 37
Dimensional tolerance in 200 250 40
0.1
width W2 250 315 44
15 Difference in width W2 0.02 315 400 49
Running parallelism of 400 500 53
C
surface C against 500 630 58
(as shown in Table18)
surface A
630 800 64
Running parallelism of
D 800 1000 70
surface D against
(as shown in Table18) 1000 1250 77
surface B
Dimensional tolerance in 1250 1600 84
0.1 1600 2000 92
height M
Difference in height M 0.02
Dimensional tolerance in
0.1
width W2
25 Difference in width W2 0.03
35 Running parallelism of
C
surface C against
(as shown in Table18)
surface A
Running parallelism of
D
surface D against
(as shown in Table18)
surface B
Dimensional tolerance in
0.1
height M
Difference in height M 0.03
Dimensional tolerance in
0.1
width W2
45 Difference in width W2 0.03
65 Running parallelism of
C
surface C against
(as shown in Table18)
surface A
Running parallelism of
D
surface D against
(as shown in Table18)
surface B
A1-78
506E
Point of Selection
Determining the Accuracy
● Accuracies of model HCR are categorized into normal and high accuracy grades by model num-
ber as indicated in Table19.
C
LM Guide
A
Fig.15
Table19 Accuracy Standard for Model HCR Table20 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism
Unit: mm by Accuracy Standard
Normal High-accuracy Unit: m
Model Accuracy standards
grade grade LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
No.
Item No Symbol H High-accuracy
Above Or less Normal grade
Dimensional tolerance in grade
0.2 0.2
12 height M — 125 30 15
15 Difference in height M 0.05 0.03 125 200 37 18
25 Running parallelism 200 250 40 20
35 C
of surface C against 250 315 44 22
(as shown in Table20)
surface A 315 400 49 24
Dimensional tolerance in
0.2 0.2 400 500 53 26
height M
500 630 58 29
45 Difference in height M 0.06 0.04
65 630 800 64 32
Running parallelism
C 800 1000 70 35
of surface C against
(as shown in Table20) 1000 1250 77 38
surface A
1250 1600 84 42
1600 2000 92 46
● Accuracies of model JR are defined by model number as indicated in Table21.
A1-79
506E
● Accuracies of models SCR and CSR are categorized into precision, super precision and ultra pre-
cision grades by model number as indicated in Table23.
E F D C
A B
Fig.17
Table23 Accuracy Standard for Models SCR and CSR Table24 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism
Unit: mm by Accuracy Standard
Super Ultra Unit: m
Precision
Model Accuracy standards precision precision LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
grade
No. grade grade
Item P SP UP Super Ultra
Precision
Difference in height M 0.01 0.007 0.005 Above Or less precision precision
grade
grade grade
Perpendicularity of surface
0.005 0.004 0.003 — 50 2 1.5 1
D against surface B
15
20 Running parallelism of C 50 80 2 1.5 1
surface E against surface B (as shown inTable24) 80 125 2 1.5 1
Running parallelism of D
surface F against surface D (as shown in Table24) 125 200 2 1.5 1
Difference in height M 0.01 0.007 0.005 200 250 2.5 1.5 1
Perpendicularity of surface 250 315 3 1.5 1
0.008 0.006 0.004
D against surface B
315 400 3.5 2 1.5
25 Running parallelism of C
surface E against surface B (as shown in Table24) 400 500 4.5 2.5 1.5
Running parallelism of D 500 630 5 3 2
surface F against surface D (as shown in Table24)
630 800 6 3.5 2
Difference in height M 0.01 0.007 0.005
Perpendicularity of surface 800 1000 6.5 4 2.5
0.01 0.007 0.005
D against surface B 1000 1250 7.5 4.5 3
30
35 Running parallelism of C 1250 1600 8 5 4
surface E against surface B (as shown in Table24)
1600 2000 8.5 5.5 4.5
Running parallelism of D
surface F against surface D (as shown in Table24) 2000 2500 9.5 6 5
Difference in height M 0.012 0.008 0.006 2500 3090 11 6.5 5.5
Perpendicularity of surface
0.012 0.008 0.006
D against surface B
45 Running parallelism of C
surface E against surface B (as shown in Table24)
Running parallelism of D
surface F against surface D (as shown in Table24)
Difference in height M 0.018 0.012 0.009
Perpendicularity of surface
0.018 0.012 0.009
D against surface B
65 Running parallelism of C
surface E against surface B (as shown in Table24)
Running parallelism of D
surface F against surface D (as shown in Table24)
A1-80
506E
Point of Selection
Determining the Accuracy
● Accuracies of model HR are categorized into normal, high accuracy, precision, super precision
and ultra precision grades as indicated in Table25.
B
M
LM Guide
A W0
Fig.18
Table25 Accuracy Standard for Model HR Unit: mm
High- Super Ultra
Normal Precision
Accuracy standards accuracy precision precision
grade grade
grade grade grade
Item No Symbol H P SP UP
Dimensional tolerance in height M 0.1 0.05 0.025 0.015 0.01
Difference in height M Note 1) 0.03 0.02 0.01 0.005 0.003
Dimensional tolerance for total width W0 0.1 0.05
Difference in total width W0Note 2) 0.03 0.015 0.01 0.005 0.003
Parallelism of the raceway against
C (as shown in Table26)
surfaces A and B
Note1) Difference in height M applies to a set of LM Guides used on the same plane.
Note2) Difference in total width W0 applies to LM blocks used in combination on one LM rail.
Note3) Dimensional tolerance and difference in total width W0 for precision and higher grades apply only to the master-rail
side among a set of LM Guides. The master rail is imprinted with “KB” following a serial number.
Table26 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism by Accuracy Standard Unit: m
LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
Above Or less Normal grade High-accuracy grade Precision grade Super precision grade Ultra precision grade
— 50 5 3 2 1.5 1
50 80 5 3 2 1.5 1
80 125 5 3 2 1.5 1
125 200 5 3.5 2 1.5 1
200 250 6 4 2.5 1.5 1
250 315 7 4.5 3 1.5 1
315 400 8 5 3.5 2 1.5
400 500 9 6 4.5 2.5 1.5
500 630 11 7 5 3 2
630 800 12 8.5 6 3.5 2
800 1000 13 9 6.5 4 2.5
1000 1250 15 11 7.5 4.5 3
1250 1600 16 12 8 5 4
1600 2000 18 13 8.5 5.5 4.5
2000 2500 20 14 9.5 6 5
2500 3000 21 16 11 6.5 5.5
A1-81
506E
● Accuracies of model GSR are categorized into normal, high accuracy and precision grades by
model number as indicated in Table27.
C Table28 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism
by Accuracy Standard
Unit: m
D
LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
M
High-accuracy Precision
Above Or less Normal grade
grade grade
— 50 5 3 2
A 50 80 5 3 2
B
80 125 5 3 2
Fig.19
125 200 5 3.5 2
Table27 Accuracy Standard for Model GSR
Unit: mm 200 250 6 4 2.5
● Accuracies of model GSR-R are categorized into normal and high accuracy grades by model
number as indicated in Table29.
Table30 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism
C by Accuracy Standard
Unit: m
D LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
M High-accuracy
Above Or less Normal grade
grade
— 50 5 3
50 80 5 3
A
B 80 125 5 3
Fig.20 125 200 5 3.5
200 250 6 4
Table29 Accuracy Standard for GSR-R 250 315 7 4.5
Unit: mm 315 400 8 5
Normal High-accuracy 400 500 9 6
Model Accuracy standards grade grade
No. 500 630 11 7
Item No Symbol H
630 800 12 8.5
Dimensional tolerance
0.03 800 1000 13 9
in height M
25
Running parallelism of C 1000 1250 15 11
30
surface C against surface A (as shown in Table30)
35 1250 1600 16 12
Running parallelism of D
surface D against surface B (as shown in Table30) 1600 2000 18 13
A1-82
506E
Point of Selection
Determining the Accuracy
● Accuracies of models SRS, RSR, RSR-M1, RSR-W, RSR-Z and RSR-WZ are categorized into nor-
mal, high accuracy and precision grades by model number as indicated in Table31.
C Table33 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism for Models
SRS7 to 25 and RSR7 to 25 by Accuracy Standard
D Unit: m
M LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
High-
Normal Precision
LM Guide
B Above Or less accuracy
A grade grade
grade
W2
— 40 8 4 1
Fig.21 40 70 10 4 1
Table31 Accuracy Standards for Models SRS, RSR, 70 100 11 4 2
RSR-M1, RSR-W, RSR-Z and RSR-WZ 100 130 12 5 2
Unit: mm 130 160 13 6 2
160 190 14 7 2
High- 190 220 15 7 3
Accuracy Normal Precision
accuracy 220 250 16 8 3
Model standards grade grade
grade 250 280 17 8 3
No.
No 280 310 17 9 3
Item H P
Symbol 310 340 18 9 3
Dimensional toler- 340 370 18 10 3
0.03 — 0.015 370 400 19 10 3
ance in height M
Difference in height M 0.015 — 0.005 400 430 20 11 4
430 460 20 12 4
Dimensional toler-
0.03 — 0.015 460 490 21 12 4
ance in width W2 490 520 21 12 4
3 Difference in width W2 0.015 — 0.005 520 550 22 12 4
5 550 580 22 13 4
Running parallelism
of surface C against C (as shown in Table32) 580 610 22 13 4
surface A 610 640 22 13 4
Running parallelism 640 670 23 13 4
of surface D against D (as shown in Table32) 670 700 23 13 5
surface B 700 730 23 14 5
730 760 23 14 5
Dimensional toler-
0.04 0.02 0.01 760 790 23 14 5
ance in height M
790 820 23 14 5
Difference in height M 0.03 0.015 0.007 820 850 24 14 5
7 Dimensional toler-
9 0.04 0.025 0.015 850 880 24 15 5
ance in width W2 880 910 24 15 5
12
14 Difference in width W2 0.03 0.02 0.01 910 940 24 15 5
15 Running parallelism 940 970 24 15 5
20 of surface C against C (as shown in Table33) 970 1000 25 16 5
25 surface A 1000 1030 25 16 5
Running parallelism 1030 1060 25 16 6
of surface D against D (as shown in Table33) 1060 1090 25 16 6
surface B 1090 1120 25 16 6
1120 1150 25 16 6
Table32 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism for Models 1150 1180 26 17 6
SRS5, RSR3 and RSR5 by Accuracy Standard 1180 1210 26 17 6
Unit: m 1210 1240 26 17 6
1240 1270 26 17 6
LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values 1270 1300 26 17 6
Precision 1300 1330 26 17 6
Above Or less Normal grade
grade 1330 1360 27 18 6
— 25 2.5 1.5 1360 1390 27 18 6
25 50 3.5 2 1390 1420 27 18 6
50 100 5.5 3 1420 1450 27 18 7
1450 1480 27 18 7
100 150 7 4
1480 1510 27 18 7
150 200 8.4 5 1510 1540 28 19 7
1540 1570 28 19 7
1570 1800 28 19 7
A1-83
506E
● Accuracies of model MX are categorized into normal and precision grades by model number as
indicated in Table34.
E F D
C
M
A
B
Fig.22
Table34 Accuracy Standard for Model MX Table36 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism for Model
Unit: mm MX7 by Accuracy Standard
Unit: m
Normal Precision
Accuracy standards
Model grade grade LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
No. No
Item P Normal Precision
Symbol Above Or less
grade grade
Difference in height M 0.015 0.005 — 40 8 1
Perpendicularity of
40 70 10 1
surface D against 0.003 0.002
surface B 70 100 11 2
5 Running parallelism
C
of surface E against 100 130 12 2
(as shown in Table35)
surface B
Running parallelism 130 160 13 2
D
of surface F against
(as shown in Table35) 160 190 14 2
surface D
Difference in height M 0.03 0.007 190 220 15 3
Perpendicularity of
surface D against 0.01 0.005 220 250 16 3
surface B 250 280 17 3
7 Running parallelism
C
of surface E against 280 310 17 3
(as shown in Table36)
surface B
Running parallelism 310 340 18 3
D
of surface F against
(as shown in Table36) 340 370 18 3
surface D
370 400 19 3
A1-84
506E
Point of Selection
Determining the Accuracy
● Accuracies of model SRW are categorized into precision, super precision and ultra precision
grades by model number as indicated in Table37.
C
LM Guide
M
B
A W2
Fig.23
Table37 Accuracy Standard for Model SRW Table38 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism
Unit: mm by Accuracy Standard
Unit: m
Preci- Super Ultra
Accuracy
Model sion precision precision LM rail length (mm) Running Parallelism Values
standards
No. grade grade grade
Preci- Super Ultra
Item P SP UP
Above Or less sion precision precision
Dimensional toler- 0 0 0 grade grade grade
ance in height M –0.05 –0.03 –0.015
— 50 2 1.5 1
Difference in height M 0.007 0.005 0.003
50 80 2 1.5 1
Dimensional toler- 0 0 0
80 125 2 1.5 1
ance in width W2 –0.04 –0.025 –0.015
70 125 200 2 1.5 1
85 Difference in width W2 0.007 0.005 0.003
Running parallelism 200 250 2.5 1.5 1
C
of surface C against 250 315 3 1.5 1
(as shown in Table38)
surface A
Running parallelism 315 400 3.5 2 1.5
D
of surface D against 400 500 4.5 2.5 1.5
(as shown in Table38)
surface B 500 630 5 3 2
Dimensional toler- 0 0 0
ance in height M –0.05 –0.04 –0.03 630 800 6 3.5 2
Difference in height M 0.01 0.007 0.005 800 1000 6.5 4 2.5
Dimensional toler- 0 0 0 1000 1250 7.5 4.5 3
ance in width W2 –0.05 –0.04 –0.03 1250 1600 8 5 4
100 Difference in width W2 0.01 0.007 0.005 1600 2000 8.5 5.5 4.5
Running parallelism
C 2000 2500 9.5 6 5
of surface C against
(as shown in Table38) 2500 3090 11 6.5 5.5
surface A
Running parallelism
D
of surface D against
(as shown in Table38)
surface B
Dimensional toler- 0 0 0
ance in height M –0.05 –0.04 –0.03
Difference in height M 0.01 0.007 0.005
Dimensional toler- 0 0 0
ance in width W2 –0.05 –0.04 –0.03
130
150 Difference in width W2 0.01 0.007 0.005
Running parallelism
C
of surface C against
(as shown in Table38)
surface A
Running parallelism
D
of surface D against
(as shown in Table38)
surface B
A1-85
506E
● Accuracies of model EPF are categorized into normal, high accuracy and precision grades by model number as indicated in Table39.
Table39 Accuracy Standard for Model EPF
Unit: mm
C
High-
Accuracy Normal Precision
accuracy
Model Standards grade grade
D grade
No.
M No
Item H P
Symbol
Dimensional toler-
W2 0.04 0.02 0.01
ance in height M
A
B Difference in height M 0.03 0.015 0.007
7M
Dimensional toler-
9M 0.04 0.025 0.015
Fig.24 ance in width W2
12M
15M Running parallelism of sur- 0.008 0.004 0.001
face C against surface ANote)
Running parallelism of sur-
0.008 0.004 0.001
face D against surface BNote)
Note) If the stroke is more than 40 mm, contact THK.
● Accuracies of model SR-MS are categorized into precision, super precision and ultra precision
grades by model number as indicated in Table40.
Table41 LM Rail Length and Running Parallelism
C by Accuracy Standard
Unit: m
A1-86
506E
LM Guide
Features and Dimensions of Each Model
A1-87
506E
Endplate
End seal
Ball
Ball cage
LM rail
Grease pocket
Fig.2 Circulation Structure inside the LM Block of the Caged Ball LM Guide
With the Caged Ball LM Guide, the use of a ball cage allows lines of evenly spaced balls to circu-
late, thus to eliminate friction between the balls.
In addition, grease held in a space between the ball circulation path and the ball cage (grease pock-
et) is applied on the contact surface between each ball and the ball cage as the ball rotates, forming
an oil film on the ball surface. As a result, an oil film is not easily broken.
A1-88
506E
LM Guide
(4) The circulation of lines of evenly spaced balls ensures smooth ball rotation.
(5) The absence of friction between balls allows high grease retention and low dust generation.
3
C
L= ( ) × 50
P
L : Nominal life (km)
C : Basic dynamic load rating (N)
P : Applied load (N)
As indicated in the equation, the greater the basic dynamic load rating, the longer the nominal
life of the LM Guide.
[Example of Calculation]
Comparison of Nominal Life Between the Caged Ball LM Guide model SHS25V and the Conven-
tional Full-ball Type Model HSR25A
Calculation Assuming P = 11.1kN
Basic dynamic rated load (C) of SHS25V = 31.7kN
Basic dynamic rated load (C) of HSR25A = 19.9kN
3 3
C 31.7
Model SHS25V L= ( ) P ( )
× 50 =
11.1
× 50 = 1160 km
3 3
C 19.9
L= (
P )
× 50 = (
11.1 )
Model HSR25A × 50 = 280 km
The nominal life of the Caged Ball LM Guide model SHS25V is 4.0 times* longer than the conventional full-ball
type model HSR25A.
*When selecting a model number, it is necessary to perform a service life calculation according to the conditions.
A1-89
506E
[Condition]
Model No. : SHS25/HSR25
Speed : 60m/min
Stroke : 350mm
Acceleration: 9.8m/s2
Orientation : horizontal
Load : Caged Ball LM Guide model SHS: 11.1kN
Conventional full-ball type model HSR: 9.8kN
HSR25
(Conventional full-ball type) L = 435 km
Lubricated every 100 km
Nominal life: 400 km L = 1347 km
SHS25
(Caged Ball LM Guide)
Initial lubrication only
A1-90
506E
LM Guide
90
50
80
Noise level (dBA)
40
50 20
SHS35LV
40 10 SHS35LV
9.6dBA
30 0
0 25 50 75 100 125
0 2000 4000 6000 8000 10000 12000 14000
Speed (m/min) Frequency (Hz)
Comparison of Noise Levels between Model SHS35LV and Comparison of Noise Levels between Model SHS35LV and
Model HSR35LR Model HSR35LR (at speed of 50 m/min)
[High Speed]
High-speed Durability Test Data
Since use of a ball cage eliminates friction between balls, only a low level of heat is generated and
superbly high speed is achieved.
[Condition]
Model No. : Caged Ball LM Guide Model SHS65LVSS
Speed : 200m/min
Stroke : 2500mm
Calculated service life 19718km
Lubrication : initial lubrication only
Applied load: 34.5kN
Travel distance
Acceleration: 1.5G
30000km
A1-91
506E
[Smooth Motion]
Rolling Resistance Data
Use of a ball cage allows the balls to be uniformly aligned and prevents a line of balls from meander-
ing as they enter the LM block. This enables smooth and stable motion to be achieved, minimizes
fluctuations in rolling resistance, and ensures high accuracy, in any mounting orientation.
Model SHS25LV: Caged Ball LM Guide
Model HSR25LR: conventional full-ball type
20 20
Rolling resistance (N)
300 300
200 200
100 100
0 0
0 5 10 15 20 0 5 10 15 20
Time (hour) Time (hour)
Conventional Full-ball Type Caged Ball LM Guide Model SSR20
A1-92
506E
LM Guide
A1-93
506E
SHS
Caged Ball LM Guide Global Standard Size Model SHS
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
End seal
45°
Ball
°
45
Ball cage
Cross section
A1-94
506E
SHS
LM Guide
Guide to be used in all orientations. In addition, the LM block can receive a well-balanced preload,
increasing the rigidity in the four directions while maintaining a constant, low friction coefficient. With
the low sectional height and the high rigidity design of the LM block, this model achieves highly ac-
curate and stable straight motion.
[Self-adjustment Capability]
The self-adjustment capability through front-to-front configuration of THK’s unique circular-arc
grooves (DF set) enables a mounting error to be absorbed even under a preload, thus to achieve
highly accurate, smooth straight motion.
A1-95
506E
A1-96
506E
SHS
LM Guide
Model SHS-LV Specification Table⇒A1-100
The LM block has the same cross-sectional shape
as model SHS-V, but has a longer overall LM
block length (L) and a greater rated load.
A1-97
506E
T1 T
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
SHS
(E) L
4- φ D0
**
L1 e0
C
f0
φ d2
LM Guide
N
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
H3 0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
14.2 24.2 0.175 0.898 0.175 0.898 0.16 0.23
3 15 16 13 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 1.3
17.2 31.9 0.296 1.43 0.296 1.43 0.212 0.29
22.3 38.4 0.334 1.75 0.334 1.75 0.361 0.46
4.6 20 21.5 16.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 3000 2.3
28.1 50.3 0.568 2.8 0.568 2.8 0.473 0.61
31.7 52.4 0.566 2.75 0.566 2.75 0.563 0.72
5.8 23 23.5 20 60 7×11×9 3000 3.2
36.8 64.7 0.848 3.98 0.848 3.98 0.696 0.89
44.8 66.6 0.786 4.08 0.786 4.08 0.865 1.34
7 28 31 23 80 9×14×12 3000 4.5
54.2 88.8 1.36 6.6 1.36 6.6 1.15 1.66
62.3 96.6 1.38 6.76 1.38 6.76 1.53 1.9
7.5 34 33 26 80 9×14×12 3000 6.2
72.9 127 2.34 10.9 2.34 10.9 2.01 2.54
82.8 126 2.05 10.1 2.05 10.1 2.68 3.24
8.9 45 37.5 32 105 14×20×17 3090 10.4
100 166 3.46 16.3 3.46 16.3 3.53 4.19
128 197 3.96 19.3 3.96 19.3 4.9 5.35
12.7 53 43.5 38 120 16×23×20 3060 14.5
161 259 6.68 31.1 6.68 31.1 6.44 6.97
205 320 8.26 40.4 8.26 40.4 9.4 10.7
19 63 53.5 53 150 18×26×22 3000 23.7
253 408 13.3 62.6 13.3 62.6 11.9 13.7
**
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-104.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-99
506E
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
SHS
(E) L
4- φ D0
**
L1 e0
C
f0
φ d2 N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
H3 0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
Options⇒A1-473 A1-101
506E
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SHS
(E) L
4- φ D0
**
L1 e0
C
φ d2 N f0
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
H3 0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3 15 9.5 13 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 14.2 24.2 0.175 0.898 0.175 0.898 0.16 0.22 1.3
31.7 52.4 0.566 2.75 0.566 2.75 0.563 0.66
5.8 23 12.5 20 60 7×11×9 3000 3.2
36.8 64.7 0.848 3.98 0.848 3.98 0.696 0.8
44.8 66.6 0.786 4.08 0.786 4.08 0.865 1.04
7 28 16 23 80 9×14×12 3000 4.5
54.2 88.8 1.36 6.6 1.36 6.6 1.15 1.36
62.3 96.6 1.38 6.76 1.38 6.76 1.53 1.8
7.5 34 18 26 80 9×14×12 3000 6.2
72.9 127 2.34 10.9 2.34 10.9 2.01 2.34
82.8 126 2.05 10.1 2.05 10.1 2.68 3.24
8.9 45 20.5 32 105 14×20×17 3090 10.4
100 166 3.46 16.3 3.46 16.3 3.53 4.19
128 197 3.96 19.3 3.96 19.3 4.9 5.05
12.7 53 23.5 38 120 16×23×20 3060 14.5
161 259 6.68 31.1 6.68 31.1 6.44 6.57
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples** are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-104.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-103
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SHS Unit: mm
Model No. SHS 15 SHS 20 SHS 25 SHS 30 SHS 35 SHS 45 SHS 55 SHS 65
160 220 220 280 280 570 780 1270
220 280 280 360 360 675 900 1570
280 340 340 440 440 780 1020 2020
340 400 400 520 520 885 1140 2620
400 460 460 600 600 990 1260
460 520 520 680 680 1095 1380
520 580 580 760 760 1200 1500
580 640 640 840 840 1305 1620
640 700 700 920 920 1410 1740
700 760 760 1000 1000 1515 1860
760 820 820 1080 1080 1620 1980
820 940 940 1160 1160 1725 2100
940 1000 1000 1240 1240 1830 2220
1000 1060 1060 1320 1320 1935 2340
1060 1120 1120 1400 1400 2040 2460
LM rail standard
1120 1180 1180 1480 1480 2145 2580
length (L0)
1180 1240 1240 1560 1560 2250 2700
1240 1360 1300 1640 1640 2355 2820
1360 1480 1360 1720 1720 2460 2940
1480 1600 1420 1800 1800 2565 3060
1600 1720 1480 1880 1880 2670
1840 1540 1960 1960 2775
1960 1600 2040 2040 2880
2080 1720 2200 2200 2985
2200 1840 2360 2360 3090
1960 2520 2520
2080 2680 2680
2200 2840 2840
2320 3000 3000
2440
A1-104
506E
SHS
Clearance
LM Guide
ℓ1
S1 F
(1) Determine the bolt length so that a clearance Table2 Dimensions of the LM Rail Tap
Unit: mm
of 2 to 5 mm is secured between the bolt
end and the bottom of the tap (effective tap Model No. S1 Effective tap depth ℓ1
depth). (See figure above.) SHS 15 M5 8
(2) For standard pitches of the taps, see Table1 SHS 20 M6 10
on A1-104. SHS 25 M6 12
SHS 30 M8 15
SHS 35 M8 17
SHS 45 M12 20
SHS 55 M14 24
SHS 65 M20 30
A1-105
506E
SSR
Caged Ball LM Guide Radial Type Model SSR
LM block
Endplate
End seal
LM rail 90°
30°
Ball cage
Ball Cross section
A1-106
506E
SSR
LM Guide
[Compact, Radial Type]
Since it is a compactly designed model that has a low sectional height and a ball contact structure in
the radial direction, this model is optimal for horizontal guide units.
[Self-adjustment Capability]
The self-adjustment capability through front-to-front configuration of THK’s unique circular-arc
grooves (DF set) enables a mounting error to be absorbed even under a preload, thus to achieve
highly accurate, smooth straight motion.
A1-107
506E
A1-108
506E
SSR
LM Guide
A1-109
506E
4-S×ℓ B
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
SSR 15XW
24 34 56.9 26 26 M4×7 39.9 6.5 19.5 4.5 5.5 2.7 4.5 3 PB1021B 4.5
SSR 15XWM
SSR 20XW
28 42 66.5 32 32 M5×8 46.6 8.2 22 5.5 12 2.9 5.2 3 B-M6F 6
SSR 20XWM
SSR 25XW
33 48 83 35 35 M6×9 59.8 8.4 26.2 6 12 3.3 6.8 3 B-M6F 6.8
SSR 25XWM
SSR 30XW
42 60 97 40 40 M8×12 70.7 11.3 32.5 8 12 4.5 7.6 4 B-M6F 9.5
SSR 30XWM
SSR 35XW 48 70 110.9 50 50 M8×12 80.5 13 36.5 8.5 12 4.7 8.8 4 B-M6F 11.5
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this symbol
are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
SSR25X W 2 UU C1 M +1200L Y P T M -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination Stainless LM rail length Stainless steel Symbol for
protection steel (in mm) LM rail No. of rails used
number LM block accessory on the same
symbol (*1) LM block
Applied to only Symbol for LM rail plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) 15 and 25 jointed use
used on the same Normal (No symbol) Accuracy symbol (*3)
rail Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)
High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
Super precision grade (SP)/Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
SSR
(E) L
L1 e0
**
4- φ D0
C
f0
LM Guide
φ d2 N
M1
φ d1
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
15 9.5 12.5 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 14.7 16.5 0.0792 0.44 0.0486 0.274 0.0962 0.15 1.2
(1240)
3000
20 11 15.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 19.6 23.4 0.138 0.723 0.0847 0.448 0.18 0.25 2.1
(1480)
3000
23 12.5 18 60 7×11×9 31.5 36.4 0.258 1.42 0.158 0.884 0.33 0.4 2.7
(2020)
3000
28 16 23 80 7×11×9 46.5 52.7 0.446 2.4 0.274 1.49 0.571 0.8 4.3
(2520)
34 18 27.5 80 9×14×12 3000 64.6 71.6 0.711 3.72 0.437 2.31 0.936 1.1 6.4
**
Note1) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-116.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with
each other
Note2) For models SSR15 and 25, two types of rails with different mounting hole dimensions are offered (see Table1).
When, replacing this model with model SR, pay attention to the mounting hole dimension of the LM rail.
Contact THK for details.
Semi-Standard
Model No. Standard rail
rail
SSR 15 For M4 (Symbol Y) For M3 (No symbol)
SSR 25 For M6 (Symbol Y) For M5 (No symbol)
Options⇒A1-473 A1-111
506E
2-S×ℓ B
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
SSR 15XV
24 34 40.3 26 M4×7 23.3 6.5 19.5 4.5 5.5 2.7 4.5 3 PB1021B 4.5
SSR 15XVM
SSR 20XV
28 42 47.7 32 M5×8 27.8 8.2 22 5.5 12 2.9 5.2 3 B-M6F 6
SSR 20XVM
SSR 25XV
33 48 60 35 M6×9 36.8 8.4 26.2 6 12 3.3 6.8 3 B-M6F 6.8
SSR 25XVM
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this symbol
are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
SSR25X V 2 UU C1 M +1200L Y P T M -Ⅲ
Model Type of Contamination Stainless LM rail length Stainless steel Symbol for
protection steel (in mm) No. of rails used
number LM block accessory LM rail
on the same
symbol (*1)
LM block
Applied to only Symbol for LM rail plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks 15 and 25 jointed use
Radial clearance symbol (*2)
used on the same Normal (No symbol) Accuracy symbol (*3)
rail Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)
High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
Super precision grade (SP)/Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 3 rails are
used in parallel is 3 at a minimum.)
SSR
(E) L
L1 e0
4- φ D0
**
〃 〃
f0
LM Guide
N
φ d2
h
M1
φ d1
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
15 9.5 12.5 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 9.1 9.7 0.0303 0.192 0.0189 0.122 0.0562 0.08 1.2
(1240)
3000
20 11 15.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 13.4 14.4 0.0523 0.336 0.0326 0.213 0.111 0.14 2.1
(1480)
3000
23 12.5 18 60 7×11×9 21.7 22.5 0.104 0.661 0.0652 0.419 0.204 0.23 2.7
(2020)
Note1) Pilot holes for side nipples** are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-116.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with
each other
Note2) For models SSR15 and 25, two types of rails with different mounting hole dimensions are offered (see Table1).
When, replacing this model with model SR, pay attention to the mounting hole dimension of the LM rail.
Contact THK for details.
Table1 The dimension of the rail mounting hole
Semi-Standard
Model No. Standard rail
rail
SSR 15 For M4 (Symbol Y) For M3 (No symbol)
SSR 25 For M6 (Symbol Y) For M5 (No symbol)
Options⇒A1-473 A1-113
506E
Model SSR-XTB
W
4- φ H
B
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
SSR 15XTB 24 52 56.9 41 26 4.5 39.9 7 19.5 4.5 5.5 2.7 4.5 3 PB1021B 4.5
SSR15X TB 2 UU C1 +820L Y P T -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol for
protection (in mm) LM rail Symbol for
number LM block accessory No. of rails used
symbol (*1) Applied to only jointed use on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks 15 and 25 sizes
used on the same Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
rail Normal (No symbol)
Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)
Medium preload (C0) High accuracy grade (H)
Precision grade (P)
Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
SSR
(E) L
L1 e0 **
4- φ D0
C
f0
LM Guide
N
φ d2
h
M1
φ d1
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
15 18.5 12.5 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 14.7 16.5 0.0792 0.44 0.0486 0.274 0.0962 0.19 1.2
(1240)
3000
20 19.5 15.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 19.6 23.4 0.138 0.723 0.0847 0.448 0.18 0.31 2.1
(1480)
3000
23 25 18 60 7×11×9 31.5 36.4 0.258 1.42 0.158 0.884 0.33 0.53 2.7
(2020)
**
Note1) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-116.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with
each other
Note2) For models SSR15 and 25, two types of rails with different mounting hole dimensions are offered (see Table1).
When, replacing this model with model SR, pay attention to the mounting hole dimension of the LM rail.
Contact THK for details.
Table1 The dimension of the rail mounting hole
Semi-Standard
Model No. Standard rail
rail
SSR 15 For M4 (Symbol Y) For M3 (No symbol)
SSR 25 For M6 (Symbol Y) For M5 (No symbol)
Options⇒A1-473 A1-115
506E
G F F G
L0
Model No. SSR 15X SSR 20X SSR 25X SSR 30X SSR 35X
160 220 220 280 280
220 280 280 360 360
280 340 340 440 440
340 400 400 520 520
400 460 460 600 600
460 520 520 680 680
520 580 580 760 760
580 640 640 840 840
640 700 700 920 920
700 760 760 1000 1000
760 820 820 1080 1080
820 940 940 1160 1160
940 1000 1000 1240 1240
1000 1060 1060 1320 1320
1060 1120 1120 1400 1400
1120 1180 1240 1480 1480
1180 1240 1300 1640 1640
1240 1300 1360 1720 1720
LM rail standard
1300 1360 1420 1800 1800
length (LO)
1360 1420 1480 1880 1880
1420 1480 1540 1960 1960
1480 1540 1600 2040 2040
1540 1600 1660 2120 2120
1660 1720 2200 2200
1720 1780 2280 2280
1780 1840 2360 2360
1840 1900 2440 2440
1900 1960 2520 2520
1960 2020 2600 2600
2020 2080 2680 2680
2080 2140 2760 2760
2140 2200 2840 2840
2260 2920 2920
2320
2380
2440
Standard pitch F 60 60 60 80 80
G 20 20 20 20 20
Max length 3000 (1240) 3000 (1480) 3000 (2020) 3000 (2520) 3000
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
Note3) The values in the parentheses indicate the maximum lengths of stainless steel types.
A1-116
506E
SSR
Clearance
LM Guide
ℓ1
S1
(1) A tapped-hole LM rail type is available only Table2 Dimensions of the LM Rail Tap Unit: mm
for high accuracy or lower grades. Model No. S1 Effective tap depth ℓ1
(2) Determine the bolt length so that a clearance
SSR 15X M5 7
of 2 to 5 mm is secured between the bolt
SSR 20X M6 9
end and the bottom of the tap (effective tap
SSR 25X M6 10
depth). (See figure above.)
SSR 30X M8 14
(3) For standard pitches of the taps, see Table1
on A1-116. SSR 35X M8 16
A1-117
506E
SVR/SVS
Caged Ball LM Guide Ultra-heavy Load Type for Machine Tools Model SVR/SVS
LM block
90
。
Protector
40 。
Radial type model SVR
Cross section
LM rail Ball cage
50
。
Ball
40 。
4-Way Type Model SVS
Cross section
* For the Ball Cage, see A1-88.
A1-118
506E
SVR/SVS
LM Guide
* Since models SVR/SVS have very high rigidity, their structures are easily affected by the misalignment of the mounting
surface and the installation error. If affected by these factors, their service life may be shortened or their motion may be dis-
rupted. When considering using these models, contact THK.
[High Rigidity]
Models SVR/SVS achieve the highest rigidity among the Caged Ball LM Guide series.
Both the radial type SVR and the 4-way equal load type SVS are available for the same size. De-
pending on the intended use, you can select either type.
A1-119
506E
Test conditions
Item Description
Tested model SVS45LR1TTHHYYC1+2880LP×2set
Maximum speed 200m/min
Stroke 2500mm
Grease used THK AFB-LF Grease
Environmental
Tested model
Tested model
Stroke
Double Seals
TTHHYY Option:
LaCS
Double Seals
Protector Side Scraper
Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS
Protector
Side Scraper
Test Result
Tested model 2
No damage
after traveling 3000 km
Tested model 1
A1-120
506E
SVR/SVS
LM Guide
limited.
A1-121
506E
A1-122
506E
SVR/SVS
LM Guide
Models SVR-LCH/SVS-LCH (Build to Order) Specification Table⇒A1-134
The LM block has the same cross-sectional
shape as models SVR/SVS-CH, but has a lon-
ger overall LM block length (L) and a greater
rated load.
A1-123
506E
4-S×ℓ
W (E) L
B L1 e0 **
4- φ D0
C
φ d2 f0
T N
(K)
M h
M1
H3 φ d1
F
W2 W1
SVR-R
Outer
LM block dimensions
dimensions
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that an LM block and an LM rail constitute one set (i.e., the required number of sets when
2 rails are used in parallel is 2).
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SVR/SVS
6-S×ℓ
(E) L
L1 e0
LM Guide
C 4- φ D0
**
〃 〃
φ d2 f0
N
M1 h
φ d1
F
SVR-LR
Unit: mm
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max* kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
48.2 68.1 0.602 3.02 0.365 1.83 0.71 0.4
25 12.5 17 40 6×9.5×8.5 3000 2.9
57 86.3 0.944 4.67 0.57 2.81 0.9 0.5
67.9 91.6 0.907 4.85 0.552 2.94 1.08 0.7
28 16 21 80 7×11×9 3000 4.2
84 124 1.64 7.92 0.991 4.76 1.47 0.9
89.6 116 1.26 6.91 0.769 4.2 1.64 1
34 18 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 6.0
112 160 2.35 11.5 1.42 6.91 2.26 1.3
138 186 2.76 13.7 1.67 8.3 3.5 1.8
45 20.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 9.5
161 233 4.52 22.1 2.74 13.4 4.6 2.3
177 235 3.99 20.6 2.42 12.4 5.07 3.3
53 23.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 14
214 309 6.8 32.7 4.1 19.7 6.67 4.3
271 352 7.26 34.9 4.4 21.1 9 6.0
63 31.5 43 150 18×26×22 3000 19.6
339 484 13.5 62.6 8.14 37.6 12.4 8.5
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples** are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
In case of oil lubrication, be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block
where the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-136 .)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-125
506E
4-S×ℓ
W (E) L
B L1 e0 4- φ D0
**
φ d2 f0
T N
(K)
M h
M1
H3 φ d1
F
W2 W1
SVS-R
Outer
LM block dimensions
dimensions
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that an LM block and an LM rail constitute one set (i.e., the required number of sets when
2 rails are used in parallel is 2).
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SVR/SVS
6-S×ℓ
(E) L
L1 e0
LM Guide
C 4- φ D0
**
〃 〃
φ d2 f0
N
M1 h
φ d1
F
SVS-LR
Unit: mm
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max* kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
37 52.2 0.479 2.41 0.443 2.23 0.525 0.4
25 12.5 17 40 6×9.5×8.5 3000 2.9
43.7 66.1 0.75 3.71 0.693 3.43 0.665 0.5
52 70.1 0.722 3.86 0.667 3.58 0.798 0.7
28 16 21 80 7×11×9 3000 4.2
64.4 95.2 1.31 6.3 1.21 5.83 1.08 0.9
68.6 88.6 1 5.49 0.927 5.09 1.2 1
34 18 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 6.0
86.1 123 1.88 9.15 1.73 8.46 1.67 1.3
105 142 2.19 10.9 2.02 10.1 2.6 1.8
45 20.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 9.5
123 178 3.58 17.5 3.31 16.2 3.44 2.3
136 180 3.17 16.4 2.93 15.1 3.76 3.3
53 23.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 14
164 237 5.4 26 4.99 24 4.96 4.3
208 269 5.76 27.7 5.33 25.6 6.66 6.0
63 31.5 43 150 18×26×22 3000 19.6
260 370 10.7 49.6 9.88 45.8 9.16 8.5
**
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
In case of oil lubrication, be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block
where the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-136 .)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-127
506E
4-S
( φ H through)
W (E) L
B L1 e0 4- φ D0
**
C
φ d2 N f0
t T T1
M (K)
h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
SVR-C
Outer
LM block dimensions
dimensions
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that an LM block and an LM rail constitute one set (i.e., the required number of sets when
2 rails are used in parallel is 2).
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SVR/SVS
6-S
(E) ( φ H through)
L
L1 e0 **
4- φ D0
C
LM Guide
〃 〃
φ d2 N f0
h
M1
φ d1
F
SVR-LC
Unit: mm
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max* kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
48.2 68.1 0.602 3.02 0.365 1.83 0.71 0.6
25 23.5 17 40 6×9.5×8.5 3000 2.9
57 86.3 0.944 4.67 0.57 2.81 0.9 0.8
67.9 91.6 0.907 4.85 0.552 2.94 1.08 1.1
28 31 21 80 7×11×9 3000 4.2
84 124 1.64 7.92 0.991 4.76 1.47 1.5
89.6 116 1.26 6.91 0.769 4.2 1.64 1.6
34 33 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 6.0
112 160 2.35 11.5 1.42 6.91 2.26 2
138 186 2.76 13.7 1.67 8.3 3.5 2.7
45 37.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 9.5
161 233 4.52 22.1 2.74 13.4 4.6 3.6
177 235 3.99 20.6 2.42 12.4 5.07 4.5
53 43.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 14
214 309 6.8 32.7 4.1 19.7 6.67 5.9
271 352 7.26 34.9 4.4 21.1 9 7.8
63 53.5 43 150 18×26×22 3000 19.6
339 484 13.5 62.6 8.14 37.6 12.4 11.0
**
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
In case of oil lubrication, be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block
where the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-136 .)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-129
506E
4-S
( φ H through)
W (E) L
e0 4- φ D0
**
B L1
C
φ d2 N f0
t T T1
(K)
M h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
SVS-C
Outer
LM block dimensions
dimensions
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that an LM block and an LM rail constitute one set (i.e., the required number of sets when
2 rails are used in parallel is 2).
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SVR/SVS
6-S
(E) ( φ H through)
L
L1 e0
4- φ D0
**
LM Guide
〃 〃
φ d2 N f0
h
M1
φ d1
F
SVS-LC
Unit: mm
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max* kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
37 52.2 0.479 2.41 0.443 2.23 0.525 0.6
25 23.5 17 40 6×9.5×8.5 3000 2.9
43.7 66.1 0.75 3.71 0.693 3.43 0.665 0.8
52 70.1 0.722 3.86 0.667 3.58 0.798 1.1
28 31 21 80 7×11×9 3000 4.2
64.4 95.2 1.31 6.3 1.21 5.83 1.08 1.5
68.6 88.6 1 5.49 0.927 5.09 1.2 1.5
34 33 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 6.0
86.1 123 1.88 9.15 1.73 8.46 1.67 2
105 142 2.19 10.9 2.02 10.1 2.6 2.7
45 37.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 9.5
123 178 3.58 17.5 3.31 16.2 3.44 3.6
136 180 3.17 16.4 2.93 15.1 3.76 4.5
53 43.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 14
164 237 5.4 26 4.99 24 4.96 5.9
208 269 5.76 27.7 5.33 25.6 6.66 7.8
63 53.5 43 150 18×26×22 3000 19.6
260 370 10.7 49.6 9.88 45.8 9.16 11.0
**
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
In case of oil lubrication, be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block
where the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-136 .)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-131
506E
W
4-S×ℓ B
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
Outer
LM block dimensions
dimensions
SVR 35RH
55 70 109.5 50 50 M8×12 79 11.7 46 23.1 19 12 6 5.2 B-M6F 9
SVS 35RH
SVR 35LRH
55 70 135 50 72 M8×12 104.5 11.7 46 23.1 19 12 6 5.2 B-M6F 9
SVS 35LRH
SVR 45RH
70 86 138.2 60 60 M10×17 105 14.7 58.4 31.9 26 16 8.5 5.2 B-PT1/8 11.6
SVS 45RH
SVR 45LRH
70 86 171 60 80 M10×17 137.8 14.7 58.4 31.9 26 16 8.5 5.2 B-PT1/8 11.6
SVS 45LRH
SVR 55RH
80 100 163.3 75 75 M12×18 123.6 17.7 66 33.6 27 16 10 5.2 B-PT1/8 14
SVS 55RH
SVR 55LRH
80 100 200.5 75 95 M12×18 160.8 17.7 66 33.6 27 16 10 5.2 B-PT1/8 14
SVS 55LRH
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that an LM block and an LM rail constitute one set (i.e., the required number of sets when
2 rails are used in parallel is 2).
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SVR/SVS
(E) L
LM Guide
L1 e0 **
4- φ D0
C
N f0
φ d2
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max* kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
89.6 116 1.26 6.91 0.769 4.2 1.64
34 18 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 1.5 6.0
68.6 88.6 1 5.49 0.927 5.09 1.2
112 160 2.35 11.5 1.42 6.91 2.26
34 18 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 2 6.0
86.1 123 1.88 9.15 1.73 8.46 1.67
138 186 2.76 13.7 1.67 8.3 3.5
45 20.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 3.1 9.5
105 142 2.19 10.9 2.02 10.1 2.6
161 233 4.52 22.1 2.74 13.4 4.6
45 20.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 4.1 9.5
123 178 3.58 17.5 3.31 16.2 3.44
177 235 3.99 20.6 2.42 12.4 5.07
53 23.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 4.7 14
136 180 3.17 16.4 2.93 15.1 3.76
214 309 6.8 32.7 4.1 19.7 6.67
53 23.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 6.2 14
164 237 5.4 26 4.99 24 4.96
**
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
In case of oil lubrication, be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block
where the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-136 .)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-133
506E
4-S W
B
( φ H through)
t T T1
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
Outer
LM block dimensions
dimensions
SVR 35CH
48 100 109.5 82 62 M10 8.5 79 20 19 16 39 16.1 12 12 6 5.2 B-M6F 9
SVS 35CH
SVR 35LCH
48 100 135 82 62 M10 8.5 104.5 20 19 16 39 16.1 12 12 6 5.2 B-M6F 9
SVS 35LCH
SVR 45CH
60 120 138.2 100 80 M12 10.5 105 22 20.5 20 48.4 21.9 16 16 8.5 5.2 B-PT1/8 11.6
SVS 45CH
SVR 45LCH
60 120 171 100 80 M12 10.5 137.8 22 20.5 20 48.4 21.9 16 16 8.5 5.2 B-PT1/8 11.6
SVS 45LCH
SVR 55CH
70 140 163.3 116 95 M14 12.5 123.6 24 22.5 22 56 23.6 17 16 10 5.2 B-PT1/8 14
SVS 55CH
SVR 55LCH
70 140 200.5 116 95 M14 12.5 160.8 24 22.5 22 56 23.6 17 16 10 5.2 B-PT1/8 14
SVS 55LCH
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that an LM block and an LM rail constitute one set (i.e., the required number of sets when
2 rails are used in parallel is 2).
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SVR/SVS
(E) L
L1 e0
**
4- φ D0
LM Guide
C
φ d2 N f0
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max* kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
89.6 116 1.26 6.91 0.769 4.2 1.64
34 33 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 1.7 6.0
68.6 88.6 1 5.49 0.927 5.09 1.2
112 160 2.35 11.5 1.42 6.91 2.26
34 33 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 2.2 6.0
86.1 123 1.88 9.15 1.73 8.46 1.67
138 186 2.76 13.7 1.67 8.3 3.5
45 37.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 3.3 9.5
105 142 2.19 10.9 2.02 10.1 2.6
161 233 4.52 22.1 2.74 13.4 4.6
45 37.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 4.3 9.5
123 178 3.58 17.5 3.31 16.2 3.44
177 235 3.99 20.6 2.42 12.4 5.07
53 43.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 5.1 14
136 180 3.17 16.4 2.93 15.1 3.76
214 309 6.8 32.7 4.1 19.7 6.67
53 43.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 6.6 14
164 237 5.4 26 4.99 24 4.96
**
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
In case of oil lubrication, be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block
where the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-136 .)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-135
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Models SVR/SVS Unit: mm
A1-136
506E
SVR/SVS
LM Guide
A1-137
506E
SHW
Caged Ball LM Guide Wide Rail Model SHW
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
End seal
45
°
Ball
Ball cage
°
45
* For the ball cage, see A1-88.
A1-138
506E
SHW
LM Guide
space saving and large MC moment rigidity.
[Self-adjustment Capability]
The self-adjustment capability through front-to-front configuration of THK’s unique circular-arc
grooves (DF set) enables a mounting error to be absorbed even under a preload, thus to achieve
highly accurate, smooth straight motion.
A1-139
506E
A1-140
506E
SHW
LM Guide
A1-141
506E
Model SHW-CA
L
W L1
4-S B φ H through C
φ d2
〃 〃
N
T h
M (K) M1
H3 φ d1
F
W2 W1
M W L B C S H L1 T K N H3
SHW17 CA 2 QZ UU C1 M +580L P M -Ⅱ
Model Type of With QZ Contamination Stainless LM rail length Stainless Symbol for
number LM block Lubricator protection steel (in mm) steel No. of rails used
accessory LM block LM rail on the same
symbol (*1) plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Accuracy symbol (*3)
Radial clearance symbol (*2) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
used on the same Normal (No symbol) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
rail Light preload (C1) Ultra precision grade (UP)
Medium preload (C0)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SHW
L
W
6-S L1
LM Guide
B
( φ H through) C
〃 〃 φ d2
N
T h
M (K) M1
H3 φ d1
W3 F
W2 W1
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
-0.05
18 11 — 6.6 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 1230 4.31 5.66 0.0228 0.12 0.0228 0.12 0.0405 0.05 0.8
24 13 — 7.5 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 1430 7.05 8.98 0.0466 0.236 0.0466 0.236 0.0904 0.1 1.23
33 13.5 18 8.6 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 1800 7.65 10.18 0.0591 0.298 0.0591 0.298 0.164 0.15 1.9
37 15.5 22 11 50 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 8.24 12.8 0.0806 0.434 0.0806 0.434 0.229 0.24 2.9
42 19 24 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 16 22.7 0.187 0.949 0.187 0.949 0.455 0.47 4.5
69 25.5 40 19 80 7×11×9 3000 35.5 49.2 0.603 3 0.603 3 1.63 1.4 9.6
90 36 60 24 80 9×14×12 3000 70.2 91.4 1.46 7.37 1.46 7.37 3.97 3.7 15
Note) If a grease nipple is required, indicate “with grease nipple;” if a greasing hole is required, indicate “with a tapped hole for
greasing.”
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-146.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-143
506E
W L
6-S×ℓ B L1
〃 〃 C
N φ d2
T
(K) h
M
M1
H3
W3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N H3
SHW
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
φ d2 C
N
T h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
LM Guide
Models SHW12CRM, SHW12HRM and SHW14CRM
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
C
N φ d2
T h
M (K)
M1
H3
W3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
Models SHW17CRM and SHW21CR
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
-0.05
18 6 — 6.6 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 1230 4.31 5.66 0.0228 0.12 0.0228 0.12 0.0405 0.04 0.8
18 6 — 6.6 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 1000 5.56 8.68 0.0511 0.246 0.0511 0.246 0.0621 0.06 0.8
24 8 — 7.5 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 1430 7.05 8.98 0.0466 0.236 0.0466 0.236 0.0904 0.08 1.23
33 8.5 18 8.6 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 1800 7.65 10.18 0.0591 0.298 0.0591 0.298 0.164 0.13 1.9
37 8.5 22 11 50 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 8.24 12.8 0.0806 0.434 0.0806 0.434 0.229 0.19 2.9
42 10 24 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 16 22.7 0.187 0.949 0.187 0.949 0.455 0.36 4.5
69 15.5 40 19 80 7×11×9 3000 35.5 49.2 0.603 3 0.603 3 1.63 1.2 9.6
90 20 60 24 80 9×14×12 3000 70.2 91.4 1.46 7.37 1.46 7.37 3.97 3 15
Note) If a grease nipple is required, indicate “with grease nipple;” if a greasing hole is required, indicate “with a tapped hole for
greasing.”
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-146.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-145
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SHW Unit: mm
Standard pitch F 40 40 40 50 60 80 80
G 15 15 15 15 20 20 20
Max length 1230 1430 1800 3000 3000 3000 3000
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
Note3) Models SHW12, 14 and 17 are made of stainless steel.
A1-146
506E
SHW
Greasing Hole
[Grease Nipple and Greasing Hole for Model SHW]
Model SHW does not have a grease nipple as standard. Installation of a grease nipple and the drill-
ing of a greasing hole is performed at THK. When ordering SHW, indicate that the desired model re-
quires a grease nipple or greasing hole. (For greasing hole dimensions and supported grease nipple
types and dimensions, see Table2).
LM Guide
When using SHW under harsh conditions, use QZ Lubricator* (optional) or Laminated Contact
Scraper LaCS* (optional).
Note1) Grease nipple is not available for models SHW12 and SHW14. They can have a greasing hole.
Note2) Using a greasing hole other than for greasing may cause damage.
Note3) For QZ Lubricator*, see A1-502. For Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS*, see A1-479.
Note4) When desiring a grease nipple for a model attached with QZ Lubricator, contact THK.
A1-147
506E
SRS
Caged Ball LM Guide Miniature Type Model SRS
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
End seal
Compact type
Model SRS-M
Side seal
Ball
Ball cage
Wide type
Model SRS-WM
A1-148
506E
SRS
LM Guide
long-term maintenance-free operation.
[Compact]
Since SRS has a compact structure where the rail cross section is designed to be low and that con-
tains only two rows of balls, it can be installed in space-saving locations.
[Lightweight]
Since part of the LM block (e.g., around the ball relief hole) is made of resin and formed through in-
sert molding, SRS is a lightweight, low inertia type of LM Guide.
A1-149
506E
A1-150
506E
SRS
LM Guide
Note) In addition to model SRS-WM, a full-ball type without
ball cage is also available.If desiring this type, indicate
type “SRS-G” when placing an order.However, since
SRS-G does not have a ball cage, its dynamic load
rating is smaller than SRS-WM. See the table of basic
load ratings for SRS-G on A1-159 for details.
A1-151
506E
A1-152
506E
SRS
LM Guide
A1-153
506E
W L
B 2-S×ℓ L1
N φ d2
T h
M (K)
M1
H3
W2 W1 φ d1
F
SRS5M
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N H3
2 SRS5WM UU C1 +150L P M -Ⅱ
Model Contamination LM rail length Stainless
protection (in mm) steel Symbol for
number No. of rails used
accessory LM rail
symbol (*1) on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks
used on the same rail Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/Precision grade (P)
Light preload (C1)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-83. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set.(i.e. If you are using 2 shafts in parallel, the required
number of sets is 2.)
SRS
L
W L1
C 2-S
LM Guide
N φ d2
T
M (K)
M1 h
H3
W2 W1 φ d1
F
SRS5WM
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic Load Rating Static permissible moment N•m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
1 Double 1 Double 1
W1 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max N N kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
0
5 3.5 4 15 2.4×3.5×1 220 439 468 0.74 5.11 0.86 5.99 1.21 0.002 0.13
–0.02
0
10 3.5 4 20 3×5.5×3 220 584 703 1.57 9.59 1.83 11.24 3.58 0.005 0.27
–0.02
Note) The maximum length under “Length ” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-160.)
*
● Reference bolt tightening torque when mounting an LM block for model SRS 5M/5WM is shown in
the table below.
Reference tightening torque
Model No. Model No. of screw Screw depth (mm) Reference tightening torque (N•m)*
SRS 5M M2 1.5 0.4
SRS 5WM M3 2.3 0.4
* Tightening above the tightening torque affects accuracy.
Be sure to tighten at or below the defined tightening torque.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-155
506E
T
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N H3
2 SRS20M QZ UU C1 +220L P M -Ⅱ
Model With QZ Contamination LM rail length Stainless
Symbol for
number Lubricator protection (in mm) steel
No. of rails used
accessory LM rail
symbol (*1) on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks
used on the same rail Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-83. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SRS
L1
C
φ d2
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment N-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
1 Double 1 Double 1
W1 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
0
7 5 4.7 15 2.4×4.2×2.3 480 1.51 1.29 3.09 19 3.69 22.1 5.02 0.009 0.25
–0.02
1.78 1.53 3.15 22.2 3.61 25.6 7.04 0.009
0
9 5.5 5.5 20 3.5×6×3.3 1240 2.69 2.75 9.31 52.2 10.7 60.3 12.7 0.016 0.36
–0.02
3.48 3.98 18.7 96.5 21.6 112 18.3 0.024
0 4 3.53 12 78.5 12 78.5 23.1 0.027
12 7.5 7.5 25 3.5×6×4.5 1430 0.65
–0.02 5.82 5.30 28.4 151 28.4 151 34.7 0.049
0 6.66 5.7 26.2 154 26.2 154 40.4 0.047
15 8.5 9.5 40 3.5×6×4.5 1600 0.96
–0.02 9.71 8.55 59.7 312 59.7 312 60.7 0.095
0
20 10 11 60 6×9.5×8 1800 7.75 9.77 54.3 296 62.4 341 104 0.11 1.68
–0.03
0
23 12.5 15 60 7×11×9 1800 16.5 20.2 177 932 177 932 248 0.24 2.6
–0.03
Note) If a grease nipple is required, indicate “with grease SRS-G (Full-ball Type) Basic Load Ratings
nipple”. (available for models SRS 15M/15N/15WM/15
WN/20M/25M) Basic load rating
If a greasing hole is required, indicate “with greasing Model No. C C0
hole”. (available for models SRS 7M/7WM/9WM/9WN/
12M/12N/12WM/12WN) kN kN
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the SRS 7GM 1.16 1.54
standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-
160.) SRS 9XGS 1.37 1.53
Static Permissible Moment*
1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LMblock SRS 9XGM 2.22 3.06
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 SRS 9XGN 2.94 4.59
blocks closely contacting with each other
SRS 12GM 3.36 3.55
SRS 15GM 5.59 5.72
SRS 20GM 5.95 9.40
SRS 25GM 13.3 22.3
● Reference bolt tightening torque when mounting an LM block for model SRS 7M is shown in the table below.
Reference tightening torque
Model No. Model No. of screw Screw depth (mm) Reference tightening torque (N•m)*
SRS 7M M2 2.3 0.4
* Tightening above the tightening torque affects accuracy.
Be sure to tighten at or below the defined tightening torque.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-157
506E
W
W 4-S×ℓ
4-S×ℓ B
B
N
N
T
T M (K)
M (K)
H3 H3
W3
W2 W1 W2 W1
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N H3
SRS 9WM 39 21 12 27
12 30 M3×2.8 4.9 9.1 2.3 2.9
SRS 9WN 50.7 23 24 38.7
SRS 12WM 44.5 15 30.9
14 40 28 M3×3.5 5.7 11 3 3
SRS 12WN 59.5 28 45.9
SRS 15WM 55.5 20 38.9
16 60 45 M4×4.5 6.5 13.3 3 2.7
SRS 15WN 74.5 35 57.9
Note) Since stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls, these models are highly resistant to corrosion and
environment.
2 SRS15WM QZ UU C1 +550L P M -Ⅱ
Model With QZ Contamination LM rail length Stainless
Symbol for
number Lubricator protection
accessory
(in mm) steel
No. of rails used
LM rail
symbol (*1) on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks
Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-83. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SRS
L1
LM Guide
φ d2
M1
φ d1
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment N-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
1 Double 1 Double 1
W1 W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
0
14 5.5 — 5.2 30 3.5×6×3.2 480 2.01 1.94 6.47 36.4 7.71 42.3 14.33 0.018 0.56
–0.02
0 3.29 3.34 14 78.6 16.2 91 31.5 0.031
18 6 — 7.5 30 3.5×6×4.5 1430 1.01
–0.02 4.20 4.37 25.1 130 29.1 151 41.3 0.049
0 5.48 5.3 26.4 143 26.4 143 66.5 0.055
24 8 — 8.5 40 4.5×8×4.5 1600 1.52
–0.02 7.13 7.07 49.2 249 49.2 249 88.7 0.091
0 9.12 8.55 51.2 290 51.2 290 176 0.13
42 9 23 9.5 40 4.5×8×4.5 1800 2.87
–0.02 12.4 12.1 106 532 106 532 250 0.201
Note) If a grease nipple is required, indicate “with grease SRS-G (Full-ball Type) Basic Load Ratings
nipple”. (available for models SRS 15M/15N/15WM/15
WN/20M/25M) Basic load rating
If a greasing hole is required, indicate “with greasing Model No. C C0
hole”. (available for models SRS 7M/7WM/9M/9N/9W
M/9WN/12M/12N/12WM/12WN). kN kN
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the SRS 7WGM 1.63 2.51
standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-
160.)
Static Permissible Moment* SRS 9WGM 2.67 3.35
1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LMblock
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 SRS 12WGM 4.46 5.32
blocks closely contacting with each other
SRS 15WGM 7.43 8.59
● Reference bolt tightening torque when mounting an LM block for model SRS 7WM is shown in the table below.
Reference tightening torque
Model No. Model No. of screw Screw depth (mm) Reference tightening torque (N•m)*
SRS 7WM M3 2.8 0.4
Options⇒A1-473 A1-159
506E
G F F G
L0
Table2 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SRS Unit: mm
SRS SRS SRS SRS SRS SRS SRS SRS SRS SRS SRS SRS
Model No.
5M 5WM 7M 7WM 9XS/XM/XN 9WM/WN 12M/N 12WM/WN 15M/N 15WM/WN 20M 25M
40 50 40 50 55 50 70 70 70 110 220 220
55 70 55 80 75 80 95 110 110 150 280 280
70 90 70 110 95 110 120 150 150 190 340 340
100 110 85 140 115 140 145 190 190 230 460 460
130 130 100 170 135 170 170 230 230 270 640 640
160 150 115 200 155 200 195 270 270 310 880 880
LM rail
170 130 260 175 260 220 310 310 430 1000 1000
standard
290 195 290 245 390 350 550
length
275 320 270 470 390 670
(LO)
375 320 550 430 790
370 470
470 550
570 670
870
Standard pitch F 15 20 15 30 20 30 25 40 40 40 60 60
G 5 5 5 10 7.5 10 10 15 15 15 20 20
Max length 220 220 480 480 1240 1430 1430 1600 1600 1800 1800 1800
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
A1-160
506E
SRS
Greasing Hole
[Grease Nipple and Greasing Hole for Model SRS]
The standard version of Model SRS is not equipped with either a grease nipple or an oil hole.
Grease nipple installation and greasing hole drilling are performed at THK. When ordering SRS, in-
dicate that the desired model requires a grease nipple or greasing hole. Model SRS-G (full-ball type)
LM Guide
has a grease nipple and a greasing hole as standard. (For greasing hole dimensions and supported
grease nipple types and dimensions, see Table3.)
When using SRS under harsh conditions, use QZ Lubricator* (optional) or Laminated Contact
Scraper LaCS* (optional).
Note1) Grease nipple is not available for models SRS5M, SRS5WM, SRS7M, SRS7WM, SRS9XS, SRS9XM, SRS9XN, SR-
S9WM, SRS12M and SRS12WM. They can have a greasing hole.
Note2) Using a greasing hole other than for greasing may cause damage.
Note3) For QZ Lubricator*, see A1-502. For Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS*, see A1-479.
Note4) When desiring a grease nipple for a model attached with QZ Lubricator, contact THK.
Note) For the L dimension, see the corresponding specifica- 7WM — 1.2 drilled hole
tion table. 9XS/XM/XN — 1.6 drilled hole
9 WM/WN — 1.6 drilled hole
12 M/N — 2.0 drilled hole
SRS
12 WM/WN — 2.0 drilled hole
4.0
15 M/N PB107
(5.0)
4.0
15 WM/WN PB107
(5.0)
3.5
20M PB107
(5.0)
4.0
25M PB1021B
(5.5)
7GM — 1.2 drilled hole
7WGM — 1.2 drilled hole
9XGS/
— 1.6 drilled hole
XGM/XGN
9WGM — 1.6 drilled hole
12GM — 2.0 drilled hole
2.0 drilled hole
SRS-G 12WGM —
4.0
15GM PB107
(5.0)
4.0
15WGM PB107
(5.0)
3.5
20GM PB107
(5.0)
4.0
25GM PB1021B
(5.5)
Note) Figures in the parentheses indicate dimensions with-
out a seal.
A1-161
506E
SCR
Caged Ball LM Guide Cross LM Guide Model SCR
LM rail
End seal
Endplate
Grease nipple
LM block
Ball
Ball cage
Side seal
LM rail
A1-162
506E
SCR
LM Guide
rails in combination. Since an orthogonal LM system can be achieved with model SCR alone, a
conventionally required saddle is no longer necessary, the structure for X-Y motion can be simplified
and the whole system can be downsized.
[High Rigidity]
Since balls are arranged in four rows in a well-balanced manner, this model is stiff against a mo-
ment, and smooth straight motion is ensured even a preload is applied to increase the rigidity.
Since the rigidity of the LM block is higher than that of a combination of two LM blocks of the con-
ventional type secured together back-to-back with bolts, this model is optimal for building an X-Y
table that requires a high rigidity.
[Compact]
This model is an integral type of Caged Ball LM Guide that squares an internal structure similar to
model SHS, which has a proven track record and is highly reliable, with another and uses two LM
rails in combination. Since an orthogonal LM Guide can be achieved with model SCR alone, a con-
ventionally required saddle is no longer necessary, the structure for X-Y motion can be simplified
and the whole system can be downsized.
A1-163
506E
A1-164
506E
SCR
LM Guide
A1-165
506E
Model SCR
F
C C1
φ d1
〃 〃
M1
L2
φ d2
B3
M
B
B4
H3
N
B1
2×5-S×ℓ W1
W2
W
L (E)
M W L B1 B3 B4 B C C1 S×ℓ L2 H3 N E
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-80.
SCR
(E) L
W
W2 2×5-S×ℓ
W1
B1
LM Guide
N
H3
B4
B
M
φ d2
B3
h
L2
M1
φ d1 〃 〃
C1 C
F
Unit: mm
MB
M0
Options⇒A1-473 A1-167
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SCR Unit: mm
A1-168
506E
SCR
LM Guide
15 M5 8
20 M6 10
25 M6 12
X-axis LM rail
30 M8 15
35 M8 17
45 M12 20
Y-axis LM rail
65 M20 30
A1-169
506E
EPF
Caged Ball LM Guide Finite stroke Model EPF
Stopper
LM block
Ball 45°
45°
Cage
LM rail
45° 45°
Cross-section
(DB configuration)
A1-170
506E
EPF
[Smooth motion]
Because a finite stroke is used, balls do not EPF9M
LM Guide
circulate and movement is smooth even with Existing equivalent products
0.0020
pre-loading. Also, because variations in rolling 0.0018
resistance are small, this model is ideal for loca- 0.0016
0.0014
tions where smooth movement is required with 0.0012
tan θ
a short stroke. 0.001
0.0008
0.0006
[High Rigidity] 0.0004
Because model EPF uses a DB construction 0.0002
0
featuring 4 rows of circular-arc grooves, it offers 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8
particularly high rigidity with respect to moment MC Moment [N-m]
in the MC direction. This makes it ideal for loca-
tions where MC moment is applied with one rail. EPF12M
Existing equivalent products
0.0018
[Miniature Type] 0.0016
Because the mounting method is compatible 0.0014
with the Miniature LM Guide Model RSR-N, the 0.0012
tan θ
0.001
models are dimensionally interchangeable. 0.0008
0.0006
[4-way Equal Load] 0.0004
Each row of balls is configured at a contact an- 0.0002
0
gle of 45 so that the rated loads applied to the 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8
LM block are uniform in the all directions (radial, MC Moment [N-m]
reverse radial and lateral directions), enabling Fig.1 Comparison of MC moment test data
the LM Guide to be used in all orientations and
in extensive applications. 3.0
EPF9M
Resistance[N]
2.5
Existing equivalent products
[Ball cage technology application 1] 2.0
Because the cage is formed out of plastic resin, 1.5
1.0
there is no metal contact between the cage and
0.5
the balls, providing excellent noise characteris- 0.0
tics, low dust emissions and long product life. 0 5 10 15 20 25 30
Stroke [mm]
[Ball cage technology application 2]
3.0
Forming the cage in a spherical shape out EPF15M
Resistance[N]
2.5
Existing equivalent products
of plastic resin allows lubricant to be held in 2.0
grease pockets, enabling long periods of main- 1.5
tenance-free operation. 1.0
0.5
0.0
0 5 10 15 20 25 30
Stroke [mm]
A1-171
506E
A1-172
506E
EPF
LM Guide
Unit: mm
A1-173
506E
Model EPF
W
B
4−S×ℓ
φ d3
W2 W1
M W LB B C d3 S×ℓ LB1 W1 W2 M1
Guaranteed stroke
(in mm) Accuracy symbol (*1)
EPF
LB
LB1
C
LM Guide
φ d2
M1 h
φ d1
G F
Unit: mm
Guaranteed Basic load *
Static permissible moment N•m Mass
stroke rating
LM LM
C C0 MA MB MC
block rail
G F d1×d2×h ST kN kN kg kg/m
Options⇒A1-473 A1-175
506E
G F (G)
L0
Note) Lengths other than the standard LM rail length (L0) are also available. Contact THK for details.
A1-176
506E
EPF
LM Guide
A1-177
506E
HSR
LM Guide Global Standard Size Model HSR
Retainer plate
LM block
Endplate
End seal
LM rail
Grease nipple
45°
Ball
Retainer plate
Inner seal (Optional)
45°
Side seal
Cross section
A1-178
506E
HSR
LM Guide
Each row of balls is placed at a contact angle of 45 so that the rated loads applied to the LM block
are uniform in the four directions (radial, reverse radial and lateral directions), enabling the LM
Guide to be used in all orientations. In addition, the LM block can receive a well-balanced preload,
increasing the rigidity in the four directions while maintaining a constant, low friction coefficient. With
the low sectional height and the high rigidity design of the LM block, this model achieves highly ac-
curate and stable straight motion.
[Self-adjustment Capability]
The self-adjustment capability through front-to-front configuration of THK’s unique circular-arc
grooves (DF set) enables a mounting error to be absorbed even under a preload, thus to achieve
highly accurate, smooth straight motion.
[High Durability]
Even under a preload or excessive biased load, differential slip of balls does not occur. As a result,
smooth motion, high wear resistance, and long-term maintenance of accuracy are achieved.
A1-179
506E
Types
A1-180
506E
HSR
LM Guide
the desired accuracy and adjusting the clear-
ance. Since model HSR-YR has tapped holes
on the side of the LM block, a simpler structure
is gained and reduced man-hour and increase
in accuracy can be achieved.
A1-181
506E
A1-182
506E
HSR
LM Guide
Model HSR-HB Specification Table⇒A1-200
The LM block has the same cross sectional shape
as model HSR-CB, but has a longer overall LM
block length (L) and a greater rated load.
A1-183
506E
T
T1 T t T1
M (K) (K)
M
H3 H3
W2 W1 W2 W1
HSR25 A 2 QZ UU C0 M +1200L P T M -Ⅱ
Model Type of With QZ Contamination Stainless steel LM rail length Stainless steel Symbol for
protection LM rail No. of rails used
number LM block Lubricator accessory LM block (in mm) Symbol for LM rail on the same
symbol (*1) jointed use plane (*4)
Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
No. of LM blocks Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
used on the same Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
rail Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
HSR
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2
N
LM Guide
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
15 16 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.2 1.5
(1240)
3000
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35 2.3
(1480)
3000
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 21.3 31.8 0.323 1.66 0.323 1.66 0.27 0.47 2.3
(1480)
3000
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59 3.3
(2020)
3000
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 27.2 45.9 0.529 2.74 0.529 2.74 0.459 0.75 3.3
(2020)
3000
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.1 4.8
(2520)
3000
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 37.3 62.5 0.889 4.37 0.889 4.37 0.751 1.3 4.8
(2520)
3000
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6 6.6
(2520)
3000
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 50.2 81.5 1.32 6.35 1.32 6.35 1.2 2 6.6
(2520)
60 95.6 1.42 7.92 1.42 7.92 1.83 2.8
45 37.5 38 105 14×20×17 3090 11
80.4 127 2.44 12.6 2.44 12.6 2.43 3.3
88.5 137 2.45 13.2 2.45 13.2 3.2 4.5
53 43.5 44 120 16×23×20 3060 15.1
119 183 4.22 21.3 4.22 21.3 4.28 5.7
141 215 4.8 23.5 4.8 23.5 5.82 8.5
63 53.5 53 150 18×26×22 3000 22.5
192 286 8.72 40.5 8.72 40.5 7.7 10.7
210 310 8.31 45.6 8.31 45.6 11 17
85 65 65 180 24×35×28 3000 35.2
282 412 14.2 72.5 14.2 72.5 14.7 23
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this sym-
bol are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-185
506E
t T T1
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
HSR25 B 2 QZ UU C0 M +1200L P T M -Ⅱ
Model Type of With QZ Contamination Stainless steel LM rail length Stainless steel Symbol for
number LM block Lubricator protection
accessory LM block (in mm) LM rail No. of rails used
Symbol for LM rail on the same
symbol (*1)
jointed use plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
HSR
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2
N
LM Guide
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
15 16 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.2 1.5
(1240)
3000
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35 2.3
(1480)
3000
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 21.3 31.8 0.323 1.66 0.323 1.66 0.27 0.47 2.3
(1480)
3000
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59 3.3
(2020)
3000
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 27.2 45.9 0.529 2.74 0.529 2.74 0.459 0.75 3.3
(2020)
3000
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.1 4.8
(2520)
3000
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 37.3 62.5 0.889 4.37 0.889 4.37 0.751 1.3 4.8
(2520)
3000
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6 6.6
(2520)
3000
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 50.2 81.5 1.32 6.35 1.32 6.35 1.2 2 6.6
(2520)
60 95.6 1.42 7.92 1.42 7.92 1.83 2.8
45 37.5 38 105 14×20×17 3090 11
80.4 127 2.44 12.6 2.44 12.6 2.43 3.3
88.5 137 2.45 13.2 2.45 13.2 3.2 4.5
53 43.5 44 120 16×23×20 3060 15.1
119 183 4.22 21.3 4.22 21.3 4.28 5.7
141 215 4.8 23.5 4.8 23.5 5.82 8.5
63 53.5 53 150 18×26×22 3000 22.5
192 286 8.72 40.5 8.72 40.5 7.7 10.7
210 310 8.31 45.6 8.31 45.6 11 17
85 65 65 180 24×35×28 3000 35.2
282 412 14.2 72.5 14.2 72.5 14.7 23
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this sym-
bol are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-187
506E
W
4-S B
( φ H through)
T1 T
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
HSR 15C (Ct) 24 47 56.6 38 30 M5 4.4 38.8 7 11 19.3 4.3 5.5 PB1021B 4.7
HSR 20C (Ct) 30 63 74 53 40 M6 5.4 50.8 10 9.5 26 5 12 B-M6F 4
HSR 25C (Ct) 36 70 83.1 57 45 M8 6.8 59.5 11 16 30.5 6 12 B-M6F 5.5
HSR 30C (Ct) 42 90 98 72 52 M10 8.5 70.4 9 18 35 7 12 B-M6F 7
HSR 35C (Ct) 48 100 109.4 82 62 M10 8.5 80.4 12 21 40.5 8 12 B-M6F 7.5
HSR
(E) L
L1
LM Guide
φ d2
N
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
15 16 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.2 1.5
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 3000 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35 2.3
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 3000 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59 3.3
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 3000 28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.1 4.8
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 3000 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6 6.6
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-189
506E
Model HSR-RM
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
φd
C
N φ d2
h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Greasing
Model No. Height Width Length
hole Grease
nipple
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E d H3
HSR12 R 2 UU C1 M +670L H T M -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination Stainless LM rail length Stainless Symbol for
protection No. of rails used
number LM block accessory steel (in mm) steel LM rail
symbol (*1) LM block on the same
Symbol for LM rail plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) jointed use
used on the same Normal (No symbol)
rail Light preload (C1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
HSR
W (E) L
4-S×ℓ L1
B
LM Guide
φ d2
T N
h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Model HSR12RM
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
8 4 6 20 2.4×4.2×2.3 (975) 1.08 2.16 0.00492 0.0319 0.00492 0.0319 0.00727 0.012 0.3
10 5 7 25 3.5×6×3.3 (995) 1.96 3.82 0.0123 0.0716 0.0123 0.0716 0.0162 0.025 0.45
12 7.5 11 40 3.5×6×4.5 (1240) 4.7 8.53 0.0409 0.228 0.0409 0.228 0.0445 0.08 0.83
Note) Since stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls, these models are highly resistant to corrosion and envi-
ronment.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-191
506E
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
HSR35 R 2 QZ SS C0 M +1400L P T M -Ⅱ
Model Type of With QZ Contamination
protection Stainless steel LM rail length Stainless steel Symbol for
LM rail No. of rails used
number LM block Lubricator accessory LM block (in mm)
symbol (*1) Symbol for on the same
LM rail jointed use plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
HSR
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2
N
LM Guide
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
15 9.5 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.18 1.5
(1240)
3000
20 12 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.25 2.3
(1480)
3000
20 12 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 21.3 31.8 0.323 1.66 0.323 1.66 0.27 0.35 2.3
(1480)
3000
23 12.5 22 60 7×11×9 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.54 3.3
(2020)
3000
23 12.5 22 60 7×11×9 27.2 45.9 0.529 2.74 0.529 2.74 0.459 0.67 3.3
(2020)
3000
28 16 26 80 9×14×12 28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 0.9 4.8
(2520)
3000
28 16 26 80 9×14×12 37.3 62.5 0.889 4.37 0.889 4.37 0.751 1.1 4.8
(2520)
3000
34 18 29 80 9×14×12 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.5 6.6
(2520)
3000
34 18 29 80 9×14×12 50.2 81.5 1.32 6.35 1.32 6.35 1.2 2 6.6
(2520)
60 95.6 1.42 7.92 1.42 7.92 1.83 2.6
45 20.5 38 105 14×20×17 3090 11
80.4 127 2.44 12.6 2.44 12.6 2.43 3.1
88.5 137 2.45 13.2 2.45 13.2 3.2 4.3
53 23.5 44 120 16×23×20 3060 15.1
119 183 4.22 21.3 4.22 21.3 4.28 5.4
141 215 4.8 23.5 4.8 23.5 5.82 7.3
63 31.5 53 150 18×26×22 3000 22.5
192 286 8.72 40.5 8.72 40.5 7.7 9.3
210 310 8.31 45.6 8.31 45.6 11 13
85 35.5 65 180 24×35×28 3000 35.2
282 412 14.2 72.5 14.2 72.5 14.7 16
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this sym-
bol are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-193
506E
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
HSR 15R (Ct) 28 34 56.6 26 26 M4×5 38.8 6 23.3 8.3 5.5 PB1021B 4.7
HSR 20R (Ct) 30 44 74 32 36 M5×6 50.8 8 26 5 12 B-M6F 4
HSR 25R (Ct) 40 48 83.1 35 35 M6×8 59.5 9 34.5 10 12 B-M6F 5.5
HSR 30R (Ct) 45 60 98 40 40 M8×10 70.4 9 38 10 12 B-M6F 7
HSR 35R (Ct) 55 70 109.4 50 50 M8×12 80.4 11.7 47.5 15 12 B-M6F 7.5
HSR
(E) L
L1
φ d2
N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
15 9.5 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.18 1.5
20 12 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 3000 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.25 2.3
23 12.5 22 60 7×11×9 3000 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.54 3.3
28 16 26 80 9×14×12 3000 28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 0.9 4.8
34 18 29 80 9×14×12 3000 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.5 6.6
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-195
506E
4-S×ℓ
B1
B
(K)
M
H3
W1
W2
HSR 15YR
28 33.5 56.6 4.3 11.5 18 M4×5 38.8 23.3 8.3 5.5 PB1021B 4.7
HSR 15YRM
HSR 20YR
30 43.5 74 4 11.5 25 M5×6 50.8 26 5 12 B-M6F 4
HSR 20YRM
HSR 25YR
40 47.5 83.1 6 16 30 M6×6 59.5 34.5 10 12 B-M6F 5.5
HSR 25YRM
HSR 30YR
45 59.5 98 8 16 40 M6×9 70.4 38 10 12 B-M6F 7
HSR 30YRM
HSR 35YR
55 69.5 109.4 8 23 43 M8×10 80.4 47.5 15 12 B-M6F 7.5
HSR 35YRM
HSR 45YR 70 85.5 139 10 30 55 M10×14 98 60 20 16 B-PT1/8 10
HSR 55YR 80 99.5 163 12 32 70 M12×15 118 67 21 16 B-PT1/8 13
HSR 65YR 90 124.5 186 12 35 85 M16×22 147 76 19 16 B-PT1/8 14
HSR25 YR 2 UU C0 M +1200L P T M -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination Stainless LM rail length Stainless Symbol for
protection steel No. of rails used
number LM block accessory steel (in mm)
symbol (*1) LM block LM rail on the same
Symbol for LM rail plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) jointed use
used on the same Normal (No symbol)
rail Light preload (C1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Medium preload (C0) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
HSR
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2 N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
15 24 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.18 1.5
(1240)
3000
20 31.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.25 2.3
(1480)
3000
23 35 22 60 7×11×9 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.54 3.3
(2020)
3000
28 43.5 26 80 9×14×12 28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 0.9 4.8
(2520)
3000
34 51.5 29 80 9×14×12 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.5 6.6
(2520)
45 65 38 105 14×20×17 3090 60 95.6 1.42 7.92 1.42 7.92 1.83 2.6 11
53 76 44 120 16×23×20 3060 88.5 137 2.45 13.2 2.45 13.2 3.2 4.3 15.1
63 93 53 150 18×26×22 3000 141 215 4.8 23.5 4.8 23.5 5.82 7.3 22.5
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this sym-
bol are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-197
506E
T
t T1
T1 T (K)
(K) M
M
H3 H3
W2 W1 W2 W1
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
HSR
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2
N
LM Guide
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35 2.3
(1480)
3000
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 21.3 31.8 0.323 1.66 0.323 1.66 0.27 0.47 2.3
(1480)
3000
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59 3.3
(2020)
3000
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 27.2 45.9 0.529 2.74 0.529 2.74 0.459 0.75 3.3
(2020)
3000
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.1 4.8
(2520)
3000
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 37.3 62.5 0.889 4.37 0.889 4.37 0.751 1.3 4.8
(2520)
3000
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6 6.6
(2520)
3000
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 50.2 81.5 1.32 6.35 1.32 6.35 1.2 2 6.6
(2520)
60 95.6 1.42 7.92 1.42 7.92 1.83 2.8
45 37.5 38 105 14×20×17 3090 11
80.4 127 2.44 12.6 2.44 12.6 2.43 3.3
88.5 137 2.45 13.2 2.45 13.2 3.2 4.5
53 43.5 44 120 16×23×20 3060 15.1
119 183 4.22 21.3 4.22 21.3 4.28 5.7
141 215 4.8 23.5 4.8 23.5 5.82 8.5
63 53.5 53 150 18×26×22 3000 22.5
192 286 8.72 40.5 8.72 40.5 7.7 10.7
210 310 8.31 45.6 8.31 45.6 11 17
85 65 65 180 24×35×28 3000 35.2
282 412 14.2 72.5 14.2 72.5 14.7 23
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this sym-
bol are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-199
506E
t T T1
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
HSR
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2
N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
3000
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35 2.3
(1480)
3000
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 21.3 31.8 0.323 1.66 0.323 1.66 0.27 0.47 2.3
(1480)
3000
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59 3.3
(2020)
3000
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 27.2 45.9 0.529 2.74 0.529 2.74 0.459 0.75 3.3
(2020)
3000
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.1 4.8
(2520)
3000
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 37.3 62.5 0.889 4.37 0.889 4.37 0.751 1.3 4.8
(2520)
3000
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6 6.6
(2520)
3000
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 50.2 81.5 1.32 6.35 1.32 6.35 1.2 2 6.6
(2520)
60 95.6 1.42 7.92 1.42 7.92 1.83 2.8
45 37.5 38 105 14×20×17 3090 11
80.4 127 2.44 12.6 2.44 12.6 2.43 3.3
88.5 137 2.45 13.2 2.45 13.2 3.2 4.5
53 43.5 44 120 16×23×20 3060 15.1
119 183 4.22 21.3 4.22 21.3 4.28 5.7
141 215 4.8 23.5 4.8 23.5 5.82 8.5
63 53.5 53 150 18×26×22 3000 22.5
192 286 8.72 40.5 8.72 40.5 7.7 10.7
210 310 8.31 45.6 8.31 45.6 11 17
85 65 65 180 24×35×28 3000 35.2
282 412 14.2 72.5 14.2 72.5 14.7 23
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this sym-
bol are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-201
506E
W W
9-S B 9- φ H B
T1 T T1 T
(K) (K)
M M
H3 H3
W2 W1 W2 W1
*
HSR 100HA 250 220 — M18 32 35
HSR 100HB 120 250 334 220 200 20 — 261 32 35 100 23 16 B-PT1/4 20
HSR 100HR 200 130 — M18×27 33 —
HSR 120HA 290 250 — M20* 34 38
HSR 120HB 130 290 365 250 210 22 — 287 34 38 110 26.5 16 B-PT1/4 20
HSR 120HR 220 146 — M20×30 33.7 —
HSR 150HA 350 300 — M24* 36 40
HSR 150HB 145 350 396 300 230 26 — 314 36 40 123 29 16 B-PT1/4 22
HSR 150HR 266 180 — M24×35 33 —
Note) “*” indicates a through hole.
HSR150 HR 2 UU C1 +2350L H T -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol Symbol for
number LM block protection (in mm) for LM rail No. of rails used
accessory jointed use on the same plane (*4)
symbol (*1)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
HSR
(E) L
L1
W
C
6-S×ℓ B
φ d2
LM Guide
N
T h
M (K)
M1
H3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
75
100 75 70 210 26×39×32 3000 351 506 19.4 98.2 19.4 98.2 22.4 32 49
50
88
114 88 75 230 33×48×43 3000 429 612 25.9 129 25.9 129 31.1 43 61
53
103
144 103 85 250 39×58×46 3000 518 728 33.6 167 33.6 167 45.2 62 87
61
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-204.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-203
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model HSR Unit: mm
Model No. HSR 8 HSR 10 HSR 12 HSR 15 HSR 20 HSR 25 HSR 30 HSR 35 HSR 45 HSR 55 HSR 65 HSR 85 HSR 100 HSR 120 HSR 150
35 45 70 160 160 220 280 280 570 780 1270 1530 1340 1470 1600
55 70 110 220 220 280 360 360 675 900 1570 1890 1760 1930 2100
75 95 150 280 280 340 440 440 780 1020 2020 2250 2180 2390 2350
95 120 190 340 340 400 520 520 885 1140 2620 2610 2600
115 145 230 400 400 460 600 600 990 1260
135 170 270 460 460 520 680 680 1095 1380
155 195 310 520 520 580 760 760 1200 1500
175 220 350 580 580 640 840 840 1305 1620
195 245 390 640 640 700 920 920 1410 1740
215 270 430 700 700 760 1000 1000 1515 1860
235 295 470 760 760 820 1080 1080 1620 1980
255 320 510 820 820 940 1160 1160 1725 2100
275 345 550 940 940 1000 1240 1240 1830 2220
370 590 1000 1000 1060 1320 1320 1935 2340
LM rail 395 630 1060 1060 1120 1400 1400 2040 2460
standard length 420 670 1120 1120 1180 1480 1480 2145 2580
(LO) 445 1180 1180 1240 1560 1560 2250 2700
470 1240 1240 1300 1640 1640 2355 2820
1360 1360 1360 1720 1720 2460 2940
1480 1480 1420 1800 1800 2565 3060
1600 1600 1480 1880 1880 2670
1720 1540 1960 1960 2775
1840 1600 2040 2040 2880
1960 1720 2200 2200 2985
2080 1840 2360 2360 3090
2200 1960 2520 2520
2080 2680 2680
2200 2840 2840
2320 3000 3000
2440
A1-204
506E
HSR
LM Guide
Clearance
ℓ1
S1 F
(1) Determine the bolt length so that a clearance Table2 Dimensions of the LM Rail Tap
Unit: mm
of 2 to 5 mm is secured between the bolt
end and the bottom of the tap (effective tap Model No. S1 Effective tap depth ℓ1
depth). (See figure above.) HSR 15 M5 8
(2) A tapped-hole LM rail type is available also HSR 20 M6 10
for model HSR-YR. HSR 25 M6 12
(3) For standard pitches of the taps, see Table1 HSR 30 M8 15
HSR 35 M8 17
on A1-204.
HSR 45 M12 24
HSR 55 M14 24
HSR 65 M20 30
HSR30A2UU +1000LH K
Symbol for
tapped-hole LM rail type
A1-205
506E
Stopper
In miniature model HSR, the balls fall out if the LM block comes off the LM rail.
For this reason, they are delivered with a stopper fitted to prevent the LM block coming off the rail. If
you remove the stopper when using the product, take care to ensure that overrun does not occur.
Table3 Model HSR stopper (C type) specification table
Unit: mm
Model No. A B C A B
8 13 6 10
10 16 6 11
12 20 7 15
C
Greasing Hole
[Semi-standard Greasing Hole for Model HSR]
For model HSR, a semi-standard greasing hole is available. Specify the appropriate model number
according to the application.
Greasing hole
Greasing hole
Type with a Greasing Hole Drilled on the Side Surface Type with a Greasing Hole Drilled on the Top Face
A1-206
506E
HSR
LM Guide
A1-207
506E
SR
LM Guide Radial Type Model SR
LM block
Endplate
Grease nipple
End seal
90°
LM rail
Ball
Retainer plate 30°
Side seal (Optional)
Cross section
A1-208
506E
SR
LM Guide
[Compact, Heavy Load]
Since it is a compact designed model that has a low sectional height and a ball contact structure
rigid in the radial direction, this model is optimal for horizontal guide units.
[Low Noise]
The endplate installed at each end of the LM block is designed to ensure the smooth and low-noise
circulation of the balls at the turning areas.
[High Durability]
Even under a preload or excessive biased load, differential slip of balls is minimal. As a result, high
wear resistance and long-term maintenance of accuracy are achieved.
A1-209
506E
A1-210
506E
SR
LM Guide
A1-211
506E
Characteristics of Model SR
When compared to models having a contact angle of 45, model SR shows excellent characteristics
as indicated below. Using these characteristics, you can design and manufacture highly accurate
and highly rigid machines or equipment.
90
°
45°
Ball diameter and nominal life
(when the number of balls Z=24)
30 °
45°
108
Contact Structure Contact Structure
Nominal life (km)
P P
106
105
45°
90
°
Fig.1
Difference in Accuracy
If a machining error (grinding error) occurs in the LM rail or LM block, it will affect the running accuracy. Assum-
ing that there is a machining error of on the raceway, it results in an error in the radial direction, and the error
with the contact angle of 45 (model HSR) is 1.4 times greater than that of the contact angle of 90 (model SR).
As for the machining error resulting in horizontal direction error, the error with the contact angle of 45 is 1.22
times greater than the contact angle of 30 .
rΔ
ro
Gr
er
ind
G
ng
Error in radial direction Δ 1
rin
ing
di
di
90
err
45°
rin
30°
ng
or
45°
°
Δ
Error in radial direction Δ 2 G
er
Grinding error Δ
ro
rΔ
Contact structure of 90° (Model SR) Contact structure of 45° (Model HSR)
A1-212
506E
SR
Difference in Rigidity
The 90 contact angle adopted by model SR has a difference with the 45 contact angle also in rigidity.
When the same radial load “P” is applied, the displacement in the radial direction with model SR is only 56% of
that with the contact angle of 45. Accordingly, where high rigidity in the radial direction is required, model SR
is more advantageous. The figure below shows the difference in radial load and displacement.
LM Guide
Deflection in radial direction δ 2
Deflection in radial direction δ 1
δ2
n
io
ct
le
Deflection δ 1
ef
P1
D
P
P
45°
90
°
Load and deflection when contact angles are not the same (Da=6.35mm)
(deflection per ball)
20
Deflection (μm)
15
10
0
100 200 300 400 500 600
Applied load (N)
Conclusion
Model SR with this type of 90 contact construction are ideal for locations where the load applied is mostly
radial, locations where radial rigidity is required, and locations where accurate motion is demanded in the up,
down, left and right directions.
However, if the reverse radial load, the lateral load or the moment is large, we recommend model HSR, which
has a contact angle of 45 (4-way equal load).
A1-213
506E
T
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
SR25 W 2 UU C0 M +1240L Y P T M -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination Stainless steel LM rail length Stainless steel
protection LM block (in mm) LM rail Symbol for
number LM block accessory No. of rails used
symbol (*1) Applied to only Symbol for LM rail on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) 15 and 25 jointed use
used on the same Normal (No symbol)
Light preload (C1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
rail Medium preload (C0) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
SR
2-S×ℓ 4-S×ℓ
(E) L (E) L
L1 L1
LM Guide
C
φ d2 φ d2
N N
h h
M1 M1
φ d1 φ d1
F F
Model SR-V Model SR-W
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
(1240) 5.39 11.1 0.0326 0.224 0.0203 0.143 0.0654 0.12
15 9.5 12.5 60 3.5×6×4.5 1.2
3000 9.51 19.3 0.0925 0.516 0.0567 0.321 0.113 0.2
(1480) 7.16 14.4 0.053 0.332 0.0329 0.21 0.11 0.2
20 11 15.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 2.1
3000 12.5 25.2 0.146 0.778 0.0896 0.481 0.194 0.3
(2020) 11.7 22.5 0.103 0.649 0.0642 0.41 0.201 0.3
23 12.5 18 60 7×11×9 2.7
3000 20.3 39.5 0.286 1.52 0.175 0.942 0.355 0.4
(2520) 17.2 32.5 0.163 1.08 0.102 0.692 0.352 0.5
28 16 23 80 7×11×9 4.3
3000 30 56.8 0.494 2.55 0.303 1.57 0.611 0.8
(2520) 23.8 44.1 0.259 1.68 0.161 1.07 0.576 0.8
34 18 27.5 80 9×14×12 6.4
3000 41.7 77.2 0.74 4.01 0.454 2.49 1.01 1.2
45 20.5 35.5 105 11×17.5×14 3000 55.3 101 1.1 5.96 0.679 3.69 1.77 2.2 11.3
48 26 38 120 14×20×17 3000 89.1 157 2.27 11.3 1.39 6.98 2.87 3.6 12.8
70 28 47 150 18×26×22 3000 156 266 2.54 13.2 2.18 11.3 4.14 7 22.8
85 35.5 65.5 180 18×26×22 3000 120 224 2.54 15.1 1.25 7.47 5.74 10.1 34.9
100 39 70.3 210 22×32×25 3000 148 283 3.95 20.9 1.95 10.3 8.55 14.1 46.4
114 45.5 65 230 26×39×30 3000 279 377 5.83 32.9 2.87 16.2 13.7 — —
144 53 77 250 33×48×36 3000 411 537 9.98 55.8 4.92 27.5 24.3 — —
Note1) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this sym-
bol are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
Those model numbers including and greater than SR85T are semi-standard models. If desiring these models, contact THK.
Models SR85T and SR100T are equipped with grease nipple on the side face of the LM block.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-218.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Note2) For models SR15 and 25, two types of rails with different mounting hole dimensions are offered (see Table1).
When, replacing this model with model SSR, pay attention to the mounting hole dimension of the LM rail.
Contact THK for details.
Semi-Standard
Model No. Standard rail
rail
SR 15 For M3 (No symbol) For M4 (Symbol Y)
SR 25 For M6 (Symbol Y) For M5 (No symbol)
Options⇒A1-473 A1-215
506E
W
B
T1 T
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
SR25 TB 2 UU C1 +1200L Y H T -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol for
protection (in mm) LM rail Symbol for
number LM block accessory Applied to only jointed use No. of rails used
symbol (*1) 15 and 25 on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
rail Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
SR
2- φ H
LM Guide
4- φ H
(E) L (E) L
L1 L1
C
φ d2 φ d2
N N
h h
M1 M1
φ d1 φ d1
F F
Model SR-SB Model SR-TB
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
(1240) 5.39 11.1 0.0326 0.224 0.0203 0.143 0.0654 0.15
15 18.5 12.5 60 3.5×6×4.5 1.2
3000 9.51 19.3 0.0925 0.516 0.0567 0.321 0.113 0.2
(1480) 7.16 14.4 0.053 0.332 0.0329 0.21 0.11 0.3
20 19.5 15.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 2.1
3000 12.5 25.2 0.146 0.778 0.0896 0.481 0.194 0.4
(2020) 11.7 22.5 0.103 0.649 0.0642 0.41 0.201 0.4
23 25 18 60 7×11×9 2.7
3000 20.3 39.5 0.286 1.52 0.175 0.942 0.355 0.6
(2520) 17.2 32.5 0.163 1.08 0.102 0.692 0.352 0.8
28 31 23 80 7×11×9 4.3
3000 30 56.8 0.494 2.55 0.303 1.57 0.611 1.1
(2520) 23.8 44.1 0.259 1.68 0.161 1.07 0.576 1
34 33 27.5 80 9×14×12 6.4
3000 41.7 77.2 0.74 4.01 0.454 2.49 1.01 1.5
45 37.5 35.5 105 11×17.5×14 3000 55.3 101 1.1 5.96 0.679 3.69 1.77 2.5 11.3
48 46 38 120 14×20×17 3000 89.1 157 2.27 11.3 1.39 6.98 2.87 4.2 12.8
Note1) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-218.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with
each other
Note2) For models SR15 and 25, two types of rails with different mounting hole dimensions are offered (see Table1).
When, replacing this model with model SSR, pay attention to the mounting hole dimension of the LM rail.
Contact THK for details.
Table1 The dimension of the rail mounting hole
Semi-Standard
Model No. Standard rail
rail
SR 15 For M3 (No symbol) For M4 (Symbol Y)
SR 25 For M6 (Symbol Y) For M5 (No symbol)
Options⇒A1-473 A1-217
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SR Unit: mm
Model No. SR 15 SR 20 SR 25 SR 30 SR 35 SR 45 SR 55 SR 70 SR 85 SR 100 SR 120 SR 150
160 220 220 280 280 570 780 1270 1520 1550 1700 1600
220 280 280 360 360 675 900 1570 2060 1970 2390 2100
280 340 340 440 440 780 1020 2020 2600 2600
340 400 400 520 520 885 1140 2620
400 460 460 600 600 990 1260
460 520 520 680 680 1095 1380
520 580 580 760 760 1200 1500
580 640 640 840 840 1305 1740
640 700 700 920 920 1410 1860
700 760 760 1000 1000 1515 1980
760 820 820 1080 1080 1725 2100
820 940 940 1160 1160 1830 2220
940 1000 1000 1240 1240 1935 2340
1000 1060 1060 1320 1320 2040 2460
1060 1120 1120 1400 1400 2145 2580
1120 1180 1180 1480 1480 2250 2700
1180 1240 1240 1640 1640 2355 2820
LM rail 1240 1300 1300 1720 1720 2460 2940
standard length 1300 1360 1360 1800 1800 2565
(LO) 1360 1420 1420 1880 1880 2670
1420 1480 1480 1960 1960 2775
1480 1540 1540 2040 2040 2880
1540 1600 1600 2120 2120 2985
1660 1660 2200 2200
1720 1720 2280 2280
1780 1780 2360 2360
1840 1840 2440 2440
1900 1900 2520 2520
1960 1960 2600 2600
2020 2020 2680 2680
2080 2080 2760 2760
2140 2140 2840 2840
2200 2920 2920
2260
2320
2380
2440
Standard pitch F 60 60 60 80 80 105 120 150 180 210 230 250
G 20 20 20 20 20 22.5 30 35 40 40 45 50
3000 3000 3000 3000 3000
Max length 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000
(1240) (1480) (2020) (2520) (2520)
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
Note3) Those model numbers including and greater than SR85T are semi-standard models. If desiring these models, contact
THK.
Note4) The figures in the parentheses indicate the maximum lengths of stainless steel made models.
A1-218
506E
SR
LM Guide
Clearance
ℓ1
S1
(1) A tapped-hole LM rail type is available only Table2 Dimensions of the LM Rail Tap Unit: mm
for high accuracy or lower grades. Model No. S1 Effective tap depth ℓ1
(2) Determine the bolt length so that a clearance
SR 15 M5 7
of 2 to 5 mm is secured between the bolt
SR 20 M6 9
end and the bottom of the tap (effective tap
SR 25 M6 10
depth). (See figure above.)
SR 30 M8 14
(3) For standard pitches of the taps, see Table1
on A1-218. SR 35 M8 16
SR 45 M12 20
SR 55 M14 22
A1-219
506E
NR/NRS
LM Guide Ultra-heavy Load Type for Machine Tools Model NR/NRS
LM rail
LM block
Inner seal
Endplate
End seal
90
°
45°
Ball
Side seal
°
°
45
45
Oil valve
Radial Type 4 way Equal Load Type
Grease nipple
Model NR Model NRS
Cross section
A1-220
506E
NR/NRS
LM Guide
pact resistance and high damping capacity, all of which are required for machine tools, thus making
these models capable of bearing ultra-heavy loads.
* Due to the extremely high rigidity of the LM guides used in models NR/NRS, the construction does not easily absorb the
effects of mounting surface misalignment and installation errors. Where such effects arise, there is a risk of reduced operat-
ing life and/or malfunction. Contact THK when considering the use of these products.
[High Rigidity]
To increase the rigidity of the LM block and the LM rail, which may deteriorate the overall rigidity of
the LM Guide in the reverse radial and lateral directions, THK made full use of FEM to achieve opti-
mal design within the limited dimensional range.
THK provides two identically sized models with different characteristics, namely the radial model NR
and four-way equal-load model NRS, users can select the model that best suits their specifications.
[Ultra-heavy Load]
Since the curvature of the raceway is approximated to the ball diameter, the ball contact area under
a load is increased and the LM Guide is capable of receiving an ultra-heavy load.
A1-221
506E
A1-222
506E
NR/NRS
LM Guide
rated load.
A1-223
506E
Deflection δ 1
in model NR differs from that with a 45 contact
Deflection in radial direction δ’2
angle also in rigidity. Under the same radial load
2
nδ
P1
ctio
P, the displacement in the radial direction with P P
fle
De
model NR having a contact angle of 90 is 44%
less than the 45.
45°
90°
0 2 4 6 8 10
Applied load (kN)
[Increased Rigidity in the Lateral and Re- Fig.2 Radial Load and Deflection (normal clearance, no preload)
verse-radial Directions]
Since with LM Guide model NR, the distance “H”
between the rail bottom and the lower-groove
balls (balls receiving lateral loads) is short, the
ratio between the rail width “W” and the dis-
tance “H” is small, and the distance “T” between
the LM rail mounting bolt seat and the LM rail B
bottom is short. Accordingly, the deformation of H
the LM rail under a lateral load is minimal, and T A
the rigidity in the lateral directions is increased.
W
Since the dimension “B” of the LM block is short
and the thickness “A” is large, the lateral exten- Radial type structure
Fig.3 Cross Section of Model NR
sion of the LM block under a reverse radial or
lateral load is minimized. This structure allows
the rigidity in the reverse radial direction to be
increased.
In comparison to the old model with the same
model number, the ball diameter of NR is
smaller and the number of effective balls is ap-
proximately 1.3 times greater, thus increasing
the static rigidity.
A1-224
506E
NR/NRS
[Comparison of Contact Surface and Internal Stress between Different Contact Structures]
As shown in Fig.4, the contact area and the internal stress of a ball greatly vary depending on the
shape of contact surface.
With the conventional roller guide, the effective length is shorter than the apparent value due to the
retention of the rollers. Additionally, the change of stress distribution in the contact section caused
by a mounting error significantly affects the differential slip.
LM Guide
0.51Da 0.52Da 0.55Da
d1 < d 2 d1≒d2 d1≪d2
≒
Change in differential Change in differential Change in differential Change in differential
slip: none slip: none slip: large slip: large
Fig.4 Comparison of Contact Surface ( 6.350 ball, 6 x 6ℓ roller)
A1-225
506E
Model NR-R
Outer dimensions LM block dimensions
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510 (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77.
(*4) Specify the plate cover or the steel tape. (*5) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
NR/NRS
6-S×ℓ
(E) L
e0
**
4- φ D0
L1
C
f0
φ d2
N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Model NR-LR
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
33 84.6 0.771 3.86 0.469 2.33 0.91 0.43
25 12.5 17 40 6×9.5×8.5 3000 3.1
44 113 1.26 6.29 0.775 3.82 1.21 0.55
48.7 122 1.26 6.63 0.778 4.05 1.47 0.74
28 16 21 80 7×11×9 3000 4.3
64.9 162 2.18 10.6 1.33 6.47 1.95 1
63.1 155 1.75 9.47 1.08 5.8 2.24 1.1
34 18 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 6.2
85.7 210 3.14 15.5 1.92 9.43 3.03 1.4
96 231 3.37 17.7 2.07 10.8 4.45 2
45 20.5 29 105 14×20×17 3090 9.8
126 303 5.93 28 3.59 16.9 5.82 2.8
131 310 5.39 27.8 3.3 16.9 6.98 3.3
53 23.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3060 14.5
170 402 8.87 43.8 5.41 26.6 9.05 4.3
189 436 8.76 44.7 5.39 27.3 11.6 6
63 31.5 43 150 18×26×22 3000 20.3
260 600 16.8 79.9 10.1 48 15.9 8.7
271 610 14.4 73.3 8.91 44.7 19.3 8.7
75 35 44 150 22×32×26 3000 24.6
355 800 25.4 118 15.4 71.4 25.2 11.6
336 751 20.3 102 12.4 62.6 26.8 12.3
85 35.5 48 180 24×35×28 3000 30.5
435 972 34.7 160 21 96.2 34.6 15.8
479 1040 34 167 20.7 101 43.4 21.8
100 50 57 210 26×39×32 3000 42.6
599 1300 47.3 238 29.2 146 54.6 26.1
**
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-238.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-227
506E
Model NRS-R
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510 (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77.
(*4) Specify the plate cover or the steel tape. (*5) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
NR/NRS
6-S×ℓ
(E) L
L1 e0
**
4- φ D0
C
f0
φ d2
N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Model NRS-LR
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
25.9 59.8 0.568 2.84 0.568 2.84 0.633 0.43
25 12.5 17 40 6×9.5×8.5 3000 3.1
34.5 79.7 0.926 4.6 0.926 4.6 0.846 0.55
38.2 86.1 0.926 4.86 0.926 4.86 1.02 0.74
28 16 21 80 7×11×9 3000 4.3
51 115 1.6 7.83 1.6 7.83 1.36 1
49.5 109 1.28 6.92 1.28 6.92 1.54 1.1
34 18 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 6.2
67.2 148 2.29 11.3 2.29 11.3 2.09 1.4
75.3 163 2.47 13 2.47 13 3.09 2
45 20.5 29 105 14×20×17 3000 9.8
98.8 214 4.34 20.5 4.34 20.5 4.06 2.8
103 220 3.97 20.5 3.97 20.5 4.86 3.3
53 23.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3000 14.5
133 284 6.49 32 6.49 32 6.28 4.3
148 309 6.45 32.9 6.45 32.9 8.11 6
63 31.5 43 150 18×26×22 3000 20.3
204 425 12.3 58.6 12.3 58.6 11.1 8.7
212 431 10.6 53.8 10.6 53.8 13.4 8.7
75 35 44 150 22×32×26 3000 24.6
278 566 18.6 87 18.6 87 17.6 11.6
264 531 14.9 75.3 14.9 75.3 18.7 12.3
85 35.5 48 180 24×35×28 3000 30.5
342 687 25.4 117 25.4 117 24.2 15.8
376 737 25.1 123 25.1 123 30.4 21.8
100 50 57 210 26×39×32 3000 42.6
470 920 34.6 174 34.6 174 38.1 26.1
**
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-238.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-229
506E
Model NR-A
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510 (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-77.
(*4) Specify the plate cover or the steel tape. (*5) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
NR/NRS
6-S
(E) L
e0
**
4- φ D0
L1
C
f0
φ d2
N
h
LM Guide
M1
φ d1
F
Model NR-LA
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
33 84.6 0.771 3.86 0.469 2.33 0.91 0.58
25 23.5 17 40 6×9.5×8.5 3000 3.1
44 113 1.26 6.29 0.775 3.82 1.21 0.77
48.7 122 1.26 6.63 0.778 4.05 1.47 1.1
28 31 21 80 7×11×9 3000 4.3
64.9 162 2.18 10.6 1.33 6.47 1.95 1.4
63.1 155 1.75 9.47 1.08 5.8 2.24 1.5
34 33 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 6.2
85.7 210 3.14 15.5 1.92 9.43 3.03 1.9
96 231 3.37 17.7 2.07 10.8 4.45 2.7
45 37.5 29 105 14×20×17 3000 9.8
126 303 5.93 28 3.59 16.9 5.82 3.5
131 310 5.39 27.8 3.3 16.9 6.98 4.4
53 43.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3000 14.5
170 402 8.87 43.8 5.41 26.6 9.05 5.7
189 436 8.76 44.7 5.39 27.3 11.6 7.6
63 53.5 43 150 18×26×22 3000 20.3
260 600 16.8 79.9 10.1 48 15.9 10.9
271 610 14.4 73.3 8.91 44.7 19.3 11.3
75 60 44 150 22×32×26 3000 24.6
355 800 25.4 118 15.4 71.4 25.2 15
336 751 20.3 102 12.4 62.6 26.8 16.2
85 65 48 180 24×35×28 3000 30.5
435 972 34.7 160 21 96.2 34.6 20.7
479 1040 34 167 20.7 101 43.4 26.7
100 80 57 210 26×39×32 3000 42.6
599 1300 47.3 238 29.2 146 54.6 31.2
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples** are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-238.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-231
506E
B
C
f0
φ d2
N
T1 T h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Model NRS-A
NR/NRS
6-S
(E) L
e0
**
4- φ D0
L1
C
f0
φ d2
N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Model NRS-LA
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
-0.05 block blocks block blocks block
25.9 59.8 0.568 2.84 0.568 2.84 0.633 0.58
25 23.5 17 40 6×9.5×8.5 3000 3.1
34.5 79.7 0.926 4.6 0.926 4.6 0.846 0.77
38.2 86.1 0.926 4.86 0.926 4.86 1.02 1.1
28 31 21 80 7×11×9 3000 4.3
51 115 1.6 7.83 1.6 7.83 1.36 1.4
49.5 109 1.28 6.92 1.28 6.92 1.54 1.5
34 33 24.5 80 9×14×12 3000 6.2
67.2 148 2.29 11.3 2.29 11.3 2.09 1.9
75.3 163 2.47 13 2.47 13 3.09 2.7
45 37.5 29 105 14×20×17 3000 9.8
98.8 214 4.34 20.5 4.34 20.5 4.06 3.5
103 220 3.97 20.5 3.97 20.5 4.86 4.4
53 43.5 36.5 120 16×23×20 3000 14.5
133 284 6.49 32 6.49 32 6.28 5.7
148 309 6.45 32.9 6.45 32.9 8.11 7.6
63 53.5 43 150 18×26×22 3000 20.3
204 425 12.3 58.6 12.3 58.6 11.1 10.9
212 431 10.6 53.8 10.6 53.8 13.4 11.3
75 60 44 150 22×32×26 3000 24.6
278 566 18.6 87 18.6 87 17.6 15
264 531 14.9 75.3 14.9 75.3 18.7 16.2
85 65 48 180 24×35×28 3000 30.5
342 687 25.4 117 25.4 117 24.2 20.7
376 737 25.1 123 25.1 123 30.4 26.7
100 80 57 210 26×39×32 3000 42.6
470 920 34.6 174 34.6 174 38.1 31.2
Note) Pilot holes for side nipples** are not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the product.
THK will mount grease nipples per your request. Therefore, do not use the side nipple pilot holes** for purposes other
than mounting a grease nipple.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-238.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-233
506E
Model NR-B
NR/NRS
6- φ H
(E) L
e0
**
4- φ D0
L1
C
f0
φ d2
N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Model NR-LB
Unit: mm
Options⇒A1-473 A1-235
506E
Model NRS-B
NR/NRS
6- φ H
(E) L
e0
**
4- φ D0
L1
C
f0
φ d2
N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Model NRS-LB
Unit: mm
Options⇒A1-473 A1-237
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Models NR/NRS Unit: mm
Model No. NR/NRS25X NR/NRS30 NR/NRS35 NR/NRS45 NR/NRS55 NR/NRS65 NR/NRS75 NR/NRS85 NR/NRS100
230 280 280 570 780 1270 1280 1530 1340
270 360 360 675 900 1570 1580 1890 1760
350 440 440 780 1020 2020 2030 2250 2180
390 520 520 885 1140 2620 2630 2610 2600
470 600 600 990 1260
510 680 680 1095 1380
590 760 760 1200 1500
630 840 840 1305 1620
710 920 920 1410 1740
750 1000 1000 1515 1860
830 1080 1080 1620 1980
950 1160 1160 1725 2100
990 1240 1240 1830 2220
1070 1320 1320 1935 2340
1110 1400 1400 2040 2460
LM rail 1190 1480 1480 2145 2580
standard length
1230 1560 1560 2250 2700
(LO)
1310 1640 1640 2355 2820
1350 1720 1720 2460 2940
1430 1800 1800 2565
1470 1880 1880 2670
1550 1960 1960 2775
1590 2040 2040 2880
1710 2200 2200 2985
1830 2360 2360
1950 2520 2520
2070 2680 2680
2190 2840 2840
2310 3000 3000
2430
2470
A1-238
506E
NR/NRS
LM Guide
A1-239
506E
HRW
LM Guide Wide Rail Model HRW
Endplate
Grease nipple
45°
Ball 45°
Retainer plate
Cross section
A1-240
506E
HRW
LM Guide
Each row of balls is placed at a contact angle of 45 so that the rated loads applied to the LM block
are uniform in the four directions (radial, reverse radial and lateral directions), enabling the LM
Guide to be used in all orientations. In addition, the LM block can receive a well-balanced preload,
increasing the rigidity in four directions while maintaining a constant, low friction coefficient. In a low
center of gravity structure with a large rail width and a low overall height, this model can be used in
places where space saving is required or high rigidity against a moment is required even in a single
axis configuration.
[Self-adjustment Capability]
The self-adjustment capability through front-to-front configuration of THK’s unique circular-arc
grooves (DF set) enables a mounting error to be absorbed even under a preload, thus to achieve
highly accurate, smooth straight motion.
A1-241
506E
A1-242
506E
HRW
LM Guide
A1-243
506E
W
6-S
( φ H through) B
T1 T
M (K)
H3
W3
W2 W1
HRW 17CA
17 60 50.8 53 26 3.3 M4 33.6 5.5 6 14.5 4 2 PB107 2.5
HRW 17CAM
HRW 21CA
21 68 58.8 60 29 4.4 M5 40 7.3 8 18 4.5 12 B-M6F 3
HRW 21CAM
HRW 27CA
27 80 72.8 70 40 5.3 M6 51.8 9.5 10 24 6 12 B-M6F 3
HRW 27CAM
HRW 35CA
35 120 106.6 107 60 6.8 M8 77.6 13 14 31 8 12 B-M6F 4
HRW 35CAM
HRW 50CA 50 162 140.5 144 80 8.6 M10 103.5 16.5 18 46.6 14 16 B-PT1/8 3.4
HRW 60CA 60 200 158.9 180 80 10.5 M12 117.5 23.5 25 53.5 15 16 B-PT1/8 6.5
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this symbol
are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
HRW35 CA 2 UU C1 M +1000L P T M
Model Type of Contamination Stainless steel LM rail length Symbol
protection Stainless steel
number LM block LM block (in mm) for LM rail LM rail
accessory jointed use
symbol (*1)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77.
HRW
(E) L
LM Guide
L1
C
φ d2
N
h
M1
φ d1
Unit: mm
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
1900
33 13.5 18 9 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 4.31 8.14 0.0417 0.244 0.0417 0.244 0.128 0.15 2.1
(800)
3000
37 15.5 22 11 50 4.5×7.5×5.3 6.18 11.5 0.0701 0.398 0.0701 0.398 0.194 0.25 2.9
(1000)
3000
42 19 24 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 11.5 20.4 0.156 0.874 0.156 0.874 0.398 0.5 4.3
(1200)
69 25.5 40 19 80 7×11×9 3000 27.2 45.9 0.529 2.89 0.529 2.89 1.49 1.4 9.9
90 36 60 24 80 9×14×12 3000 50.2 81.5 1.25 6.74 1.25 6.74 3.46 4 14.6
120 40 80 31 105 11×17.5×14 3000 63.8 102 1.76 12.3 1.76 12.3 5.76 5.7 27.8
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-248.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-245
506E
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
φd C
N φ d2
T h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Greasing
Model No. Height Width Length
hole Grease
nipple
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E d H3
HRW27 CR 2 UU C1 M +820L P T M
Model Type of Contamination Stainless LM rail length Symbol
protection Stainless steel
number LM block steel (in mm) for LM rail LM rail
accessory LM block jointed use
symbol (*1)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77.
To download a desired data, search for
A1-246 the corresponding model number in the Technical site. https://tech.thk.com
506E
HRW
W
4-S×ℓ B
T
M (K)
H3
W3
W2 W1
LM Guide
Models HRW17 and 21CR/CRM
(E) L
W
6-S×ℓ B L1
C
φ d2
T N
M (K)
h
M1
H3
W3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
18 6 — 6.5 40 4.5×8×4.5 (1000) 3.29 7.16 0.0262 0.138 0.013 0.069 0.051 0.045 0.79
24 8 — 7.2 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 (1430) 5.38 11.4 0.0499 0.273 0.025 0.137 0.112 0.08 1.2
1900
33 8.5 18 9 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 4.31 8.14 0.0417 0.244 0.0417 0.244 0.128 0.12 2.1
(800)
3000
37 8.5 22 11 50 4.5×7.5×5.3 6.18 11.5 0.0701 0.398 0.0701 0.398 0.194 0.19 2.9
(1000)
3000
42 10 24 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 11.5 20.4 0.156 0.874 0.156 0.874 0.398 0.37 4.3
(1200)
69 15.5 40 19 80 7×11×9 3000 27.2 45.9 0.529 2.89 0.529 2.89 1.49 1.2 9.9
90 20 60 24 80 9×14×12 3000 50.2 81.5 1.25 6.74 1.25 6.74 3.46 3.2 14.6
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-248.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-247
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model HRW Unit: mm
Model No. HRW 12 HRW 14 HRW 17 HRW 21 HRW 27 HRW 35 HRW 50 HRW 60
70 70 110 130 160 280 280 570
110 110 190 230 280 440 440 885
150 150 310 380 340 760 760 1200
190 190 470 480 460 1000 1000 1620
LM rail 230 230 550 580 640 1240 1240 2040
standard length 270 270 780 820 1560 1640 2460
(LO) 310 310 2040
390 390
470 470
550
670
Standard pitch F 40 40 40 50 60 80 80 105
G 15 15 15 15 20 20 20 22.5
1900 3000 3000
Max length (1000) (1430) 3000 3000 3000
(800) (1000) (1200)
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
Note3) The figures in the parentheses indicate the maximum lengths of stainless steel made models.
Stopper
In miniature model HRW, the balls fall out if the LM block comes off the LM rail.
For this reason, they are delivered with a stopper fitted to prevent the LM block coming off the rail. If
you remove the stopper when using the product, take care to ensure that overrun does not occur.
Table2 Model HRW stopper (C type) specification table
Unit: mm A B
Model No. A B C
12 22 7 10.5
14 29 7.8 11.2
C
A1-248
506E
HRW
LM Guide
A1-249
506E
RSR
LM Guide Miniature Types Model RSR
Endplate
LM block
End seal
LM rail
Ball
Grease nipple
Cross section
A1-250
506E
RSR
LM Guide
The LM block is designed to have a shape with high rigidity in a limited space, and in combination
with large-diameter balls, demonstrates high rigidity in all directions.
[Ultra Compact]
The absence of cage displacement, a problem that cross-roller guides and types of ball slides with
finite stroke tend to cause, make these models highly reliable LM systems.
A1-251
506E
A1-252
506E
RSR
LM Guide
Model RSR-TN Specification Table⇒A1-256
Has position of LM block mounting holes
changed compared with RSR-N.
A1-253
506E
MA=24.5N•m MA=0.42N•m
Mc=59.5N•m Mc=26.1N•m
C = 746N
C =4020N φ 10 Radial load
40 Radial load C0=6080N C0=1098N
25
14
24 LM10 47.5
72.5
Model RSR12WV
Linear Bushing Model LM10
Fig.1
17
12
A1-254
506E
RSR
LM Guide
When using this model in locations where it is difficult to obtain satisfactory accuracy of the mount-
ing surface, we recommend using types RSR…A (semi standard) whose ball raceways have circu-
lar-arc grooves. (avoid using these types in a single-rail configuration).
For specific accuracy of the mounting surface for types RSR…A, [Flatness of the Mounting Surface]
is on A1-468.
A1-255
506E
M (K)
M1
H3
W2 W1 F
Model RSR3M
L
L1
W 2-S×ℓ C
M1.6 through
M (K)
M1
H3
W2 W1 F
Model RSR3N
Greasing
Model No. Height Width Length
hole Grease
nipple
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E d H3
2 RSR5 M UU C1 +130L P M -Ⅱ
Model number Contamination LM rail length Stainless
protection Symbol for
accessory (in mm) steel No. of rails used
symbol (*1) LM rail on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks
used on the same rail Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/Precision grade (P)
Light preload (C1)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-83. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
RSR
W 2-S×ℓ
B L
φd
φ d2 L1
N 〃 〃
h
M (K)
H3 M1
φ d1
LM Guide
W2 W1 F
Models RSR5M/5TN
L
W 2-S×ℓ L1
φd φ d2 C
N
h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Model RSR5N
Unit: mm
1 Double 1 Double 1
W1 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
0 0.18 0.27 0.293 2.11 0.293 2.11 0.45 0.0011
3 2.5 2.6 10 — 220 0.055
–0.02 0.3 0.44 0.726 4.33 0.726 4.33 0.73 0.0016
0
0.32 0.59 0.884 6.51 0.884 6.51 1.53 0.003
5 3.5 4 15 2.4×3.5×1 480 0.55 0.96 1.84 11.9 1.84 11.9 2.49 0.004 0.14
–0.02
0.55 0.96 1.84 11.9 1.84 11.9 2.49 0.004
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-264.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
● Recommended tightening torque when mounting the LM rail/block
Table1 shows recommended bolt tightening torques when mounting the LM block and LM rail of
models RSR3M/3N.
Table1 Recommended Tightening Torques of Mounting Bolts
Recommended
Model No. of screw
tightening torque (N-m)
M1.6 0.09
M2 0.19
Note) Applicable to austenite stainless steel hexagonal-socket-head type bolts.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-257
506E
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
φd C
φ d2
N
(K) h
M M1
H3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
Greasing
Model No. Height Width Length
hole Grease
nipple
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E d H3
2 RSR15V M UU C1 +230L P M -Ⅱ
Model number Contamination LM rail length Stainless Symbol for
protection (in mm) steel No. of rails used
accessory LM rail on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks symbol (*1)
used on the same rail
Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-83. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
RSR
W (E) L
4-S×ℓ B L1
C
LM Guide
φ d2
T N
(K)
M h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
1 Double 1 Double 1
W1 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
0 0.88 1.37 2.93 20.8 2.93 20.8 5 0.013
7 5 4.7 15 2.4×4.2×2.3 480 0.23
–0.02 1.59 2.5 8.68 49.9 8.68 49.9 9.12 0.018
0 1.47 2.25 7.34 43.3 7.34 43.3 10.4 0.018
9 5.5 5.5 20 3.5×6×3.3 1240 0.32
–0.02 2.6 3.96 18.4 97 18.4 97 18.4 0.027
0 2.65 4.02 11.4 74.9 10.1 67.7 19.2 0.037
12 7.5 7.5 25 3.5×6×4.5 1430 0.58
–0.025 4.3 6.65 28.9 163 25.5 145 31.8 0.055
0 4.41 6.57 23.7 149 21.1 135 38.8 0.069
15 8.5 9.5 40 3.5×6×4.5 1600 0.925
–0.025 7.16 10.7 63.1 330 55.6 293 63 0.093
0 8.82 12.7 75.4 435 66.7 389 96.6 0.245
20 13 15 60 6×9.5×8.5 1800 1.95
–0.03 14.2 20.6 171 897 151 795 157 0.337
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-264.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-259
506E
2-S×ℓ L
W L1
φd φ d2 C
N
h
M (K)
H3 M1
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Greasing
Model No. Height Width Length
hole Grease
nipple
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E d H3
RSR 3WM 14.9 4.5 8.5
4.5 12 — M2×1.7 — 3.5 0.8 — 0.8 — 1
RSR 3WN 19.9 8 13.3
RSR 5WM 22.1 — 6.5 M3×2.3 13.7
RSR 5WTM 22.1 13 — M2.5×1.5 13.7
6.5 17 — 5 1.1 — 0.8 — 1.5
RSR 5WN 28.1 — 11 M3×2.3 19.7
RSR 5WTN 28.1 13 — M2.5×1.5 19.7
RSR 7WM 31 — 12 M4×3.5 20.4
RSR 7WTM 31 19 8 M3×3 20.4
9 25 — 7 1.6 — 1.2 — 2
RSR 7WN 40.9 — 18 M4×3.5 30.3
RSR 7WTN 40.9 19 17 M3×3 30.3
Note) The LM block, rail, and ball material are composed of stainless steel and are corrosion resistant to general environments.
To secure the LM rail of models RSR3WM and 3WN, use cross-recessed head screws for precision equipment (No. 0
pan head screw, class 1) M2.
2 RSR7WM UU C1 +130L P M
Model number Contamination LM rail length Stainless steel
protection (in mm) LM rail
accessory
No. of LM blocks symbol (*1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same rail Radial clearance symbol (*2) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Normal (No symbol) Precision grade (P)
Light preload (C1)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-83.
RSR
W (E) L
2-S×ℓ B L1
φ d2 〃 〃
N
N
M (K)
M1 h
H3
φ d1
LM Guide
W2 W1 F
Models RSR5WTM/WTN
W L
B L1
4-S×ℓ C
φ d2
N
h
M (K)
H3 M1
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Models RSR7WTM/WTN
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment N-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
1 Double 1 Double 1
W1 W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
0 0.25 0.47 0.668 4.44 0.668 4.44 1.48 0.002
6 3 — 2.6 15 2.4×4×1.5 480 0.12
–0.02 0.39 0.75 1.57 9.06 1.57 9.06 2.36 0.003
0.51 0.96 1.97 13.1 1.97 13.1 4.89 0.007
0 0.51 0.96 1.97 13.1 1.97 13.1 4.89 0.007
10 3.5 — 4 20 3×5.5×3 480 0.28
–0.025 0.75 1.4 4.06 23.5 4.06 23.5 7.13 0.01
0.75 1.4 4.06 23.5 4.06 23.5 7.13 0.01
1.37 2.16 7.02 40.7 7.02 40.7 15.4 0.021
0 1.37 2.16 7.02 40.7 7.02 40.7 15.4 0.021
14 5.5 — 5.2 30 3.5×6×3.2 480 0.51
–0.05 2.04 3.21 14.7 77.6 14.7 77.6 22.9 0.026
2.04 3.21 14.7 77.6 14.7 77.6 22.9 0.026
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-264.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-261
506E
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
φd C
φ d2
N
T h
M (K)
H3 M1
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Greasing
Model No. Height Width Length
hole Grease
nipple
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E d H3
RSR 9WV 39 21 12 M2.6×3 27
* RSR 9WVM 12 30 39 21 12 M2.6×3 27 — 7.8 2 — 1.6 — 4.2
* RSR 9WN 50.7 23 24 M3×3 38.7
RSR 12WV 44.5 15 30.9
* RSR 12WVM 14 40 44.5 28 15 M3×3.5 30.9 4.5 10 3 — 2 — 4
* RSR 12WN 59.5 28 45.9
* RSR 14WVM 15 50 50 35 18 M4×4.5 34.3 6 11.5 3 4 — PB107 3.5
RSR 15WV 55.5 20 38.9
* RSR 15WVM 16 60 55.5 45 20 M4×4.5 38.9 5.6 12 3.5 3 — PB107 4
* RSR 15WN 74.5 35 57.9
Note) *The LM block, rail, and ball material are composed of stainless steel and are corrosion resistant to general
environments.
2 RSR12WV M UU C1 +310L H M
Model number Contamination LM rail length Stainless steel
protection (in mm) LM rail
accessory Accuracy symbol (*3)
No. of LM blocks symbol (*1) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
used on the same rail Radial clearance symbol (*2) Precision grade (P)
Normal (No symbol)/Light preload (C1)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-83.
RSR
W (E) L
4-S×ℓ B L1
C
φ d2
N
T N
M (K)
M1 h
H3
φ d1
F
LM Guide
W2 W1
Model RSR14WVM
W (E) L
4-S×ℓ L1
B
C
φ d2
T N
M (K)
M1 h
H3
W3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
Models RSR15WV/WVM/WN
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment N-m Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
1 Double 1 Double 1
W1 W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
0
2.45 3.92 16 92.9 16 92.9 36 0.035
18 6 — 7.5 30 3.5×6×4.5 1430 2.45 3.92 16 92.9 16 92.9 36 0.035 1.08
–0.05
3.52 5.37 31 161 31 161 49.4 0.051
0
4.02 6.08 24.5 138 21.7 123 59.5 0.075
24 8 — 8.5 40 4.5×8×4.5 1600 4.02 6.08 24.5 138 21.7 123 59.5 0.075 1.5
–0.05
5.96 9.21 53.9 274 47.3 242 90.1 0.101
0
30 10 — 9 40 4.5×7.5×5.3 1800 6.01 9.08 43.2 233 38.2 208 110 0.096 2
–0.05
0
6.66 9.8 50.3 278 44.4 248 168 0.17
42 9 23 9.5 40 4.5×8×4.5 1800 6.66 9.8 50.3 278 44.4 248 168 0.17 3
–0.05
9.91 14.9 110 555 97.3 490 255 0.21
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-264.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-263
506E
G F G
L0
Table2 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model RSR/RSR-W Unit: mm
Model No. RSR 3 RSR 5 RSR 7 RSR 9 RSR 12 RSR 15 RSR 20 RSR 3W RSR 5W RSR 7W RSR 9W RSR 12W RSR 14W RSR 15W
30 40 40 55 70 70 220 40 50 50 50 70 110 110
40 55 55 75 95 110 280 55 70 80 80 110 150 150
60 70 70 95 120 150 340 70 90 110 110 150 190 190
80 100 85 115 145 190 460 110 140 140 190 230 230
100 130 100 135 170 230 640 130 170 170 230 270 270
LM rail 160 130 155 195 270 880 150 200 200 270 310 310
standard 175 220 310 1000 170 260 260 310 430 430
length 195 245 350 290 290 390 550 550
(LO) 275 270 390 320 470 670 670
375 320 430 550 790 790
370 470
470 550
570 670
870
Standard pitch F 10 15 15 20 25 40 60 15 20 30 30 40 40 40
G 5 5 5 7.5 10 15 20 5 5 10 10 15 15 15
Max length 220 480 480 1240 1430 1600 1800 480 480 480 1430 1600 1800 1800
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) The LM rail mounting hole of model RSR3 is an M1.6 through hole.
Stopper
In model RSR/RSR-W, the balls fall out if the LM block comes off the LM rail.
For this reason, they are delivered with a stopper fitted to prevent the LM block coming off the rail. If
you remove the stopper when using the product, take care to ensure that overrun does not occur.
Table3 Model RSR/RSR-W stopper (C type)
specification table
Unit: mm
Model No. A B C
A B
7 11 5 7.7
9 13 6 9.5
12 16 7 12.5
15 19 7 14.5 C
20 25 7 20.0
7W 18 6 8.2
9W 23 7 11.5
12W 29 7 13.5
14W 33.8 7 13 Fig.1 Model RSR/RSR-W stopper (C type)
15W 46 7 14.5
Note) Models RSR3M/N, 5M/N and 5W use O-rings, while
model RSR3W uses silicon tubing.
A1-264
506E
RSR
LM Guide
A1-265
506E
RSR-Z
LM Guide Miniature Type (Low Cost Type) Model RSR-Z
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
End seal
(Optional)
Side seal
Ball
A1-266
506E
RSR-Z
LM Guide
Also, it has the same dimensions as models RSR/RSR-W, but achieves a lighter weight and a lower
price.
[Lightweight]
Since part of the LM block body uses a resin material, the block mass is reduced by up to 28% from
the conventional type model RSR-V. This makes RSR-Z a low-inertia type.
[Smooth Motion]
The unique structure of the endplate allows the balls to circulate smoothly and infinitely.
[Low Noise]
60
Since the unloaded ball path is made of resin, RSR12V
Noise level (dBA)
55
there is no metal to metal contact and low noise
50
is achieved.
45
40
RSR12Z
35
30
0
20 40 60 80 100
Speed (m/min)
Fig.1 Noise Levels of Models RSR12Z and RSR12V
A1-267
506E
A1-268
506E
RSR-Z
LM Guide
A1-269
506E
Model RSR-ZM
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
φd C
φ d2
N
T h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Greasing
Model No. Height Width Length
hole Grease
nipple
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E d H3
RSR 7ZM 8 17 23.4 12 8 M2×2.5 13.2 3.4 6.5 1.6 — 1.5 — 1.5
RSR 9ZM 10 20 30.8 15 10 M3×2.7 19.4 4.6 7.8 2.4 — 1.6 — 2.2
RSR 15ZM 16 32 43 25 20 M3×3.5 26.5 5.5 12.6 2.9 3.6 — PB107 3.4
Note) Since stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls, these models are highly resistant to corrosion and
environment.
2 RSR15Z M UU C1 +230L P M -Ⅱ
Model number Contamination LM rail length Stainless Symbol for
protection (in mm) steel No. of rails used
accessory LM rail on the same plane (*4)
symbol (*1)
No. of LM blocks
used on the same rail Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-83. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
RSR-Z
(E)
W L
4-S×ℓ
LM Guide
B L1
C
φ d2
T N
M (K) h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Model RSR15ZM
Unit: mm
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-271
506E
Model RSR-WZM
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
φd φ d2 C
N
T
M (K) h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Greasing
Model No. Height Width Length
hole Grease
nipple
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E d H3
RSR 15WZM 16 60 55.5 45 20 M4×4.5 39.3 5.4 12.6 3 3.6 — PB107 3.4
Note) Since stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls, these models are highly resistant to corrosion and
environment.
2 RSR12WZ M SS C1 +390L H M
Model number Contamination LM rail length Stainless steel
protection (in mm) LM rail
accessory
No. of LM blocks symbol (*1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same rail Radial clearance symbol (*2) Normal grade (No Symbol)
Normal (No symbol) High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-83.
RSR-Z
W (E) L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
LM Guide
C
φ d2
T N
M (K)
M1 h
H3
W3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
Model RSR15WZM
Unit: mm
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-273
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model RSR-Z/WZ Unit: mm
Model No. RSR 7Z RSR 9Z RSR 12Z RSR 15Z RSR 7WZ RSR 9WZ RSR 12WZ RSR 15WZ
40 55 70 70 50 50 70 110
55 75 95 110 80 80 110 150
70 95 120 150 110 110 150 190
85 115 145 190 140 140 190 230
100 135 170 230 170 170 230 270
130 155 195 270 200 200 270 310
LM rail 175 220 310 260 260 310 430
standard length
195 245 350 290 290 390 550
(LO)
275 270 390 320 470 670
375 320 430 550 790
370 470
470 550
570 670
870
Standard pitch F 15 20 25 40 30 30 40 40
G 5 7.5 10 15 10 10 15 15
Max length 480 1240 1430 1600 480 1430 1600 1800
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) The LM rails of these models are all made of stainless steel.
Stopper
In models RSR-Z/RSR-WZ, the balls fall out if the LM block comes off the LM rail.
For this reason, they are delivered with a stopper fitted to prevent the LM block coming off the rail. If
you remove the stopper when using the product, take care to ensure that overrun does not occur.
Table2 Model RSR-Z/RSR-WZ stopper (C type) specification table
Unit: mm
Model No. A B C
7 11 5 7.7 A B
9 13 6 9.5
12 16 7 12.5
15 19 7 14.5
7W 18 6 8.2 C
9W 23 7 11.5
12W 29 7 13.5
15W 46 7 14.5
A1-274
506E
RSR-Z
LM Guide
A1-275
506E
HR
LM Guide Separate Type (4-way Equal Load) Model HR
LM rail
End seal
Endplate
45゚
LM block
Ball
A1-276
506E
HR
LM Guide
the raceway at 45, the same load can be applied in all directions (radial, reverse radial and lateral
directions) if a set of LM rails and LM block is mounted on the same plane (i.e., when two LM rails
are combined with an LM block on the same plane). Furthermore, since the sectional height is low, a
compact and stable linear guide mechanism is achieved.
This structure makes clearance adjustment relatively easy, and is highly capable of absorbing a
mounting error.
[Easy Installation]
Model HR is easier to adjust a clearance and achieve more accuracy than cross-roller guides.
[Self-adjustment Capability]
Even if the parallelism or the level between the two rails is poorly established, the self-adjustment
capability through front-to-front configuration of THK’s unique circular-arc grooves (DF set) enables
a mounting error to be absorbed and smooth straight motion to be achieved even under a preload.
A1-277
506E
A1-278
506E
HR
LM Guide
1 2
A1-279
506E
30 30
18 18 15 15
HR918 VR3
42 40
23 22
20 20
11 11
58
55
25 28
HR2555 VR12
71
75
35 36
HR3575 VR15
85 83
40 40
HR4085 VR18
Fig.1
A1-280
506E
HR
LM Guide
A1-281
506E
B1
φd
2-S
C
W0 L
φ d2 L1
W
h
M T(K) M1
W4
φ d1
W1
A F
M W W0 L B1 C H S h2 L1 T K d D1
HR 918
8.5 11.4 18 45 5.5 15 — M3 — 25 7.5 8 1.5 —
HR 918M
HR 1123
11 13.7 23 52 7 15 2.55 M3 3 30 9.5 10 2 5
HR 1123M
HR 1530
15 19.2 30 69 10 20 3.3 M4 3.5 40 13 14 2 6.5
HR 1530M
HR 2042
20 26.3 42 91.6 13 35 5.3 M6 5.5 56.6 17.5 19 3 10
HR 2042M
HR 2042T
20 26.3 42 110.7 13 50 5.3 M6 5.5 75.7 17.5 19 3 10
HR 2042TM
HR 2555
25 33.3 55 121 16 45 6.8 M8 7 80 22.5 24 3 11
HR 2555M
HR 2555T
25 33.3 55 146.4 16 72 6.8 M8 7 105.4 22.5 24 3 11
HR 2555TM
Note) Symbol M indicates that stainless steel is used in the LM block, LM rail and balls. Those models marked with this symbol
are therefore highly resistant to corrosion and environment.
2 HR2555 UU M +1000L P T M
Model number Contamination LM rail length Symbol for Stainless steel
protection (in mm) LM rail LM rail
accessory jointed use
No. of LM blocks symbol (*1) Stainless steel Accuracy symbol (*2)
used on the same rail LM block Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-81.
Note) One set of model HR means a combination of two LM rails and an LM blocks used on the same plane.
HR
B1
φd
2-S
( φ H through) C
LM Guide
W0 L
W L1
φ d2
h
M T(K) M1
W4 φ D1 h2
W1 φ d1
A F
9.5 5 11.6 8 40 3.5×6×4.5 500 2.35 4.31 0.0414 0.272 0.0414 0.272 0.03 0.5
10.7 6 13.5 11 60 3.5×6×4.5 1600 4.31 7.65 0.0982 0.641 0.0982 0.641 0.08 1
15.6 8 19.5 14.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 2200 9.9 17.2 0.308 1.91 0.308 1.91 0.13 1.8
15.6 8 19.5 14.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 2200 13.6 22.9 0.53 2.99 0.53 2.99 0.26 1.8
22 10 27 18 80 9×14×12 2600 18.6 30.5 0.783 4.41 0.783 4.41 0.43 3.2
22 10 27 18 80 9×14×12 3000 25.1 40.8 1.33 6.95 1.33 6.95 0.5 3.2
Note) A moment in the direction MC can be received if two rails are used in parallel. However, since it depends on the distance be-
tween the two rails, the moment in the direction MC is omitted here.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-286.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: Static permissible moment value with one LM block mounted on two LM rails used
on the same plane
Double blocks: Static permissible moment value with 2 blocks in close contact with each
other on 2 LM blocks used on the same plane
Options⇒A1-473 A1-283
506E
W0
W
M T(K)
W4
W1
A
M W W0 L B1 C H S h2 L1 T K d D1
HR 3065 145 50 90
30 40.3 65 19 8.6 M10 9 27.5 29 4 14
HR 3065T 173.5 80 118.5
HR 3575 154.8 60 103.8
35 44.9 75 21.5 10.5 M12 12 32 34 4 18
HR 3575T 182.5 92.5 131.5
HR 4085 177.8 70 120.8
40 50.4 85 24 12.5 M14 13 36 38 4 20
HR 4085T 215.9 110 158.9
HR 50105 227 85 150
50 63.4 105 30 14.5 M16 15.5 45 48 5 23
HR 50105T 274.5 130 197.5
HR 60125 60 74.4 125 329 35 160 18 M20 18 236 55 58 5 26
2 HR4085T UU +1500L P T
Model number Contamination LM rail length Symbol for LM rail
protection (in mm) jointed use
accessory
symbol (*1) Accuracy symbol (*2)
No. of LM blocks Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
used on the same rail Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-81.
Note) One set of model HR means a combination of two LM rails and an LM blocks used on the same plane.
HR
B1
φd
LM Guide
2-S
( φ H through) C
L
L1
φ d2
h
M1
φ D1 h2
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m * Mass
MA MB
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0 block rail
Options⇒A1-473 A1-285
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model HR Unit: mm
Model No. HR 918 HR 1123 HR 1530 HR 2042 HR 2555 HR 3065 HR 3575 HR 4085 HR 50105 HR 60125
70 110 160 220 280 280 570 780 1270 1530
120 230 280 280 440 440 885 1020 1570 1890
LM rail 220 310 340 340 600 600 1200 1260 2020 2250
standard length 295 390 460 460 760 760 1620 1500 2620 2610
(LO) 580 640 1000 1000 2040 1980
1240 1240 2460 2580
A1-286
506E
HR
Accessories
LM Guide
ance.
If it is inevitable to use the mounting method as indicated by Fig.3 for a structural reason, the dedi-
cated mounting bolt as shown in Fig.4 is required for securing the LM block. Be sure to specify that
the dedicated mounting bolt is required when ordering the LM Guide.
D1
d1
Fig.2 Fig.3
A1-287
506E
Greasing Hole
A1-288
506E
HR
LM Guide
A1-289
506E
GSR
LM Guide Separate Type (Radial) Model GSR
LM block
Endplate
End seal
LM rail
Ball
Retainer plate
Side seal
Cross section
A1-290
506E
GSR
LM Guide
applied simply by securing the LM block with mounting bolts.
Model GSR has a special contact structure using circular-arc grooves. This increases self-adjusting
capability and makes GSR an optimal model for places associated with difficulty establishing high
accuracy and for general industrial machinery.
* Model GSR cannot be used in single-axis applications.
[Interchangeability]
Both the LM block and LM rail are interchangeable and can be stored separately. Therefore, it is
possible to store a long-size LM rail and cut it to a desired length before using it.
[Compact]
Since model GSR has a low center of gravity structure with a low overall height, the machine can be
downsized.
A1-291
506E
A1-292
506E
GSR
LM Guide
Fig.1 Example of Adjusting a Preload with a Push Bolt
A1-293
506E
N1
φ d2
N
T h
(K1)
M (K)
M1
H3
W4
φ d1
W1
F
W2
GSR
4-S×ℓ
W (E) L
B B1 L1
C
φ d2
LM Guide
N
(K1) T h
M (K)
M1
H3
W4
W1 φ d1
W2 F
Models GSR20 to 35T, Models GSR20V and 25V Models GSR15 to 35T
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
Double Double
W1 W2 W4 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN 1 block 1 block kg kg/m
blocks blocks
4.31 5.59 0.0252 0.158 0.0218 0.136 0.08
15 25 7.5 11.5 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 2000 1.2
5.69 8.43 0.0525 0.292 0.0452 0.252 0.13
7.01 8.82 0.0498 0.307 0.0431 0.265 0.17
20 33 10 13 60 6×9.5×8.5 3000 1.8
9.22 13.2 0.102 0.564 0.0885 0.486 0.25
10.29 12.65 0.0858 0.522 0.0742 0.451 0.29
23 38 11.5 16.5 60 7×11×9 3000 2.6
13.5 19 0.177 0.965 0.152 0.831 0.5
28 44.5 14 19 80 9×14×12 3000 18.8 25.9 0.282 1.54 0.243 1.32 0.6 3.6
34 54 17 22 80 11×17.5×14 3000 25.1 33.8 0.421 2.28 0.362 1.96 1 5
Note) A moment in the direction MC can be received if two rails are used in parallel. However, since it depends on the distance be-
tween the two rails, the moment in the direction MC is omitted here.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-296.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Clients who require wall-mounted installations or oil lubrication should contact THK.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-295
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model GSR Unit: mm
Standard pitch F 60 60 60 80 80
G 20 20 20 20 20
Max length 2000 3000 3000 3000 3000
Note) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
(1) Determine the bolt length so that a clearance of 2 to 3 mm is secured between the bolt end and
the bottom of the tap (effective tap depth).
(2) As shown in Fig.2, a tapered washer is also available that allows GSR to be mounted on a sec-
tion steel.
(3) For model number coding, see A1-294 to A1-295.
Table2 Tap Position and Depth Shape
A1-296
506E
GSR
LM Guide
A1-297
506E
GSR-R
LM Guide Separate Type (Radial) Model GSR-R
LM block
Endplate
End seal
A1-298
506E
GSR-R
LM Guide
applied simply by securing the LM block with mounting bolts.
Model GSR-R is based on model GSR, but has rack teeth on the LM rail. This facilitates the design
and assembly of drive mechanisms.
* Model GSR-R cannot be used in single-axis applications.
[Easy Designing]
The travel distance per turn of the pinion is specified by the integer value. This makes it easy to cal-
culate the travel distance per pulse when the LM Guide is used in combination with a stepping motor
or servomotor.
[Space Saving]
Since the rail has a rack, the machine size can be reduced.
[Long Stroke]
The end faces of the LM rail are machined for jointed use. To obtain a long stroke, simply joint LM
rails of the standard length.
[High Durability]
The rack tooth has a width equal to the LM rail height, the rack uses high-grade steel with proven
performance and the tooth surface are heat-treated, thereby to ensure high durability.
A1-299
506E
A1-300
506E
GSR-R
LM Guide
A1-301
506E
Model GSR-R
P
Rh
4-S×ℓ C
W (E) L
B B1 L1
φ d2
T N
h
(K)M
M1 M2 M1
W4 H3
W1 W2 φ d1
W0 F
Model GSR-T-R
Reference Pitch
Model No. pitch Module line Height Width Length
dimension height Grease
nipple
P Rh M W W0 L B1 B C S×ℓ L1 T K N E H3
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set.
GSR-R
Rh
LM Guide
2-S×ℓ
W (E) L
B B1 L1
φ d2
T N
h
(K)M
M1 M2 M1
W4 φ d1
H3
W1 W2 F
W0
Model GSR25V-R
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m Mass
MA MB
LM LM
Width Height Pitch C C0
block rail
1 Double 1 Double
W1 W2 W4 M1 F M2 d1×d2×h kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks
10.29 12.65 0.0858 0.522 0.0742 0.451 0.29
44.91 15 11.5 16.5 60 11.5 7×11×9 4.7
13.5 19 0.177 0.965 0.152 0.831 0.5
50.55 16.5 14 19 80 12 9×14×12 18.8 25.9 0.282 1.54 0.243 1.32 0.6 5.9
60.18 20 17 22 80 14.5 11×17.5×14 25.1 33.8 0.421 2.28 0.362 1.96 1 8.1
Note) A moment in the direction MC can be received if two rails are used in parallel. However, since it depends on the distance be-
tween the two rails, the moment in the direction MC is omitted here.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-304.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Clients who require wall-mounted installations or oil lubrication should contact THK.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-303
506E
G F G
L0
A1-304
506E
GSR-R
LM Guide
Use of a special jig as shown in Fig.1 will make
the connection easier.
(THK also offers the rack-aligning jig.)
A1-305
506E
[Checking Strength]
The strength of the assembled rack and pinion must be checked in advance.
(1) Calculate the maximum thrust acting on the pinion.
(2) Divide the permissible power transmission capacity of the pinion to be used (Table1) by an over-
load factor (Table2).
(3) By comparing the thrust acting on the pinion obtained in step 1 with the pinion power transmis-
sion capacity obtained in step 2, make sure the applied thrust does not exceed the permissible
power transmission capacity.
T1 T1
Time (sec)
Fig.3
A1-306
506E
GSR-R
LM Guide
Rail with rack
Pinion
Motor
Motor
Belt
LM block
Pinion
A1-307
506E
Keyway
Unit: mm
Number Tip circle Meshing Boss Hole Tooth Overall Supported
Keyway
Model No. Pitch of diameter PCD diameter diameter width length G H model
teeth J×K numbers
A B C D E F
GP 6-20A 20 42.9 39 30 18
6 16.5 24.5 M3 4 6×2.8 GSR 25-R
GP 6-25A 25 51.9 48 35 18
GP 8-20A 20 57.1 52 40 20 M3
8 19 26 5 8×3.3 GSR 30-R
GP 8-25A 25 69.1 64 40 20 M4
GP10-20A 20 70.4 64 45 25 8×3.3
10 22 30 M4 5 GSR 35-R
GP10-25A 25 86.4 80 60 25 10×3.3
Note1) When placing an order, specify the model number from the table.
Note2) Non-standard pinions with different numbers of teeth are also available upon request. Contact THK for details.
A1-308
506E
GSR-R
φA PCDB φ DH7 φ C
LM Guide
Unit: mm
Tip circle Meshing Boss Hole Tooth Overall Supported
Number
Model No. Pitch diameter PCD diameter diameter width length model
of teeth
A B C D E F numbers
GP 6-20C 20 42.9 39 30 12
6 16.5 24.5 GSR 25-R
GP 6-25C 25 51.9 48 35 15
GP 8-20C 20 57.1 52 40 18
8 19 26 GSR 30-R
GP 8-25C 25 69.1 64 40 18
GP10-20C 20 70.4 64 45 18
10 22 30 GSR 35-R
GP10-25C 25 86.4 80 60 18
Note1) When placing an order, specify the model number from the table.
Note2) Non-standard pinions with different numbers of teeth are also available upon request. Contact THK for details.
B
Rh+
2
Rh
Unit: mm
LM rail Pinion
Model GSR Pinion
Pitch line height Meshing PCD Rh+B/2
Model No. Model No.
Rh B
GP 6-20A
39 62.5
GP 6-20C
GSR 25-R 43
GP 6-25A
48 67
GP 6-25C
GP 8-20A
52 74
GP 8-20C
GSR 30-R 48
GP 8-25A
64 80
GP 8-25C
GP 10-20A
64 89
GP 10-20C
GSR 35-R 57
GP 10-25A
80 97
GP 10-25C
A1-309
506E
CSR
LM Guide Cross LM Guide Model CSR
LM rail
End seal
Endplate
Grease nipple
LM block
Ball
Retainer plate
Side seal
LM rail
A1-310
506E
CSR
LM Guide
which has a proven track record and is highly reliable, with another and uses two LM rails in com-
bination. It is machined with high precision so that the perpendicularity of the hexahedron of the
LM block is within 2 m per 100 mm in error. The two rails are also machined with high precision
in relative straightness. As a result, extremely high accuracy in orthogonality is achieved. Since an
orthogonal LM system can be achieved with model CSR alone, a conventionally required saddle is
no longer necessary, the structure for X-Y motion can be simplified and the whole system can be
downsized.
[High Rigidity]
Since balls are arranged in four rows in a well-balanced manner, this model is stiff against a mo-
ment, and smooth straight motion is ensured even a preload is applied to increase the rigidity.
The rigidity of the LM blocks is 50% higher than that of a combination of two HSR LM blocks se-
cured together back-to-back with bolts. Thus, CSR is an optimal LM Guide for building an X-Y table
that requires high rigidity.
A1-311
506E
A1-312
506E
CSR
LM Guide
Ball screw mounting location
Ball screw mounting on the X axis
location on the Y axis
A1-313
506E
Model CSR
C C1 (E) L
W
L2 F W2
2×5-S×ℓ φ d1 W1
H3
M1 N B1
h
φ d2 B3 B B4
B
B3 M M φ d2
B4
B1 N M1 h
W1 H3 φ d1 2×5-S×ℓ
W2 F L2
W
L (E) C1 C
Models CSR20 to 45
CSR 15 47 38.8 56.6 — 11.3 34.8 — 20 9.4 M4×6 32 3.5 19.5 5.5 PB1021B 3.5
CSR 20S 50.8 74 — 13.3 42.5 — 30 10.4
57 M5×8 42 4 25 12 B-M6F 4
CSR 20 66.8 90 13 7.8 37 24 56 5.4
CSR 25S 59.5 83.1 — 17 52 — 34 12.75
70 M6×10 46 5.5 30 12 B-M6F 5.5
CSR 25 78.6 102.2 18 9 44 26 64 7.3
CSR 30S 70.4 98 — 20 61 — 40 15.2
82 M6×10 58 7 35 12 B-M6F 7
CSR 30 93 120.6 21 12 53 32 76 8.5
CSR 35 95 105.8 134.8 24 14 61 37 90 7.9 M8×14 68 7.5 40 12 B-M6F 7.5
CSR 45 118 129.8 170.8 30 16 75 45 110 9.9 M10×15 84 10 50 16 B-PT1/8 10
4 CSR25 UU C0 +1200/1000L P
Model Contamination LM rail length LM rail length
number protection on the X axis on the Y axis
accessory (in mm) (in mm)
symbol (*1)
Total No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Normal (No symbol)/Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-80.
CSR
(E) L
W
L2 F W2
2×2-S×ℓ C C1 φ d1 W1
H3
M1 N
LM Guide
h φ d2 B3 B4
M M φ d2 h
B4 B3
N M1
W1 H3 φ d1 C1 C 2×2-S×ℓ
W2 F L2
W
L (E)
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-316.)
Static permissible moment*: Static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
MB
M0
Options⇒A1-473 A1-315
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model CSR Unit: mm
A1-316
506E
CSR
LM Guide
15 M5 8
20 M6 10
X-axis LM rail
25 M6 12
30 M8 15
Y-axis LM rail
35 M8 17
45 M12 24
A1-317
506E
MX
LM Guide Miniature Cross Guide Model MX
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
End seal
Ball
LM rail
A1-318
506E
MX
LM Guide
MX alone, a conventionally required saddle is no longer necessary and the whole system can be
downsized.
A1-319
506E
Model MX
L
L2 F
φd φ d1
M1
M h
N φ d2
H3
W1
W2
Note) The LM block, rail, and ball material are composed of stainless steel and are corrosion resistant to general environments.
Note) If the LM rail mount of a semi-standard model is of a tapped-hole LM rail type, add symbol “K” after the accuracy symbol.
Example: 4 MX7W M UU C1+120/100L P K T M
Add symbol K
MX
W2
W1
φ d2
H3
LM Guide
N
h M
M1
φ d1 φd
F L2
Unit: mm
Static Permissible
Basic load
LM rail dimensions Moment* Mass
rating
N-m
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0 M0 MB
block rail
W1 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0
5 10.1 4 15 2.4×3.5×1 200 0.59 1.1 2.57 2.57 0.01 0.14
–0.02
0
14 22.1 5.2 30 3.5×6×3.2 400 2.04 3.21 14.7 14.7 0.051 0.51
–0.025
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-322.)
Static permissible moment*: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
MB
M0
For the LM rail mounting hole, a tapped-hole LM rail type is available as semi-standard.
5.2
M2.6×2ℓ M3 through
When mounting the LM rail of model MX7WM, take into account the thread length of the
mounting bolt in order not to let the bolt end stick out of the top face of the LM rail.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-321
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model MX Unit: mm
Model No. MX 5 MX 7W
40 50
55 80
70 110
100 140
LM rail standard
130 170
length (LO)
160 200
260
290
Standard pitch F 15 30
G 5 10
Max length 480 480
Note) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
A1-322
506E
MX
LM Guide
A1-323
506E
JR
LM Guide Structural Member Rail Model JR
45°
Ball
Lower plate
45°
Side seal
Cross section
A1-324
506E
JR
LM Guide
reliable. The LM rail has a sectional shape with high flexural rigidity, and therefore can be used as a
structural member.
Unlike the conventional LM Guide type, whose LM rail was secured onto the base with bolts when
installed, model JR’s LM rail is integrated with the mounting base, and the top of the LM rail has the
same structure as LM Guide model HSR. The lower part of the LM rail has a hardness of HRC25 or
less, making it easy to cut the rail and enabling the rail to be welded.
When welding the rail, we recommend using welding rods compliant with JIS D 5816. (suggested manufac-
turer and model number: Kobelco LB-52).
Fig.2
A1-325
506E
A1-326
506E
JR
LM Guide
A1-327
506E
W
4-S B
W
B T1 T
4-S t
(K)
T1 T
(K) M
M J2
J2
θ°
θ°
J1 J1
W1 W1
JR35 R 2 UU +1000L T
Type of Contamination LM rail Symbol for LM rail
protection
LM block accessory length jointed use
symbol (*1) (in mm)
Model No. of LM blocks
number used on the same rail
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510
JR
W
W
4-S×ℓ B
4- φ H B
T
t T T1
(K) (K)
M M
J2 J2
LM Guide
θ°
θ°
J1 J1
W1 W1
M1
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Length* C C0
block rail
Double Double
W1 J1 J2 M1 Max kN kN 1 block 1 block 1 block kg kg/m
blocks blocks
0.59
48 4 5 12 47 2000 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59 4.2
0.54
1.6
54 7 8 10 54 4000 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6 8.6
1.5
2.8
70 8 10 10 70 4000 60 95.6 1.42 7.92 1.42 7.92 1.83 2.8 15.2
2.6
4.5
93 4.8 11.6 12 90 4000 88.5 137 2.45 13.2 2.45 13.2 3.2 4.5 18.3
4.3
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-330.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-329
506E
Model No. JR 25 JR 35 JR 45 JR 55
1000 1000 1000 1000
LM rail standard 1500 2000 2000 2000
length (LO) 2000 4000 4000 4000
a side b side
Dial gauge
Rail A Rail B G
Rail a side
G
b side
Nut
Rail presser Bolt Bolt C Bolt D Setscrew F
Rail presser Rail presser
Joint fitting Bolt E
Fig.3
A1-330
506E
JR
LM Guide
C
φD
H
G θ°
R
A E
B F
Unit: mm
Mounting
Clamper dimensions
Model No. dimensions Bolt used
A B C D E F G H R J
JB 25 57 78 25 7 10.5 15 10 3.8 R2 25 10 M 6
JB 35 72 102 35 9 15 24 12 3.1 R2 32 8 M 8
JB 45 90 130 45 11 20 30 16 5.4 R2 40 8 M10
JB 55 115 155 50 14 20 30 17 8.2 R2 50 10 M12
N
φU
T
K S
L P
Unit: mm
Mounting
Clamper dimensions
Model No. dimensions Bolt used
K L N P S T U V
JT 25 57 79 25 11 10 4 7 25 M 6
JT 35 65 91 27 13 13 4.5 9 40 M 8
JT 45 84 114 33 15 16 6 11 50 M10
JT 55 110 148 50 19 15 6 14 50 M12
A1-331
506E
HCR
LM Guide R Guide Model HCR
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
Grease nipple
End seal
Ball
A1-332
506E
HCR
LM Guide
motion.
[Freedom of Design]
Multiple LM blocks can individually move on the same rail. By arranging LM blocks on the load
points, efficient structural design is achieved.
A1-333
506E
A1-334
506E
HCR
LM Guide
A1-335
506E
T1 T
M
H3
W1 W2
HCR
(L)
n1- φ d1 through, φ d2 counter bore depth h
(U) B
4-S C
(n1-1)×θ 2
θ
LM Guide
θ2
θ1 (
Ri
1)
R
Ro
L0
(E) (L1)
N
M1
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height C C0
block rail
1 Double 1 Double 1
R R0 Ri L0 U W1 W2 M1 d1×d2×h n1 1 2 kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
100 106 94 100 13.4 12 13.5 11 3.5×6×5 3 60 7 23 4.7 8.53 0.0409 0.228 0.0409 0.228 0.0445 0.08 0.83
150 157.5 142.5 150 20.1 3 7 23 6.66 10.8
300 307.5 292.5 300 40 15 16 15 4.5×7.5×5.3 5 60 6 12 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.2 1.5
400 407.5 392.5 400 54 7 3 9 8.33 13.5
500 511.5 488.5 500 67 9 2 7
750 761.5 738.5 750 100 23 23.5 22 7×11×9 12 60 2.5 5 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59 3.3
1000 1011.5 988.5 1000 134 15 2 4
600 617 583 600 80 7 3 9
800 817 783 800 107 11 2.5 5.5
34 33 29 9×14×12 60 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6 6.6
1000 1017 983 1000 134 12 2.5 5
1300 1317 1283 1300 174 17 2 3.5
800 822.5 777.5 800 107 8 2 8
1000 1022.5 977.5 1000 134 10 3 6
45 37.5 38 14×20×17 60 60 95.6 1.42 7.92 1.42 7.92 1.83 2.8 11.0
1200 1222.5 1177.5 1200 161 12 2.5 5
1600 1622.5 1577.5 1600 214 15 2 4
1000 1031.5 968.5 1000 134 8 60 2 8
1500 1531.5 1468.5 1500 201 10 60 3 6
2000 2031.5 1968.5 1531 152 63 53.5 53 18×26×22 12 45 0.5 4 141 215 4.8 23.5 4.8 23.5 5.82 8.5 22.5
2500 2531.5 2468.5 1913 190 13 45 1.5 3.5
3000 3031.5 2968.5 1553 102 10 30 1.5 3
Note) LM rail radiuses other than the radiuses in the above table are also available. Contact THK for details.
The R-Guide center angles in the table are maximum manufacturing angles. To obtain angles greater than them, rails
must be additionally connected. Contact THK for details.
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-337
506E
HMG
LM Guide Straight-Curved Guide Model HMG
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
Straight-Curved seal
Ball
A1-338
506E
HMG
LM Guide
the structure by eliminating a lift and a table.
[Freedom of Design]
It allows free combinations of straight and curved shapes.
Since LM blocks can smoothly transit between the straight and curved sections, various combina-
tions of straight and curved rails can be joined into various shapes such as O, U, L and S shapes.
In addition, HMG allows a large table to be mounted and a heavy object to be carried through com-
binations of multiple blocks on a single rail or 2 or more LM rails. Thus, it provides great freedom of
design.
A1-339
506E
Operation
Feeding a workpiece Workpiece
Workpiece placement → feeding → operation carried in
→ returning → workpiece placement•••
Operation Operation
A1-340
506E
HMG
LM Guide
A1-341
506E
: Rotating mechanism
: Rotating mechanism and slide mechanism
Fig.4 Examples of Table Mechanisms
Fig.5 shows examples of designing a table when units are used on multiple axes. HMG requires a rotat-
ing mechanism and a slide mechanism since the table is decentered when an LM block transits from
a straight section to a curved section. The amount of decentering differs according to the radius of the
curved section and the LM block span. Therefore, it is necessary to design the system in accordance
with the corresponding specifications.
Fig.6 shows detail drawings of the slide and rotating mechanisms. In the figure, LM Guides are used in
the slide mechanism and Cross-Roller Rings in the rotating mechanism to achieve smooth sliding and
rotating motions.
For driving the Straight-Curved Guide, belt drives and chain drives are available.
Slide distance
Straight section
of the table
Rotation Rotation
A1-342
506E
HMG
LM Guide
A1-343
506E
Model HMG
(L)
W (L')
(E)
2−S×ℓ B
L1
N 〃 〃
W1 W2
HMG 45A 60 120 107.6 76.6 100 M12×25 42.6 10 16 45 37.5 105 38
HMG 65A 90 170 144.4 107.4 142 M16×37 63.4 19 16 63 53.5 150 53
HMG
d2
h
M1
d1
F
Straight rail
R
LM Guide
B
θ1
θ2 θ1
(n−1)
×θ 2
θ
Curved rail Unit: mm
Basic dynamic
load rating (C) Basic static load rating (C0)
Mounting hole Curved rail
Resultant load Straight section Curved section
d1×d2×h R n 1 2 (C) kN (Cost) kN (Cor) kN
150 3 60 7 23
4.5×7.5×5.3 300 5 60 6 12 2.56 4.23 0.44
400 7 60 3 9
500 9 60 2 7
7×11×9 750 12 60 2.5 5 9.41 10.8 6.7
1000 15 60 2 4
600 7 60 3 9
800 11 60 2.5 5.5
9×14×12 17.7 19 11.5
1000 12 60 2.5 5
1300 17 60 2 3.5
800 8 60 2 8
1000 10 60 3 6
14×20×17 28.1 29.7 18.2
1200 12 60 2.5 5
1600 15 60 2 4
1000 8 60 2 8
1500 10 60 3 6
18×26×22 2000 12 45 0.5 4 66.2 66.7 36.2
2500 13 45 1.5 3.5
3000 10 30 1.5 3
When a moment is applied where one LM block is specified per axis, the LM block may experience non-smooth motion.
We recommend that multiple LM blocks be used per axis when a moment is applied.
Table 1 shows the static permissible moment of an LM block in the MA, MB and MC directions.
Table1 Static Permissible Moments of Model HMG Unit: kN-m
MA MB MC
Model No.
Straight section Curved section Straight section Curved section Straight section Curved section
HMG 15 0.008 0.007 0.008 0.01 0.027 0.003
HMG 25 0.1 0.04 0.1 0.05 0.11 0.07
HMG 35 0.22 0.11 0.22 0.12 0.29 0.17
HMG 45 0.48 0.2 0.48 0.22 0.58 0.34
HMG 65 1.47 0.66 1.47 0.73 1.83 0.94
Options⇒A1-473 A1-345
506E
Jointed LM rail
Note) Place the pin on the outer circumference and the bolt on the inner circumference.
adjustment bolt
[Jointed LM Rail]
Model HMG always requires a jointed rail where a
an LM block travels from the straight section b
to the curved section and where the curve is
inverted such as an S curve. Take this into ac- G F F/2
L
count when design the system. d2
h
M1
Wo d1 W1
A1-346
506E
HMG
LM Guide
22.83 0.17 500
25A 22 60 7×11×9 23 22.89 42 0.11 750
22.92 0.08 1000
33.77 0.23 600
33.83 0.17 800
35A 29 80 9×14×12 34 54
33.86 0.14 1000
33.9 0.1 1300
44.71 0.29 800
44.77 0.23 1000
45A 38 105 14×20×17 45 76
44.81 0.19 1200
44.86 0.14 1600
62.48 0.52 1000
62.66 0.34 1500
65A 53 150 18×26×22 63 62.74 107 0.26 2000
62.8 0.2 2500
62.83 0.17 3000
500
50
°
60
R1
0
30
R
60°
60
°
Fig.8 Example of model No.
A1-347
506E
NSR-TBC
LM Guide Self-aligning Type Model NSR-TBC
Spline nut
LM casing
LM rail
End seal
A1-348
506E
NSR-TBC
LM Guide
[Capable of Receiving Loads in All Directions]
NSR-TBC has four rows of balls. The balls are arranged in two rows on each shoulder of the LM
rail, and can receive loads in all four directions: upward, downward and lateral directions. Due to the
self-aligning structure, however, a rotational moment (MC) cannot be applied in a single-rail configu-
ration.
A1-349
506E
Model NSR-TBC
4−φ H W (E)
B
T N
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1 (E1)
NSR50TBC 2 UU C1 +1200L P T -Ⅱ
Model number Contamination LM rail length
protection (in mm) Symbol for
accessory Symbol for No. of rails used
symbol (*1) LM rail on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM cases Radial clearance symbol (*2) jointed use
used on the same Normal (No symbol)
rail Accuracy symbol (*3)
Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Medium preload (C0) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-72. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
NSR-TBC
L
C
φ d2
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
Basic load Static Permissible Moment*
LM rail dimensions Mass
rating kN-m
MA MB LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
casing rail
W1 Double Double
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 casings casings
23 23.5 23 60 6×9.5×8.5 2200 9.41 18.6 0.31 0.27 0.62 3.1
28 31 28 80 7×11×9 3000 14.9 26.7 0.53 0.46 1.13 4.7
34 33 34.5 80 7×11×9 3000 22.5 38.3 0.85 0.74 1.8 7.2
45 37.5 44.5 105 9×14×12 3000 37.1 62.2 1.7 1.5 3.5 12.2
48 46 47.5 120 11×17.5×14 3000 55.1 87.4 2.7 2.4 5.2 14.3
63 56 62 150 14×20×17 3000 90.8 152 9.8 4.9 9.4 27.6
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-352.)
Static permissible moment*: Double casings: static permissible moment value with 2 casings closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-351
506E
G F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model NSR-TBC Unit: mm
Model No. NSR 20TBC NSR 25TBC NSR 30TBC NSR 40TBC NSR 50TBC NSR 70TBC
220 280 280 570 780 1270
280 440 440 885 1020 1570
340 600 600 1200 1260 2020
460 760 760 1620 1500 2620
640 1000 1000 2040 1980
LM rail standard
820 1240 1240 2460 2580
length (LO)
1000 1640 1640 2985 2940
1240 2040 2040
1600 2520 2520
3000 3000
A1-352
506E
NSR-TBC
LM Guide
A1-353
506E
HSR-M1
LM Guide High Temperature Type Model HSR-M1
LM block
(THK-EX50)
Endplate
(SUS304) LM rail
(THK-EX50)
End seal
(High temperature
rubber material)
45°
Ball
(SUS440C)
45°
Side seal
(High temperature Cross section
rubber material)
A1-354
506E
HSR-M1
LM Guide
Guide to be used in all orientations.
The high temperature type LM Guide is capable of being used at service temperature up to 150℃
thanks to THK’s unique technologies in material, heat treatment and lubrication.
[Dimensional Stability]
Since it is dimensionally stabilized, it demonstrates superb dimensional stability after being heated
or cooled (note that it shows linear expansion at high temperature).
A1-355
506E
0.02 0.2
0 Vertical
-0.02 0.15 Horizontal
-0.04
-0.06 0.1
-0.08
-0.1 0.05
-0.12
-0.14 0
High Standard Stainless High Standard Stainless
temperature type steel temperature type steel
type type type type
Overall LM Rail Length Curvature of the LM Rail
Note1) The above data on overall length and curvature indicate dimensional change when the LM rail is cooled to normal
temperature after being heated at 150℃ for 100 hours.
Note2) The samples consist of high temperature, standard and stainless steel types of model HSR25 + 580L.
grease 12 grease
6 Competitor’
s high temperature
10 Competitor’
s high temperature
grease grease
8
4
6
2 4
2
0 0
Normal 150℃ Normal 150℃
Temperature Temperature
temperature temperature
measurement measurement
Average Value Fluctuation Value
A1-356
506E
HSR-M1
LM Guide
Model HSR-M1LA Specification Table⇒A1-360
The LM block has the same cross-sectional
shape as model HSR-M1A, but has a longer
overall LM block length (L) and a greater rated
load.
A1-357
506E
Service Life
When using this product in temperatures higher than 100C, always multiply the basic dynamic load
rating by the temperature coefficient when calculating the rated service life. See A1-64 for
details.
A1-358
506E
HSR-M1
LM Guide
A1-359
506E
T1 T
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
HSR 15M1A 24 47 59.6 38 30 M5 38.8 6.5 11 19.3 4.3 5.5 PB1021B 4.7
HSR 20M1A 76 50.8
30 63 53 40 M6 9.5 10 26 5 12 B-M6F 4
HSR 20M1LA 92 66.8
HSR 25M1A 83.9 59.5
36 70 57 45 M8 11 16 30.5 6 12 B-M6F 5.5
HSR 25M1LA 103 78.6
HSR 30M1A 98.8 70.4
42 90 72 52 M10 9 18 35 7 12 B-M6F 7
HSR 30M1LA 121.4 93
HSR 35M1A 112 80.4
48 100 82 62 M10 12 21 40.5 8 12 B-M6F 7.5
HSR 35M1LA 137.4 105.8
Note) The length L of the high temperature type LM Guide model HSR is longer than normal type of model HSR. (Dimension
L1 is the same.)
HSR25 M1 A 2 UU C1 +1240L P T -Ⅱ
Model number Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol Symbol for
LM block protection (in mm) for LM rail No. of rails used
accessory jointed use on the same plane (*4)
symbol (*1)
Symbol for high No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
temperature used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
type LM Guide rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
HSR-M1
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2 N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
15 16 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 1240 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.2 1.5
13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 1480 2.3
21.3 31.8 0.323 1.66 0.323 1.66 0.27 0.47
19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 1500 3.3
27.2 45.9 0.529 2.74 0.529 2.74 0.459 0.75
28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.1
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 1500 4.8
37.3 62.5 0.889 4.37 0.889 4.37 0.751 1.3
37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 1500 6.6
50.2 81.5 1.32 6.35 1.32 6.35 1.2 2
Note) The maximum length under “Length ” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-368.)
*
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-361
506E
t T T1 T1 T
M (K) (K)
M
H3 H3
W2 W1 W2 W1
HSR 15M1B 24 47 59.6 38 30 4.5 38.8 11 6.5 7 19.3 4.3 5.5 PB1021B 4.7
HSR 20M1B 76 50.8
30 63 53 40 6 — 9.5 10 26 5 12 B-M6F 4
HSR 20M1LB 92 66.8
HSR 25M1B 83.9 59.5
36 70 57 45 7 16 11 10 30.5 6 12 B-M6F 5.5
HSR 25M1LB 103 78.6
HSR 30M1B 98.8 70.4
42 90 72 52 9 18 9 10 35 7 12 B-M6F 7
HSR 30M1LB 121.4 93
HSR 35M1B 112 80.4
48 100 82 62 9 21 12 13 40.5 8 12 B-M6F 7.5
HSR 35M1LB 137.4 105.8
Note) The length L of the high temperature type LM Guide model HSR is longer than normal type of model HSR. (Dimension
L1 is the same.)
HSR20 M1 LB 2 UU C0 +1000L P T -Ⅱ
Model number Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol Symbol for
LM block protection (in mm) for LM rail No. of rails used
accessory jointed use on the same plane (*4)
symbol (*1)
Symbol for high No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
temperature used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
type LM Guide rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
HSR-M1
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2
LM Guide
N
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
15 16 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 1240 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.2 1.5
13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 1480 2.3
21.3 31.8 0.323 1.66 0.323 1.66 0.27 0.47
19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 1500 3.3
27.2 45.9 0.529 2.74 0.529 2.74 0.459 0.75
28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.1
28 31 26 80 9×14×12 1500 4.8
37.3 62.5 0.889 4.37 0.889 4.37 0.751 1.3
37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6
34 33 29 80 9×14×12 1500 6.6
50.2 81.5 1.32 6.35 1.32 6.35 1.2 2
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-368.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-363
506E
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
HSR 15M1R 28 34 59.6 26 26 M4×5 38.8 6 23.3 8.3 5.5 PB1021B 4.7
HSR 20M1R 76 36 50.8
30 44 32 M5×6 8 26 5 12 B-M6F 4
HSR 20M1LR 92 50 66.8
HSR 25M1R 83.9 35 59.5
40 48 35 M6×8 8 34.5 10 12 B-M6F 5.5
HSR 25M1LR 103 50 78.6
HSR 30M1R 98.8 40 70.4
45 60 40 M8×10 8 38 10 12 B-M6F 7
HSR 30M1LR 121.4 60 93
HSR 35M1R 112 50 80.4
55 70 50 M8×12 10 47.5 15 12 B-M6F 7.5
HSR 35M1LR 137.4 72 105.8
Note) The length L of the high temperature type LM Guide model HSR is longer than normal type of model HSR. (Dimension
L1 is the same.)
HSR35 M1 R 2 UU C0 +1080L P T -Ⅱ
Model number Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol
protection
Symbol for
LM block (in mm) for LM rail No. of rails used
accessory
symbol (*1)
jointed use on the same plane (*4)
Symbol for high No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
temperature used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
type LM Guide rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
HSR-M1
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2 N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
15 9.5 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 1240 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.2 1.5
13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35
20 12 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 1480 2.3
21.3 31.8 0.323 1.66 0.323 1.66 0.27 0.47
19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59
23 12.5 22 60 7×11×9 1500 3.3
27.2 45.9 0.529 2.74 0.529 2.74 0.459 0.75
28 46.8 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.1
28 16 26 80 9×14×12 1500 4.8
37.3 62.5 0.889 4.37 0.889 4.37 0.751 1.3
37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6
34 18 29 80 9×14×12 1500 6.6
50.2 81.5 1.32 6.35 1.32 6.35 1.2 2
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-368.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-365
506E
Model HSR-M1YR
4-S×ℓ
W
B1
B
(K)
M
H3
W1
W2
HSR 15M1YR 28 33.5 59.6 4.3 11.5 18 M4×5 38.8 23.3 8.3 5.5 PB1021B 4.7
HSR 20M1YR 30 43.5 76 4 11.5 25 M5×6 50.8 26 5 12 B-M6F 4
HSR 25M1YR 40 47.5 83.9 6 16 30 M6×6 59.5 34.5 10 12 B-M6F 5.5
HSR 30M1YR 45 59.5 98.8 8 16 40 M6×9 70.4 38 10 12 B-M6F 7
HSR 35M1YR 55 69.5 112 8 23 43 M8×10 80.4 47.5 15 12 B-M6F 7.5
Note) The length L of the high temperature type LM Guide model HSR-YR is longer than normal type of model HSR-YR.
(Dimension L1 is the same.)
HSR25 M1 YR 2 UU C0 +1200L P T -Ⅱ
Model number Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol Symbol for
LM block protection (in mm) for LM rail No. of rails used
accessory jointed use on the same plane (*4)
symbol (*1)
Symbol for high No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
temperature used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
type LM Guide rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
HSR-M1
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2 N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
15 24 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 1240 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.2 1.5
20 31.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 1480 13.8 23.8 0.19 1.04 0.19 1.04 0.201 0.35 2.3
23 35 22 60 7×11×9 1500 19.9 34.4 0.307 1.71 0.307 1.71 0.344 0.59 3.3
28 43.5 26 80 9×14×12 1500 37.3 62.5 0.524 2.7 0.524 2.7 0.562 1.3 4.8
34 51.5 29 80 9×14×12 1500 37.3 61.1 0.782 3.93 0.782 3.93 0.905 1.6 6.6
Note) The maximum length under “Length ” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-368.)
*
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-367
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model HSR-M1 Unit: mm
Model No. HSR 15M1 HSR 20M1 HSR 25M1 HSR 30M1 HSR 35M1
160 220 220 280 280
220 280 280 360 360
280 340 340 440 440
340 400 400 520 520
400 460 460 600 600
460 520 520 680 680
520 580 580 760 760
580 640 640 840 840
640 700 700 920 920
700 760 760 1000 1000
LM rail standard 760 820 820 1080 1080
length (LO) 820 940 940 1160 1160
940 1000 1000 1240 1240
1000 1060 1060 1320 1320
1060 1120 1120 1400 1400
1120 1180 1180 1480 1480
1180 1240 1240
1240 1360 1300
1480 1360
1420
1480
Standard pitch F 60 60 60 80 80
G 20 20 20 20 20
Max length 1240 1480 1500 1500 1500
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
Note3) The values for HSR-M1 also apply to HSR-M1YR.
A1-368
506E
HSR-M1
LM Guide
A1-369
506E
SR-M1
LM Guide High Temperature Type Model SR-M1
LM block
(THK-EX50)
Endplate
(SUS304)
Grease nipple
(SUS304)
End seal
(High temperature
rubber material)
LM rail
(THK-EX50)
90°
Ball
(SUS440C)
Retainer plate
(SUS304) 30°
Side seal
(High temperature Cross section
rubber material)
A1-370
506E
SR-M1
LM Guide
High temperature type LM Guide model SR-M1 is capable of being used at service temperature up
to 150℃ thanks to THK’s unique technologies in material, heat treatment and lubrication.
[Dimensional Stability]
Since it is dimensionally stabilized, it demonstrates superb dimensional stability after being heated
or cooled (note that it shows linear expansion at high temperature).
A1-371
506E
A1-372
506E
SR-M1
Service Life
When using this product in temperatures higher than 100C, always multiply the basic dynamic load
rating by the temperature coefficient when calculating the rated service life. See A1-64 for
details.
LM Guide
A1-373
506E
Model SR-M1W
SR30 M1 W 2 UU C0 +1160L Y P T -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination LM rail length Applied to Symbol for
protection (in mm) only 15 LM rail Symbol for
number LM block accessory and 25 jointed use No. of rails used
symbol (*1) on the same plane (*4)
Symbol for high No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
temperature used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
type LM Guide rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
SR-M1
2-S×ℓ
(E) L
L1
〃 〃
φ d2
N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Model SR-M1V
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
5.39 11.1 0.0326 0.224 0.0203 0.143 0.0654 0.12
15 9.5 12.5 60 3.5×6×4.5 1240 1.2
9.51 19.3 0.0925 0.516 0.0567 0.321 0.113 0.2
7.16 14.4 0.053 0.332 0.0329 0.21 0.11 0.2
20 11 15.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 1500 2.1
12.5 25.2 0.146 0.778 0.0896 0.481 0.194 0.3
11.7 22.5 0.103 0.649 0.0642 0.41 0.201 0.3
23 12.5 18 60 7×11×9 1500 2.7
20.3 39.5 0.286 1.52 0.175 0.942 0.355 0.4
17.2 32.5 0.163 1.08 0.102 0.692 0.352 0.5
28 16 23 80 7×11×9 1500 4.3
30 56.8 0.494 2.55 0.303 1.57 0.611 0.8
23.8 44.1 0.259 1.68 0.161 1.07 0.576 0.8
34 18 27.5 80 9×14×12 1500 6.4
41.7 77.2 0.74 4.01 0.454 2.49 1.01 1.2
Note1) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-378.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with
each other
Note2) For models SR15 and 25, two types of rails with different mounting hole dimensions are offered (see Table1).
When, replacing this model with model SSR, pay attention to the mounting hole dimension of the LM rail.
Contact THK for details.
Table1 The dimension of the rail mounting hole
Semi-Standard
Model No. Standard rail
rail
SR 15 For M3 (No symbol) For M4 (Symbol Y)
SR 25 For M6 (Symbol Y) For M5 (No symbol)
Options⇒A1-473 A1-375
506E
4- φ H
W (E) L
B L1
C
φ d2
T1 T N
(K) h
M
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Model SR-M1TB
SR30 M1 W 2 UU C0 +1000L Y P T -Ⅱ
Model number Type of Contamination LM rail length Applied to Symbol for
LM block protection (in mm) only 15 LM rail Symbol for
accessory and 25 jointed use No. of rails used
symbol (*1) on the same plane (*4)
Symbol for high No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
temperature used on the same Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
type LM Guide rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
SR-M1
2- φ H
(E) L
L1
LM Guide
〃 〃
φ d2
N
h
M1
φ d1
F
Model SR-M1SB
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
5.39 11.1 0.0326 0.224 0.0203 0.143 0.0654 0.12
15 18.5 12.5 60 3.5×6×4.5 1240 1.2
9.51 19.3 0.0926 0.516 0.0567 0.321 0.113 0.2
7.16 14.4 0.053 0.332 0.0329 0.21 0.11 0.2
20 19.5 15.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 1500 2.1
12.5 25.2 0.146 0.778 0.0896 0.481 0.194 0.3
11.7 22.5 0.103 0.649 0.0642 0.41 0.201 0.3
23 25 18 60 7×11×9 1500 2.7
20.3 39.5 0.286 1.52 0.175 0.942 0.355 0.4
17.2 32.5 0.163 1.08 0.102 0.692 0.352 0.5
28 31 23 80 7×11×9 1500 4.3
30 56.8 0.494 2.55 0.303 1.57 0.611 0.8
23.8 44.1 0.259 1.68 0.161 1.07 0.576 0.8
34 33 27.5 80 9×14×12 1500 6.4
41.7 77.2 0.74 4.01 0.454 2.49 1.01 1.2
Note1) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-378.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with
each other
Note2) For models SR15 and 25, two types of rails with different mounting hole dimensions are offered (see Table1).
When, replacing this model with model SSR, pay attention to the mounting hole dimension of the LM rail.
Contact THK for details.
Table1 The dimension of the rail mounting hole
Semi-Standard
Model No. Standard rail
rail
SR 15 For M3 (No symbol) For M4 (Symbol Y)
SR 25 For M6 (Symbol Y) For M5 (No symbol)
Options⇒A1-473 A1-377
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SR-M1 Unit: mm
Standard pitch F 60 60 60 80 80
G 20 20 20 20 20
Max length 1240 1500 1500 1500 1500
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
A1-378
506E
SR-M1
LM Guide
A1-379
506E
RSR-M1
LM Guide High Temperature Type Model RSR-M1
Endplate
(SUS304)
LM block
(THK EX50)
End seal
(High temperature rubber)
LM rail
(THK EX50)
Ball
(SUS440C)
Grease nipple
(SUS304)
A1-380
506E
RSR-M1
LM Guide
tion.
[Dimensional Stability]
Since it is dimensionally stabilized, it demonstrates superb dimensional stability after being heated
or cooled (note that it shows linear expansion at high temperature).
A1-381
506E
A1-382
506E
RSR-M1
Service Life
When using this product in temperatures higher than 100C, always multiply the basic dynamic load
rating by the temperature coefficient when calculating the rated service life. See A1-64 for
details.
LM Guide
A1-383
506E
B 4-S×ℓ L1
φd C
N φ d2
h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
2 RSR15 M1 V UU C1 +230L P T -Ⅱ
Model number Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol for Symbol for
LM block protection
accessory (in mm) LM rail No. of rails used
symbol (*1) jointed use on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Symbol for high Radial clearance symbol (*2)
used on the same temperature Normal (No symbol) Accuracy symbol (*3)
rail type LM Guide Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Precision grade (P)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-83. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
RSR-M1
4-S×ℓ
W (E) L
B L1
C
φ d2
LM Guide
T N
(K)
M h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-388.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-385
506E
W L
4-S×ℓ
B L1
φd C
φ d2
N
T h
M (K)
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
2 RSR12 M1 WN UU C1 +310L P T
Model number Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol for LM rail
LM block protection (in mm) jointed use
accessory
No. of LM blocks Symbol for high symbol (*1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same temperature Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Radial clearance symbol (*2) Precision grade (P)
rail type LM Guide Normal (No symbol)
Light preload (C1)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-71. (*3) See A1-83.
RSR-M1
W (E) L
B 4-S×ℓ L1
LM Guide
C
φ d2
T h N
M (K)
H3 M1
W3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
Models RSR15M1WV/M1WN
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment N-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
1 Double 1 Double 1
W1 W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
0 2.45 3.92 16 92.9 16 92.9 36 0.035
18 6 — 7.5 30 3.5×6×4.5 1430 1.08
–0.05 3.52 5.37 31 161 31 161 49.4 0.051
0 4.02 6.08 24.5 138 21.7 123 59.5 0.075
24 8 — 8.5 40 4.5×8×4.5 1600 1.5
–0.05 5.96 9.21 53.9 274 47.3 242 90.1 0.101
0 6.66 9.8 50.3 278 44.4 248 168 0.17
42 9 23 9.5 40 4.5×8×4.5 1800 3
–0.05 9.91 14.9 110 555 97.3 490 255 0.21
Note) The maximum length under “Length ” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-388.)
*
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-387
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model RSR-M1 Unit: mm
Model No. RSR 9M1 RSR 12M1 RSR 15M1 RSR 20M1 RSR 9M1W RSR 12M1W RSR 15M1W
55 70 70 220 50 70 110
75 95 110 280 80 110 150
95 120 150 340 110 150 190
115 145 190 460 140 190 230
135 170 230 640 170 230 270
155 195 270 880 200 270 310
LM rail 175 220 310 1000 260 310 430
standard length
195 245 350 290 390 550
(LO)
275 270 390 320 470 670
375 320 430 550 790
370 470
470 550
570 670
870
Standard pitch F 20 25 40 60 30 40 40
G 7.5 10 15 20 10 15 15
Max length 1240 1430 1600 1800 1430 1600 1800
Note) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Stopper
In models RSR-M1/RSR-M1W, the balls fall out if the LM block comes off the LM rail.
For this reason, they are delivered with a stopper fitted to prevent the LM block coming off the rail. If
you remove the stopper when using the product, take care to ensure that overrun does not occur.
Table2 Model RSR-M1/RSR-M1W stopper (C type)
specification table
Unit: mm
Model No. A B C
A B
9 13 6 9.5
12 16 7 12.5
15 19 7 14.5
20 25 7 20.0 C
9W 23 7 11.5
12W 29 7 13.5
15W 46 7 14.5
A1-388
506E
RSR-M1
LM Guide
A1-389
506E
HSR-M2
LM Guide High Corrosion Resistance Type Model HSR-M2
LM rail
Retainer plate (SUS304)
(SUS304)
LM block
(SUS431)
Endplate
(Synthetic resin)
End seal
(Synthetic rubber)
45°
Ball
(SUS431)
45°
Retainer plate
(SUS304)
Side seal
(Synthetic rubber)
Grease nipple
(SUS304)
A1-390
506E
HSR-M2
LM Guide
Guide to be used in all orientations.
The LM rail, LM block and balls are made of highly corrosion resistant stainless steel and the other
metal parts are made of stainless steel, allowing superb corrosion resistance to be achieved. As a
result, the need for surface treatment is eliminated.
A1-391
506E
Model HSR-M2A
W
B
4-S
T
T1
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
HSR 15M2A 24 47 56.6 38 30 M5 38.8 6.5 11 19.3 4.3 5.5 PB1021B 4.7
HSR 20M2A 30 63 74 53 40 M6 50.8 9.5 10 26 5 12 B-M6F 4
HSR 25M2A 36 70 83.1 57 45 M8 59.5 11 16 30.5 6 12 B-M6F 5.5
Note) For the high corrosion resistance type LM Guide, a stainless steel end plate is optionally available. (symbol…I)
HSR20M2 A 2 UU C1 Ⅰ +820L P T -Ⅱ
Model number Type of Contamination End plate is LM rail length Symbol
(high corrosion LM block protection made of (in mm) for LM rail Symbol for
resistance type accessory stainless steel jointed use No. of rails used
LM Guide) symbol (*1) on the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-72. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
HSR-M2
(E) L
L1
C
φ d2 N
LM Guide
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
*
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment N-m Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
0.05 block blocks block blocks block
15 16 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 1000 2.33 2.03 12.3 70.3 12.3 70.3 10.8 0.2 1.5
20 21.5 18 60 6×9.5×8.5 1000 3.86 3.57 29 160 29 160 26.5 0.35 2.3
23 23.5 22 60 7×11×9 1000 5.57 5.16 46.9 261 46.9 261 45.1 0.59 3.3
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-394.)
The basic load rating of the high corrosion resistance type LM Guide is smaller than ordinary stainless steel LM Guides.
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-393
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model HSR-M2 Unit: mm
Standard pitch F 60 60 60
G 20 20 20
Max length 1000 1000 1000
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
A1-394
506E
HSR-M2
LM Guide
A1-395
506E
HSR-M1VV
LM Guide Medium-to-low Vacuum Type Model HSR-M1VV
LM block:
THK-EX50 (martensitic stainless steel)
45°
Non-contact side seal:
high-temperature resin material
(minimum clearance)
LM rail:
45°
THK-EX50 (martensitic stainless steel)
Cross section
A1-396
506E
HSR-M1VV
LM Guide
● Use of grease designed for Medium-to-Low Vacuum achieves a stable rolling resistance.
* If the baking temperature exceeds 100°C, multiply the basic load rating with the temperature coefficient.
Structure of the labyrinth end seal dedicated for Medium- Labyrinth end seal
Minimum clearance
to-Low Vacuum dedicated for
The labyrinth end seal dedicated for Medium-to-Low Vacuum forms a Medium-to-Low Vacuum
multi-stage space as shown in the figure on the right to minimize the
pressure difference between adjacent stages. This reduces the out-
flow velocity of the oil inside the LM block to a minimum. In addition,
the seal will not affect the rolling resistance since it does not contact LM rail
the LM rail.
[Rolling resistance]
The grease used in the LM Guide for Medium-
Rolling resistance (N)
to-Low Vacuum has a smaller rolling resistance 3 With grease for Medium-to-Low Vacuum
With fluorinated grease
than conventional fluorine grease and ensures
stable rolling motion. 2
Specimen: HSR15M1RVV
Temperature: 25℃ (5℃) 1
Pressure: atmospheric pressure
0
0 30 60 90 120
Stroke (mm)
Rolling resistance fluctuation
A1-397
506E
Precautions on Design
If a large moment is applied to a system consisting of one block on one axis, the labyrinth end seal
may contact the rail, and it may affect the motion.
If a moment is applied, we recommend using two axes with two blocks per axis.
Contact THK for details.
A1-398
506E
HSR-M1VV
LM Guide
A1-399
506E
Model HSR-M1VV
W
4-S×ℓ
B
T
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K H3
HSR15M1R 1 VV C1 +400L P -Ⅱ
Model No. Radial clearance Symbol for
symbol (*1) No. of rails used on the
Labyrinth seal Accuracy same plane (*4)
symbol(*2) symbol (*3)
No. of LM blocks LM rail length
used on the same rail (in mm)
(*1) See A1-71. (*2) See A1-397. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note1) The radial clearance, maximum LM rail length and accuracy class are equal to that of model HSR.
Note2) With this model, a single-rail unit constitutes one set (i.e., the required number of sets when 2 rails are used in parallel
is 2).
HSR-M1VV
L1
LM Guide
φ d2
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
±0.05 block blocks block blocks block
15 9.5 15 60 4.5×7.5×5.3 1240 8.33 13.5 0.0805 0.457 0.0805 0.457 0.0844 0.27 1.5
Note) The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-402.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
If a large moment is applied to a system consisting of one block on one axis, the labyrinth end seal may contact the rail,
and it may affect the motion.
If a moment is applied, we recommend using two axes with two blocks per axis.
Contact THK for details.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-401
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model HSR-M1VV Unit: mm
A1-402
506E
HSR-M1VV
LM Guide
A1-403
506E
SR-MS
LM Guide Oil-Free for Special Environments Model SR-MS
LM rail:
THK-EX50 (martensitic stainless steel)
LM block:
THK-EX50 (martensitic stainless steel)
Ball:
SUS440C + Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film 90°
Spacer ball: PTFE
30°
Cross section
A1-404
506E
SR-MS
LM Guide
This achieves Low outgassing As a result… Pa and chemical contamina-
Special solvent is used to de-grease this tion (gaseous contamination
such as organic matter and
model. moisture) is not allowed.
3. Does not use grease * Can be used at temperature
up to 150℃ (instantaneously
Use of highly reliable dry lubricant S-com- 200℃).
[Low Friction]
The Oil-Free LM Guide for special environments exerts superbly low frictional properties in atmo-
spheric to vacuum environments.
A1-405
506E
generated / l (200 s)
Amount of particles
Amount of particles
40 40
30 30
20 20
10 10
0 0
0 5 10 15 20 25 0 5 10 15 20 25
Traveling time (hr) Traveling time (hr)
1500
No data is available for conventional dry lubrication
1000
500
0
950 1370 1720
Contact surface pressure of a ball (MPa)
* The durable life represents the value at a point from which the Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film is no longer effective.Note
that the durable life differs from the rated service life of the LM Guide.
A1-406
506E
SR-MS
LM Guide
Model SR-MSV Specification Table⇒A1-408
A space-saving type whose LM block has the
same cross-sectional shape as model SR-
MSW, but has a smaller overall LM block length
(L).
A1-407
506E
W
B
T
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
M W L B C S×ℓ L1 T K H3
SR15MSV 1 CS + 340L Y P - Ⅱ
Model No. LM rail length Symbol for
(mm) No. of rails used on the
Radial clearance Applied to same plane (*3)
symbol (*1) only 15
No. of LM blocks Accuracy symbol (*2)
used on the same rail
SR-MS
Type V Type W
L L
2-S×ℓ L1 L1 4-S×ℓ
C
LM Guide
φ d2
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
Permis-
LM rail dimensions sible Permissible moment N•m Mass
load
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length*
block rail
F0
W1 1 Double 1 Double 1
W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max N kg kg/m
±0.05 block blocks block blocks block
320 0.80 5.43 0.51 3.60 1.16 0.12
15 9.5 12.5 60 3.5×6×4.5 400 1.2
570 2.35 13.0 1.47 8.31 2.08 0.2
430 1.35 8.44 0.87 5.52 2.05 0.2
20 11 15.5 60 6×9.5×8.5 400 2.1
750 3.76 19.9 2.36 12.6 3.59 0.3
Note1) The maximum length under “Length ” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-410 .)
*
For the durability of the Oil-Free LM Guide for special environment, contact THK.
The value of permissible load F0 represents the permissible value for the strength of the dry lubricant S-compound film.
Since the service life of the S film may vary according to the environment or the operating conditions, be sure to evalu-
ate and validate the life under the service conditions and operating conditions at the customer.
Note2) For model SR15, two types of rails with different mounting hole dimensions are offered (see Table1).
When, replacing this model with model SSR, pay attention to the mounting hole dimension of the LM rail.
Contact THK for details.
Table1 The dimension of the rail mounting hole
Semi-Standard
Model No. Standard rail
rail
SR 15 For M3 (No symbol) For M4 (Symbol Y)
Options⇒A1-473 A1-409
506E
G F F G
L0
Table1 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SR-MS Unit: mm
A1-410
506E
SR-MS
LM Guide
A1-411
506E
LM block
Endplate
End seal
Retainer plate
Roller cage
Roller
45° 45°
45° 45°
Caged Roller LM Guide is a roller guide that achieves low-friction, smooth motion and long-term
maintenance-free operation by using a roller cage. In addition, to ensure ultra-high rigidity, rollers
with low elastic deformation are used as the rolling elements and the roller diameter and the roller
length are optimized.
Furthermore, the lines of rollers are placed at a contact angle of 45 so that the same rated load is
applied in all (radial, reverse and lateral) directions.
A1-412
506E
LM Guide
(2) The absence of friction between rollers al-
lows grease to be retained in grease pock-
ets and achieves long-term maintenance-
free operation.
(3) The absence of friction between rollers Grease pocket
achieves low heat generation and superbly
high speed.
(4) The absence of roller-to-roller collision
ensures low noise and acceptable running
sound.
[Smooth Motion]
Rolling Resistance Data
Evenly spaced and aligned rollers circulate, minimizing rolling resistance fluctuations and achieving
smooth and stable motion.
60
Conventional roller guide
Rolling resistance F (N)
50 #45
10.63N
40
30
20 SRG45LC
2.26N
10
0
0 100 200 300 400 500
Stroke(mm)
Result of Measuring Rolling Resistance Fluctuations
[Conditions]
Feeding speed: 10mm/s
Applied load: no load (one block)
Feeding device (model KR)
Measurement direction
Load cell
Roller guide measured
A1-413
506E
[Conditions]
A sufficient amount
Model No.: SRG45LC of grease remains
Magnitude of preload: clearance C0 Roller
Speed: 180m/min
Acceleration: 1.5G
Stroke: 2300mm
Lubrication : Initial lubrication only
(THKAFB-LF Grease)
Stroke
A1-414
506E
[Ultra-high Rigidity]
High Rigidity Evaluation Data
[Preload] SRG : radial clearance C0
Conventional type : radial clearance equivalent to C0
Radial rigidity
LM Guide
Radial rigidity
12
10
Conventional roller guide
Deflection (μm)
8 #45
6
4
SRG45LC
2 (with a caged roller)
0
0 5 10 15 20 25 30
Radial load (kN)
15
Deflection (μm)
5
SRG45LC
(with a caged roller)
0
0 5 10 15 20 25 30
Reverse radial load (kN)
Horizontal rigidity
Horizontal rigidity
40
Table bolt fixed Bolt not fixed Conventional roller guide
Deflection (μm)
(free) 30 #45
20
10 SRG45LC
(with a caged roller)
0
Rigidity is measured with the two axes placed in 0 5 10 15 20 25 30
parallel and one of the axes not fixed with a bolt in Horizontal load (kN)
order not to apply a moment.
A1-415
506E
SRG
Caged Roller LM Guide Ultra-high Rigidity Type Model SRG
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
End seal
45° 45°
45° 45°
Caged roller
Roller
Cross section
A1-416
506E
SRG
[Ultra-high Rigidity]
A higher rigidity is achieved by using highly rigid rollers as the rolling elements and having the over-
LM Guide
all roller length more than 1.5 times greater than the roller diameter.
A1-417
506E
A1-418
506E
SRG
LM Guide
Model SRG-R Specification Table⇒A1-426
With this type, the LM block has a smaller width
(W) and tapped holes.
Used in places where the space for table width is
limited.
A1-419
506E
for parallelism P
Tolerance
Fig.1
Table2 Error Allowance in Vertical Level (X) between Two Rails Unit: mm
Radial clearance Normal C1 C0
Permissible error on the
0.00030a 0.00021a 0.00011a
mounting surface X
Fig.3
A1-420
506E
SRG
LM Guide
A1-421
506E
4-S×ℓ1 C2 2-S×ℓ2
C
( φ H) ( φ H)
W (E) L **
4- φ D0
L1 e0
φ d2 f0
N
T
M (K) h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1
F
Models SRG15A and 20A/LA
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-72. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SRG
LM Guide
6-S C2
( φ H through) C
W (E) L
e0
**
4- φ D0
L1
φ d2 f0
T T1 N
M (K) h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1
F
Models SRG25 to 65C/LC
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC
LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
H3 0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
-0.05
4 15 16 15.5 30 4.5×7.5×5.3 3000 11.3 25.8 0.21 1.24 0.21 1.24 0.24 0.20 1.58
21 46.9 0.48 2.74 0.48 2.74 0.58 0.42
4.6 20 21.5 20 30 6×9.5×8.5 3000 2.58
26.7 63.8 0.88 4.49 0.88 4.49 0.79 0.57
27.9 57.5 0.641 3.7 0.641 3.7 0.795 0.7
4.5 23 23.5 23 30 7×11×9 3000 3.6
34.2 75 1.07 5.74 1.07 5.74 1.03 0.9
39.3 82.5 1.02 6.21 1.02 6.21 1.47 1.2
5 28 31 26 40 9×14×12 3000 4.4
48.3 108 1.76 9.73 1.76 9.73 1.92 1.6
59.1 119 1.66 10.1 1.66 10.1 2.39 1.9
6 34 33 30 40 9×14×12 3000 6.9
76 165 3.13 17 3.13 17 3.31 2.4
91.9 192 3.49 20 3.49 20 4.98 3.7
8 45 37.5 37 52.5 14×20×17 3090 11.6
115 256 6.13 32.2 6.13 32.2 6.64 4.5
131 266 5.82 33 5.82 33 8.19 5.9
10 53 43.5 43 60 16×23×20 3060 15.8
167 366 10.8 57 10.8 57 11.2 7.8
11.5 63 53.5 54 75 18×26×22 3000 278 599 22.7 120 22.7 120 22.1 16.4 23.7
Note1) The greasing hole on the top face and the pilot hole of the side nipple* are not drilled through in order to prevent for-
eign material from entering the block.
THK will mount a grease nipple per your request. Therefore, do not use the greasing hole of the top face and the side
nipple pilot hole* for purposes other than mounting a grease nipple.
In case of oil lubrication, be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block
where the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-428.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with
each other
Note2) If the mounting holes (4 holes) of the LM block are back spot-faced, these models can be mounted on the table from
the top and the bottom as with model SRG-C.
The value in the parentheses represents a dimension if the mounting hole is back spot-faced.
Contact THK for details.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-423
506E
Model SRG-LC
9-S
( φ H throughNote2))
(E) L
W L1 e0 **
4- φ D0
B C
φ d2
T1 T N f0
M (K) h
M1
H3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
Model SRG85LC
SRG 85LC 110 215 350 185 140 M20 17.8 250.8 30 35 94 22 16 15 22 8.2 B-PT1/8
SRG 100LC 120 250 395 220 200 M20 17.8 280.2 35 38 104 23 16 15 23 8.2 B-PT1/4
SRG85 LC 2 KK C0 +2610L P T -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol for No. of
number LM block protection (in mm) rails used on the
accessory same plane (*4)
symbol (*1) Symbol for LM
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) rail jointed use
Normal (No symbol)
used on the same rail Light preload (C1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Medium preload (C0) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-72. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SRG
LM Guide
(a) 6-S (b) 3-S
( φ H throughNote3)) ( φ HNote3))
(E) L
W L1 e0 4- φ D0
*
B C
φ d2
T1 T N f0
M (K) h
M1
H3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
Model SRG100LC
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
H3 0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
-0.05
16 85 65 71 90 24×35×28 3000 497 990 45.3 239 45.3 239 51.9 26.2 35.7
16 100 75 77 105 26×39×32 3000 601 1170 60 319 60 319 72.3 37.6 46.8
Note1) The greasing hole on the top face and the pilot hole of the side nipple** are not drilled through in order to prevent for-
eign material from entering the block.
See A1-429 for details.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-428.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with
each other
The removing/mounting jig is not provided as standard. When desiring to use it, contact THK.
Note2) The LM block mounting holes (9 holes) of SRG85LC are all through holes (full thread).
Note3) The LM block mounting holes in part (a) (6 holes) of SRG100LC are through holes (full thread).
The LM block mounting holes in part (b) (3 holes) have effective thread depth of 22 mm.
Options⇒A1-473 A1-425
506E
4-S×ℓ1 C 2-S×ℓ2
W (E) L
L1 e0
**
4- φ D0
φ d2 f0
T N
M (K) h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1
F
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-72. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
SRG
6-S×ℓ C
LM Guide
W (E) L 4- φ D0
**
L1 e0
φ d2
T N f0
M (K)
h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
Options⇒A1-473 A1-427
506E
G F G
L0
Table4 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SRG Unit: mm
Model No. SRG 15 SRG 20 SRG 25 SRG 30 SRG 35 SRG 45 SRG 55 SRG 65 SRG 85 SRG 100
160 220 220 280 280 570 780 1270 1530 1340
220 280 280 360 360 675 900 1570 1890 1760
280 340 340 440 440 780 1020 2020 2250 2180
340 400 400 520 520 885 1140 2620 2610 2600
400 460 460 600 600 990 1260
460 520 520 680 680 1095 1380
520 580 580 760 760 1200 1500
580 640 640 840 840 1305 1620
640 700 700 920 920 1410 1740
700 760 760 1000 1000 1515 1860
760 820 820 1080 1080 1620 1980
820 940 940 1160 1160 1725 2100
940 1000 1000 1240 1240 1830 2220
1000 1060 1060 1320 1320 1935 2340
LM rail 1060 1120 1120 1400 1400 2040 2460
standard 1120 1180 1180 1480 1480 2145 2580
length (LO) 1180 1240 1240 1560 1560 2250 2700
1240 1360 1300 1640 1640 2355 2820
1360 1480 1360 1720 1720 2460 2940
1480 1600 1420 1800 1800 2565 3060
1600 1720 1480 1880 1880 2670
1840 1540 1960 1960 2775
1960 1600 2040 2040 2880
2080 1720 2200 2200 2985
2200 1840 2360 2360 3090
1960 2520 2520
2080 2680 2680
2200 2840 2840
2320 3000 3000
2440
Standard
30 30 30 40 40 52.5 60 75 90 105
pitch F
G 20 20 20 20 20 22.5 30 35 45 40
Max length 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3090 3060 3000 3000 3000
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
A1-428
506E
SRG
Greasing Hole
[Greasing Hole for Model SRG]
Model SRG allows lubrication from both the side and top faces of the LM block. The greasing hole of
standard types is not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the LM block.
When using the greasing hole, contact THK.
When using the greasing hole on the top face of models SRG-R and SRG-LR, a greasing adapter is
LM Guide
separately required. Contact THK for details.
If the mounting orientation of the LM Guide is other than horizontal use, the lubricant may not reach
the raceway completely.
Be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block where the
grease nipple or the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
A1-429
506E
φ D2 depth d2
e1
φ D0
e0 Side nipple
(M6 pilot hole)
f0
V
Unit: mm
Pilot hole for side nipple Greasing hole on the top face
Applicable
Model No.
e0 f0 D0 nipple D2 (O-ring) V e1 d2
15A
4 6 2.9 PB107 9.2 (P6) 0.5 5.5 1.5
15V
20A
4 6 2.9 PB107 9.2 (P6) 0.5 6.5 1.5
20LA
20V
4 6 2.9 PB107 9.2 (P6) 0.5 6.5 1.5
20LV
25C
6 6.4 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.5 6 1.5
25LC
25R
6 10.4 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 4.5 6 1.5
25LR
30C
6 7.5 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 6 1.4
30LC
30R
6 10.5 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 3.4 6 1.4
30LR
35C
SRG 35LC 6 6 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 6 1.4
35R
6 13 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 7.4 6 1.4
35LR
45C
7 7 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 7 1.4
45LC
45R
7 17 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 10.4 7 1.4
45LR
55C
9 8.5 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 11 1.4
55LC
55R
9 18.5 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 10.4 11 1.4
55LR
65LC 9 13.5 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 10 1.4
65LV 9 13.5 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 10 1.4
85LC 15 22 8.2 PT1/8 13 (P10) 0.4 10 1
100LC 15 23 8.2 PT1/8 13 (P10) 0.4 10 1
Note) The greasing interval is longer than that of full-roller types because of the roller cage effect. However, the actual greas-
ing interval may vary depending on the service environment, such as a high load and high speed. Contact THK for de-
tails.
A1-430
506E
SRG
LM Guide
A1-431
506E
SRN
Caged Roller LM Guide Ultra-high Rigidity Type (Low Center of Gravity) Model SRN
LM rail
LM block
Endplate
End seal
45° 45°
Roller
45° 45°
Caged roller
Cross section
A1-432
506E
SRN
[Ultra-high Rigidity]
A higher rigidity is achieved by using highly rigid rollers as the rolling elements and having the over-
LM Guide
all roller length more than 1.5 times greater than the roller diameter.
A1-433
506E
A1-434
506E
SRN
LM Guide
according to the radial clearance.
Table1 Error Allowance in Parallelism (P) between Two Rails Unit: mm
Radial clearance
Normal C1 C0
Model No.
SRN 35 0.014 0.010 0.007
SRN 45 0.017 0.013 0.009
SRN 55 0.021 0.014 0.011
SRN 65 0.027 0.018 0.014
for parallelism P
Fig.1 Tolerance
Table2 Error Allowance in Vertical Level (X) between Two Rails Unit: mm
Radial clearance Normal C1 C0
Permissible error on the
0.00030a 0.00021a 0.00011a
mounting surface X
Fig.2
Fig.3
A1-435
506E
T1 T
M (K)
H3
W2 W1
SRN45 C 2 KK C0 +1160L P T -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol for No. of
protection (in mm) rails used on the
number LM block accessory same plane (*4)
symbol (*1)
No. of LM blocks Symbol for LM rail
Radial clearance symbol (*2) jointed use
used on the same Normal (No symbol)
rail Light preload (C1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Medium preload (C0) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-72. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
SRN
LM Guide
6-S
C2
( φ H through) C
(E) L **
4- φ D0
L1 e0
φ d2
N f0
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
-0.05
59.1 119 1.66 10.1 1.66 10.1 2.39 1.6
34 33 30 40 9×14×12 3000 6.9
76 165 3.13 17 3.13 17 3.31 2
91.9 192 3.49 20 3.49 20 4.98 3
45 37.5 36 52.5 14×20×17 3090 11.3
115 256 6.13 32.2 6.13 32.2 6.64 3.6
131 266 5.82 33 5.82 33 8.19 4.9
53 43.5 43 60 16×23×20 3060 15.8
167 366 10.8 57 10.8 57 11.2 6.4
63 53.5 49 75 18×26×22 3000 278 599 22.7 120 22.7 120 22.1 12.7 21.3
Note) The greasing hole on the top face and the pilot hole of the side nipple** are not drilled through in order to prevent for-
eign material from entering the block.
See A1-441 for details.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-440.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-437
506E
(K)
M
H3
W2 W1
SRN45 LR 2 KK C0 +1200L P T -Ⅱ
Model Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol for No. of
protection (in mm) rails used on the
number LM block accessory same plane (*4)
symbol (*1)
Symbol for LM rail
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) jointed use
used on the same Normal (No symbol)
rail Light preload (C1) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Medium preload (C0) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-72. (*3) See A1-77. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
SRN
LM Guide
6-S×ℓ C
(E) L
L1 e0
**
4- φ D0
φ d2
N f0
h
M1
φ d1
F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
-0.05
59.1 119 1.66 10.1 1.66 10.1 2.39 1.1
34 18 30 40 9×14×12 3000 6.9
76 165 3.13 17 3.13 17 3.31 1.4
91.9 192 3.49 20 3.49 20 4.98 1.9
45 20.5 36 52.5 14×20×17 3090 11.3
115 256 6.13 32.2 6.13 32.2 6.64 2.5
131 266 5.82 33 5.82 33 8.19 3.2
53 23.5 43 60 16×23×20 3060 15.8
167 366 10.8 57 10.8 57 11.2 4.5
63 31.5 49 75 18×26×22 3000 278 599 22.7 120 22.7 120 22.1 9.4 21.3
Note) The greasing hole on the top face and the pilot hole of the side nipple** are not drilled through in order to prevent for-
eign material from entering the block.
See A1-441 for details.
The maximum length under “Length*” indicates the standard maximum length of an LM rail. (See A1-440.)
Static permissible moment*: 1 block: static permissible moment value with 1 LM block
Double blocks: static permissible moment value with 2 blocks closely contacting with each other
Options⇒A1-473 A1-439
506E
G F G
L0
Table4 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SRN Unit: mm
A1-440
506E
SRN
Greasing Hole
[Greasing Hole for Model SRN]
Model SRN allows lubrication from both the side and top faces of the LM block. The greasing hole of
standard types is not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the LM block.
When using the greasing hole, contact THK.
LM Guide
Greasing hole on the top face
φ D2 depth 1
e1
φ D0
e0 Side nipple
(M6 pilot hole)
f0
V
Unit: mm
Pilot hole for side nipple Applicable Greasing hole on the top face
Model No.
e0 f0 D0 nipple D2 (O-ring) V e1
35C
8 7.0 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 6
35LC
35R
8 7.0 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 6
35LR
45C
8.5 7.6 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 7
45LC
45R
SRN 45LR 8.5 7.6 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 7
55C
10 9.8 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 11
55LC
55R
10 9.8 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 11
55LR
65LC 9 13 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 10
65LR 9 13 5.2 M6F 10.2 (P7) 0.4 10
Note) The greasing interval is longer than that of full-roller types because of the roller cage effect. However, the actual greas-
ing interval may vary depending on the service environment, such as a high load and high speed. Contact THK for de-
tails.
A1-441
506E
SRW
Caged Roller LM Guide Ultra-high Rigidity Type (Wide) Model SRW
LM block
Endplate
End seal
LM rail
A1-442
506E
SRW
LM Guide
[Ultra-high Rigidity]
Since it has a wide rail and can be secured on the table using two rows of mounting bolts, the
mounting strength is significantly increased. In addition, since the crosswise raceway distance (L) is
large, model SRW is structurally strong against a moment load (Mc moment) in the rolling direction.
Furthermore, model SRW uses rollers that show little elastic deformation as its rolling elements, and
the overall length of each roller is 1.5 times greater than the diameter, thus to increase the rigidity.
Rolling direction moment
(Mc moment)
0.0015
Slant tan θ
0.001
SRG45LR
0.0005
SRW70LR
L 0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1
Applied moment M (kN•m)
Fig.1 Result of Comparison between Models SRW and SRG in Moment Rigidity in the Rolling Direction (Mc Moment)
A1-443
506E
Fig.3
A1-444
506E
SRW
LM Guide
Table1 Error in Parallelism (P) between Two Rails
Unit: mm
Radial clearance
for parallelism P
Normal C1 C0
Model No.
Tolerance
SRW 70 0.013 0.009 0.007
SRW 85 0.016 0.011 0.008
SRW 100 0.020 0.014 0.011
SRW 130 0.026 0.018 0.014 Fig.4
SRW 150 0.030 0.021 0.016
Table3 Error in Level (Y) in the Axial Direction
Table2 Error in Level (X) between Two Rails Unit: mm
Unit: mm
Accuracy of the
0.000036b
Radial clearance Normal C1 C0 mounting surface
Accuracy of the
0.00020a 0.00014a 0.000072a
mounting surface X
X=X1+X2
X1: Level difference on the rail mounting surface
X2: Level difference on the block mounting surface
Example of calculation
When the rail span :
a=500mm
Accuracy of the mounting surface
X=0.0002 500
=0.1 X2
X1
a
Fig.5
b
Fig.6
A1-445
506E
Model SRW-LR
W3 B1 B
W 8-S×ℓ C
(E) L
L1 e0 4- φ D0
**
T φ d2
(K) N f0
M
h
M1
H3
φ d1
W2 W1 F
SRW
LM Guide
W (E) L
B 12-S×ℓ L1 e0
**
4- φ D0
B1 C
T φ d2 N f0
M (K)
h
M1
W3 H3 φ d1
W2 W1 F
Unit: mm
LM rail dimensions Basic load rating Static permissible moment kN-m* Mass
MA MB MC LM LM
Width Height Pitch Length* C C0
block rail
W1
1 Double 1 Double 1
0 W2 W3 M1 F d1×d2×h Max kN kN kg kg/m
block blocks block blocks block
-0.05
70 32.5 28 37 52.5 11×17.5×14 3090 115 256 6.13 32.2 6.13 32.2 10.2 6.3 18.6
85 40 32 43 60 14×20×17 3060 167 366 10.8 57 10.8 57 17.5 11.0 26.7
100 50 38 54 75 16×23×20 3000 278 599 22.7 120 22.7 120 33.9 21.6 35.9
130 65 52 71 90 18×26×22 3000 497 990 45.3 239 45.3 239 74.2 41.7 61.0
150 75 60 77 105 24×35×28 3000 601 1170 60 319 60 319 101.6 65.1 74.4
Options⇒A1-473 A1-447
506E
G F G
L0
Table4 Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail for Model SRW Unit: mm
Model No. SRW 70 SRW 85 SRW 100 SRW 130 SRW 150
570 780 1270 1530 1340
675 900 1570 1890 1760
780 1020 2020 2250 2180
885 1140 2620 2610 2600
990 1260
1095 1380
1200 1500
1305 1620
1410 1740
1515 1860
1620 1980
LM rail standard 1725 2100
length (L0) 1830 2220
1935 2340
2040 2460
2145 2580
2250 2700
2355 2820
2460 2940
2565 3060
2670
2775
2880
2985
Standard pitch F 52.5 60 75 90 105
G 22.5 30 35 45 40
Max length 3090 3060 3000 3000 3000
Note1) The maximum length varies with accuracy grades. Contact THK for details.
Note2) If jointed rails are not allowed and a greater length than the maximum values above is required, contact THK.
A1-448
506E
SRW
Greasing Hole
[Greasing Hole for Model SRW]
Model SRW allows lubrication from both the side and top faces of the LM block. The greasing hole
of standard types is not drilled through in order to prevent foreign material from entering the LM
block. When using the greasing hole, contact THK.
LM Guide
φ D2 depth 2 Greasing hole on the top face
e1
4- φ D0
e0 Side nipple
V
f0
Unit: mm
Pilot hole for side nipple Applicable Greasing hole on the top face
Model No.
e0 f0 D0 nipple D2 (O-ring) V e1
70 7 17 5.2 M6F 13 (P10) 0.4 2.7
85 9 18.5 5.2 M6F 13 (P10) 0.4 9.9
SRW 100 9 23.5 5.2 M6F 13 (P10) 0.4 10.1
130 15 42 8.2 PT1/8 13 (P10) 0.4 10
150 15 53 8.2 PT1/8 13 (P10) 0.4 10
Note) The greasing interval is longer than that of full-roller types because of the roller cage effect. However, the actual greas-
ing interval may vary depending on the service environment, such as a high load and high speed. Contact THK for de-
tails.
A1-449
506E
A1-450
506E
Point of Design
Designing the Guide System
LM Guide
Load direction Reverse radial load
Lateral load
Radial load
Model SHS
When high rigidity is required in all directions and the installation space is limited in height
A1-451
506E
Single-rail configuration
Load direction
Reverse radial load
Lateral load
Model SHW
Radial load
When the minimum possible height of the equipment is allowed (Adjustable preload type)
Load direction
Reverse radial load
Lateral load Model HR
Radial load
When a medium load is applied and the mounting surface is rough (Preload, self-adjusting type)
Load direction
Reverse radial load
Lateral load Model GSR
Radial load
A1-452
506E
Point of Design
Designing the Guide System
LM Guide
LM rail reference surface
Double-rail configuration
Model HR Model CF
(Cam follower)
Model HSR-R
A1-453
506E
Multi-rail configuration
A1-454
506E
Point of Design
Designing the Guide System
LM Guide
There are several ways of mounting the LM Guide as shown in Table1. When the machine is sub-
ject to vibrations that may cause the LM rail(s) or LM blocks to loosen, we recommend the securing
method indicated by Fig.1 on A1-456 . (If 2 or more rails are used in parallel, only the LM
block on the master rail should be secured in the crosswise direction.) If this method is not appli-
cable for a structural reason, hammer in knock pins to secure the LM block(s) as shown in Table2 on
A1-456 When using knock pins, machine the top/bottom surfaces of the LM rail by 2 to 3 mm
using a carbide end mill before drilling the holes since the surfaces are hardened.
Table1 Major Securing Methods on the Master-rail Side
(a) Secured only with side reference surfaces (b) Secured with set screws
(c) Secured with a presser plate (d) Secured with tapered gibs
A1-455
506E
(a) Secured only with the side reference sur- (b) Secured only with the side reference sur-
face of the rail face of the block
(c) Secured without a side reference surface (d) Secured with dowel pins
Table
Base
LM rail set screw
A1-456
506E
Point of Design
Designing a Mounting Surface
LM Guide
sign the mounting surface while taking the following points into account.
B C
[Corner Shape]
If the corner on the surface on which the LM rail
or LM block is to be mounted is machined to r
be shaped R, which is greater than the cham-
fer dimension of the LM rail or LM block, then r
the rail or the block may not closely contact its
r r
reference surface. Therefore, when designing
a mounting surface, it is important to carefully
read the description on the “corner shape” of A B
the subject model . (Fig.2) Fig.2
Fig.3
A1-457
506E
[Dimensional Tolerance between the Reference Surface and the Mounting Hole]
If the dimensional tolerance between the refer-
ence surface of the LM rail or the LM block and
the mounting hole is too large, the rail or the W3
block may not closely contact the reference sur-
face when mounted on the base. D
Normally, the tolerance should be within 0.1
mm depending on the model. (Fig.5)
Fig.5
A1-458
506E
Point of Design
Designing a Mounting Surface
LM Guide
The corner of the mounting shoulder must be machined to have a recess, or machined to be smaller
than the corner radius “r,” to prevent interference with the chamfer of the LM rail or the LM block.
The corner radius varies with model numbers. See A1-459 to A1-465 for details.
r
r
H2
H 1 H3
r
r
Shoulder for the LM Rail Shoulder for the LM Block (LM casing)
Fig.7
A1-459
506E
H2
H3 H1
A1-460
506E
Point of Design
Designing a Mounting Surface
r2
r2 r
r
H2 H2
H3 H 1
LM Guide
r1
r
r
r1 H1
H3
Shoulder for the LM Rail Shoulder for the LM Block
Fig.9 Fig.10
r2
r2
H3
H2
H 1 r1
r1
A1-462
506E
Point of Design
Designing a Mounting Surface
r
r r
H2 r H2
r H1 H3
LM Guide
H3 H1 r
r D r
Shoulder for the LM Rail Shoulder for the LM Block Shoulder for the LM Rail Shoulder for the LM Block
Fig.12 Fig.13
A1-463
506E
r
r
r
H2
r
H2
r H1
H3 H 1 r
r
r
Fig.14 Fig.15
H3 H r
r
Fig.16
[Model GSR-R]
Unit: mm
Shoulder
Corner
Model height for
radius
No. the LM rail
r(max) H H3
25 0.8 4 4.5
30 1.2 4 4.5
35 1.2 4.5 5.5
A1-464
506E
Point of Design
Designing a Mounting Surface
r2
r2
H3
H2
LM Guide
r1
H1 r1
A1-465
506E
[Models SHS, SCR, HSR, CSR, HSR-M1, HSR-M2, [Models SSR, SR, SR-M1]
and HSR-M1VV] Unit: m
Unit: m
Clearance Clearance Normal
Model No.
Clearance Clearance Normal C0 C1 clearance
Model No.
C0 C1 clearance 15 — 25 35
8 — 10 13 20 25 30 40
10 — 12 16 25 30 35 50
12 — 15 20 30 35 40 60
15 — 18 25 35 45 50 70
20 18 20 25 45 55 60 80
25 20 22 30 55 65 70 100
30 27 30 40 70 65 80 110
35 30 35 50 85 80 90 120
45 35 40 60 100 90 100 130
55 45 50 70 120 100 110 140
65 55 60 80 150 110 120 150
85 70 75 90
100 85 90 100 [Models SVR and NR]
120 100 110 120 Unit: m
150 115 130 140
Clearance Clearance Normal
Model No.
C0 C1 clearance
[Model JR]
25 14 15 21
Unit: m
30 19 21 28
Model No. — 35 21 25 35
25 100 45 25 28 42
35 200 55 32 35 49
45 300 65 39 42 56
55 400 75 44 47 60
85 49 53 63
100 60 63 70
A1-466
506E
Point of Design
Designing a Mounting Surface
LM Guide
45 18 20 30
55 23 25 35 Clearance Clearance Normal
Model No.
65 28 30 40 C0 C1 clearance
75 31 34 43 918 — 7 10
85 35 38 45 1123 — 8 14
100 43 45 50 1530 — 12 18
2042 14 15 20
[Models SHW and HRW] 2555 20 24 35
Unit: m 3065 22 26 38
Clearance Clearance Normal 3575 24 28 42
Model No. 4085 30 35 50
C0 C1 clearance
50105 38 42 55
12 — 10 13
60125 50 55 65
14 — 12 16
17 — 15 20
21 — 18 25 [Models GSR and GSR-R]
Unit: m
27 — 20 25
35 20 22 30 Model No. —
50 27 30 40 15 30
60 30 35 50 20 40
25 50
[Models SRS, RSR, RSR-W, RSR-Z 30 60
and RSR-M1] 35 70
Unit: m
Circular-arc [Model NSR-TBC]
Gothic-arch groove
groove Unit: m
Model No.
Clearance Normal Normal
Normal
C1 clearance clearance Model No. Clearance C1
clearance
3 — 2 —
20 40 50
5 — 2 —
25 50 70
7 — 3 —
30 60 80
9 3 4 11
40 70 90
12 5 9 15
50 80 110
14 6 10 —
70 90 130
15 6 10 18
20 8 13 25
25 10 15 30
A1-467
506E
A1-468
506E
Point of Design
Designing a Mounting Surface
LM Guide
S
500
Fig.19 Error Allowance in Vertical Level (S) between Two Rails
[Models SHS, HSR, CSR, HSR-M1, HSR-M2, [Models SVR and NR]
and HSR-M1VV] Unit: m
Unit: m
Clearance Clearance Normal
Model No.
Clearance Clearance Normal C0 C1 clearance
Model No.
C0 C1 clearance 25 35 43 65
8 — 11 40 30 45 55 85
10 — 16 50 35 60 75 105
12 — 20 65 45 70 85 125
15 — 85 130 55 85 105 150
20 50 85 130 65 100 125 175
25 70 85 130 75 110 135 188
30 90 110 170 85 120 145 200
35 120 150 210 100 140 165 225
45 140 170 250
55 170 210 300 [Model JR]
65 200 250 350 Unit: m
85 240 290 400
Model No. —
100 280 330 450
120 320 370 500 25 400
150 360 410 550 35 500
45 800
[Models SSR, SR, SR-M1] 55 1000
Unit: m
A1-469
506E
A1-470
506E
Point of Design
Designing a Mounting Surface
LM Guide
on the master LM rail has its reference surface
finished to a designated accuracy, allowing it to Master LM Guide
serve as the positioning reference for the table.
(See Fig.20.)
LM Guides of normal grade are not marked with
“KB.” Therefore, any one of the LM rails hav-
ing the same serial number can be used as the
master LM rail.
Subsidiary LM Guide
Y2F123 KB
Master mark
Serial number
THK logo
Reference surface
Line marking
Subsidiary LM Guide
A1-471
506E
Fig.22 Serial Number Marking and Combined Use of an LM Rail and LM Blocks
Subsidiary-rail axis
Reference surface Reference surface
A1-472
506E
A1-473
506E
Contamination Protection
End seal Double seals End seal Double seals
Type End Side Inner + Side seal + Side seal Side End seal Double seals
Model No. + Side seal + Side seal (+ Inner seal) (+ Inner seal) LaCS
seal seal seal Scraper + Protector + Protector
(+ Inner seal) (+ Inner seal) + Metal scraper + Metal scraper
Symbol UU — — SS DD ZZ KK HH YY JJ TT
SHS 15 to 65 ○ ○ ○ ○★ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
SSR 15 to 35 ○★ ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
SVR 25 to 65 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
SVS 25 to 65 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
12,14 ○ ○ — ○ — — — ○ — — —
Caged Ball
SHW 17 ○ ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
21 to 50 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
5 ○★ — — — — — — — — — —
SRS 7 ○★ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
9 to 25 ○★ ○ — ○ — — — ○ — — —
SCR 15 to 65 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
EPS 7 to 15 — — — — — — — — — — —
○ — — — — — — — — — —
8,10,12
○ ○ — ○★ ○ ○ *6 ○* 6 ○ — — —
15,20,25
30,35 ○ ○ — ○★ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
HSR
45,55,65 ○ ○ — ○★ ○ ○ ○ — — — —
85
○ ○ — ○★ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
100,120,150
○ ○ — ○★ — — — — — — —
15 to 25 ○ ○ — ○ ○ ○* 7 ○*7 — — — —
Full-ball
SR 30 to 70 ○ ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — —
85 to 150 ○ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
25 to 65,100 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ *8 ○ *8 ○ *8 ○ *8 — — —
NR
75,85 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
25 to 65,100 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ *9 ○ *9 ○*9 ○ *9 — — —
NRS
75,85 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
12,14 ○★ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
HRW 17,21 ○★ — — — ○ ○ ○ — — — —
27 to 60 ○★ ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — —
*1 Model SHS : Dedicated cap GC --- not applicable to only model SHS15
*2 Model SSR : Dedicated cap GC --- not applicable to model SSR15, Stainless steel LM Guides --- applicable to XV, XW
*3 Model SHW : GG, PP --- applicable to only model SHW21, Dedicated cap GC --- applicable to SHW35, 50
*4 Model SRS : Dedicated cap C --- applicable to models SRS9W, 12, 15, 20, 25
*5 Model SCR : Dedicated cap GC --- not applicable to only model SCR15
*6 Model HSR : ZZ, KK --- grease nipple cannot be attached to model HSR15,
GG --- applicable to model HSR25, Steel tape SP --- applicable to models HSR15 to 100, Dedicated cap C --- applicable to models HSR12 to 100,
Dedicated cap GC --- applicable to models HSR20 to 100,
Dedicated LM cover --- applicable to models HSR25 to 55, Model HSR Grade Ct --- supports SS only
Inner seal --- applicable to models HSR30 to 85
*7 Model SR : ZZ, KK --- grease nipple cannot be attached to models SR15, 20.
Dedicated cap C --- applicable to models SR15 to 85, dedicated cap GC --- applicable to models SR20 to 85,
Stainless steel LM Guides --- applicable to models SR15 to 35
*8 Model NR : DD,ZZ,KK and HH --- side nipple required for model NR100, Plate cover SV --- applicable to models NR35 to 75,
Dedicated cap C and GC --- not applicable to only model NR75
A1-474
506E
Options
Table of Supported Options by Models
LM Guide (Options)
end seal + side seal (+ Inner seal) bellows Cover Rail Type tor side nipple AP-CF LM Guide
TPH (dedicated
LL RR GG PP Z Z — — — for HSR) K QZ — F M
— — ○ ○ — ○ ○ △* 1 ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ —
— — ○ ○ — ○ ○ △*2 ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ △*2
— — — — — — ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — — — ○ — — — — ○ — ○ ○
— — — — — — ○ — ○ — — ○ — ○ ○
— — △*3 △*3 — — ○ △* 3 ○ — — ○ — ○ —
— — — — — — — — — — — — — — ○
— — — — — — — — — — — ○ — — ○
— — — — — — △*4 — — — — ○ — — ○
— — — — — — ○ △*5 — — ○ ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
— — — — — — △*6 — — — — — — ○ ○
○ ○ △*6 — — ○ ○ △* 6 ○ △ *6 ○ ○ — ○ ○
○ ○ — — — ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — ○ ○
○ ○ — — — ○ ○ ○ ○ △ *6 ○ ○ — ○ —
— — — — — ○ ○ ○ ○ — — ○ — ○ —
— — — — — △* 6 △*6 △*6 — — — — — ○ —
○ ○ — — — ○ ○ △* 7 ○ ̶ ○ — — ○ ○
— — — — — ○ ○ ○ ○ ̶ ○ — — ○ △* 7
— — — — — — △*7 △*7 — — — — — ○ —
— — — — △*8 ○ ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — △*8 ○ △*8 △*8 ○ — — — ○ ○ —
— — — — △*9 ○ ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — △*9 ○ △*9 △*9 ○ — — — ○ ○ —
— — — — — — △*10 — — — — — — ○ ○
— — — — — — ○ — ○ — — — — ○ ○
— — — — — — ○ △*10 △*10 — — — — ○ △*10
*9 Model NRS : DD,ZZ,KK and HH --- side nipple required for model NRS100, Plate cover SV --- applicable to models NRS35 to 75,
Dedicated cap C and GC --- not applicable to only model NRS75
*10 Model HRW: Dedicated cap C --- applicable to models HRW14 to 60, Dedicated cap GC --- applicable to models HRW35, 50, 60,
Dedicated bellows --- applicable to models HRW17 to 50, Stainless steel LM Guides --- applicable to models HRW12 to 35
A1-475
506E
Contamination Protection
End seal Double seals End seal Double seals
Type End Side Inner + Side seal + Side seal Side End seal Double seals
Model No. + Side seal + Side seal (+ Inner seal) (+ Inner seal) LaCS
seal seal seal Scraper + Protector + Protector
(+ Inner seal) (+ Inner seal) + Metal scraper + Metal scraper
Symbol UU — — SS DD ZZ KK HH YY JJ TT
2,3 — — — — — — — — — — —
RSR 3W,5,7,14,20 ○ — — — — — — — — — —
9,9W,12,12W,15,15W ○ — — — — — — — — — —
7 ○★ — — — — — — — — — —
RSR-Z 9 ○★ — — — — — — — — — —
9W,12,12W,15,15W ○★ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
918 to 2555 ○ — — — — — — — — — —
HR
3065 to 60125 ○ — — — — — — — — — —
GSR 15 to 35 ○★ ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — —
GSR-R 25 to 35 ○ ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — —
15 to 25 ○ ○ — ○ ○ ○*16 ○*16 — — — —
CSR
30 to 45 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — —
Full-ball
MX 5,7 ○ — — — — — — — — — —
JR 25 to 55 ○ ○ — ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — —
12 ○ — — — — — — — — — —
HCR
15 to 65 ○ ○ — ○ ○ ○ *17 ○ *17 — — — —
HMG 15 to 65 ○ — — — — — — — — — —
20TBC to 30TBC ○ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
NSR
40TBC to 70TBC ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — — — — —
15M1 ○ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
HSR-M1 20M1 to 30M1 ○ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
35M1 ○ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
SR-M1 15 to 35 ○ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
9,12W,15W ○ — — — — — — — — — —
RSR-M1
9W,12,15,20 ○ — — — — — — — — — —
HSR-M2 15 to 25 ○ ○ — ○ — — — — — — —
○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — — — —
15
20,25,35 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
SRG
Caged Roller
30,45,55,65 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
85,100
○ ○ ○ ○ ○*19 — — — — — —
SRN 35 to 65 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
70 to 100 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — —
SRW
130,150 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ — — — —
*11 Model RSR : Dedicated cap C --- applicable to models RSR9W, 12, 14W, 15 and 20
*12 Model RSR-Z : Dedicated cap C --- applicable to models RSR9W, 12 and 15
*13 Model HR : Dedicated cap C --- applicable to models HR1123 to 50105, Dedicated cap GC --- applicable to models HR2042 to 50105
*14 Model GSR : Dedicated cap GC --- applicable to models GSR20 to 35
*15 Model GSR-R : AP-HC treatment of rack rail is not applicable
*16 Model CSR : ZZ, KK --- grease nipple cannot be attached to models CSR15.Dedicated cap model GC --- applicable to models CSR20,25.
A1-476
506E
Options
Table of Supported Options by Models
LM Guide (Options)
end seal + side seal (+ Inner seal) bellows Cover Rail Type tor side nipple AP-CF LM Guide
TPH (dedicated
LL RR GG PP Z Z — — — for HSR) K QZ — F M
— — — — — — — — — — — — — ○ ○
— — — — — — △*11 — — — — — — ○ ○
— — — — — — △*11 — — — — ○ — ○ ○
— — — — — — — — — — — — — — ○
— — — — — — ○ — — — — ̶ — — ○
— — — — — — △*12 — — — — ̶ — — ○
— — — — — — △*13 △*13 — — — — — ○ ○
— — — — — — △*13 △*13 — — — — — ○ —
— — — — — — ○ △*14 — — — — — ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ — — — — — △*15 —
○ ○ — — — — ○ △*16 — — ○ — — ○ —
○ ○ — — — — ○ ○ — — ○ — — ○ —
— — — — — — — — — — ○ — — ○ ○
— — — — — — — — — — — — — ○ —
— — — — — — — — — — — — — ○ —
○ ○ — — — — — — — — — — — ○ —
— — — — — — ○ △*18 — — — — — ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ ○ — — — — ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ ○ — — — — ○ —
— — — — — — — — — — — — — ○
— — — — — — — ̶ — — — — — ○
— — — — — — ○ — — — — — — ○
— — — — — — ○ — — — — — — ○
— — — — — — ○ — — — — — — ○
— — — — — — — — — — — — — ○
— — — — — — ○ ̶ — — — — — ○
— — ○ ○ — — ○ — ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ — — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
— — — — — — ○ ○ ○ — — ○ ○ ○ —
*17 Model HCR : ZZ, KK --- grease nipple cannot be attached to model HCR15.
*18 Model HMG : Dedicated cap GC --- applicable to model HMG25
*19 Model SRG : DD --- side nipple required for model SRG100.
A1-477
506E
A1-478
506E
Options
Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS
LM Guide (Options)
For locations with adverse environment, Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS is available.
LaCS removes minute foreign material adhering to the LM rail in multiple stages and prevents it
from entering the LM block with laminated contact structure (3-layer scraper).
LM block
Ball cage
Mounting bolt Ball
Contact scraper
Metal scraper
End seal
Liquid
LM rail
Large amount
QZ Lubricator
of foreign material
Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS
Appearance Drawing Structural Drawing
[Features]
● Since the 3 layers of scrapers fully contact the LM rail, LaCS is highly capable of removing minute
foreign material.
● Since it uses oil-impregnated, foam synthetic rubber with a self-lubricating function, low friction
resistance is achieved.
A1-479
506E
No.2
with
LaCS Not fractured at 5,000 km
0 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 Lip has not been fractured
Distance traveled (km)
A1-480
506E
Options
Side Scraper
Side Scraper
●For the supported models: models SVR/SVS
●For the resistance of side scraper, see A1-501.
●For the LM block dimension (dimension L) with side scraper attached, see A1-484.
●For notes regarding how to handle the side scraper, see A1-546.
LM Guide (Options)
Foreign
Route of entrance by foreign material material
Side scraper case from the side face of the LM block
Foreign material
Outline view
(Ex: in case of QZTTHHYY type)
[Features]
● Minimizes foreign material entering from the side of the LM Guide in a harsh environment.
● Demonstrates a dust protection effect in inverted or wall mount.
The shoulder height of the mounting surface and the corner
radius after the side scraper is mounted
Unit: mm
Corner
Shoulder height
H3 Model No. radius H3
H1 of the LM rail
r(max)
H1
r
25 0.5 2 2.7
30 1 3.5 4.2
35 1 5.5 6.2
r 45 1 8 8.8
Side view of the LM block after the side scraper is mounted 55 1.5 10.5 11.2
65 1.5 11 12.1
Note) Note that the side scraper is not sold alone.
* The side scraper can accommodate various options of dust control accessories and lubrication accessories. For details,
contact THK.
A1-481
506E
Protector
●For the supported models: models SVR/SVS
●HH type (with LaCS) of models SVR/SVS is provided with the protector.
●For the LM block dimension (dimension L) with protector attached, see A1-484.
[Features]
● The protector minimizes the entrance of foreign material even in harsh environments where for-
eign material such as fine particles and liquids are present.
The shoulder height of the mounting surface and the corner
radius after the protector is mounted
Unit: mm
A1-482
506E
Options
Light-Resistance Contact Seal LiCS
LM Guide (Options)
LiCS is a light sliding resistance contact seal. It is effective in removing dust on the raceway and re-
taining a lubricant such as grease. It achieves extremely low drag and smooth, stable motion.
LiCS
[Features]
Light-Resistance Contact Seal LiCS is a seal that uses a light-resistance material in its sealing ele-
ment and contacts the LM rail raceway to achieve low drag resistance. It is optimal for applications
where low drag resistance is required, such as semiconductor-related devices, inspection devices
and OA equipment all of which are used in favorable environments.
• Since the sealing element contacts the LM rail raceway, it is effective in removing dust on the
raceway.
• Use of oil-impregnated, expanded synthetic rubber, which has excellent self-lubricating property,
achieves low drag resistance.
SSR20 XW 2 GG C1 +600L P -Ⅱ
LM Guide Type of With LiCS seal LM rail length Symbol for No. of rails used
model LM block on both ends (in mm) on the same plane
number Radial clearance symbol Accuracy symbol
No. of LM blocks Normal grade (No Symbol) / High accuracy grade (H)
Normal (No symbol)
used on the same rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P) / Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
A1-483
506E
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
UU SS DD ZZ KK SSHH DDHH ZZHH KKHH
overall length
15C/V/R 64.4 64.4 64.4 69.8 66.8 72.2 78.6 84 79.8 85.2
15LC/LV 79.4 79.4 79.4 84.8 81.8 87.2 93.6 99 94.8 100.2
20C/V 79 79 79 85.4 83 89.4 93.6 100 96 102.4
20LC/LV 98 98 98 104.4 102 108.4 112.6 119 115 121.4
25C/V/R 92 92 92 101.6 100.4 107.6 112 119.2 114.4 121.6
25LC/LV/LR 109 109 109 118.6 117.4 124.6 129 136.2 131.4 138.6
30C/V/R 106 106 106 116 113.8 122.4 129.4 138 131.8 140.4
30LC/LV/LR 131 131 131 141 138.8 147.4 154.4 163 156.8 165.4
SHS
35C/V/R 122 122 122 134.8 132.4 142.2 148 157.8 150.4 160.2
35LC/LV/LR 152 152 152 164.8 162.4 172.2 178 187.8 180.4 190.2
45C/V/R 140 140 140 152.8 151.2 161 169 178.8 172.2 182
45LC/LV/LR 174 174 174 186.8 185.2 195 203 212.8 206.2 216
55C/V/R 171 171 171 186.6 184.2 195.4 202 213.2 205.2 216.4
55LC/LV/LR 213 213 213 228.6 226.2 237.4 244 255.2 247.2 258.4
65C/V 221 221 221 238.6 236.2 248.6 258 270.4 261.2 273.6
65LC/LV 272 272 272 289.6 287.2 299.6 309 321.4 312.2 324.6
15XVY 40.3 40.3 40.3 47.3 44.9 50.7 59.5 65.3 60.7 66.5
15XWY/XTBY 56.9 56.9 56.9 63.9 61.5 67.3 76.1 81.9 77.3 83.1
20XV 47.7 47.7 47.7 54.6 53.4 60.3 67.7 74.6 70.1 77
20XW/XTB 66.5 66.5 66.5 73.4 72.2 79.1 86.5 93.4 88.9 95.8
SSR
25XVY 60 60 60 67.4 65.7 73.1 80 87.4 82.4 89.8
25XWY/XTBY 83 83 83 90.4 88.7 96.1 103 110.4 105.4 112.8
30XW 97 97 97 105.1 102.7 110.8 121 129.1 123.4 131.5
35XW 110.9 110.9 110.9 119.9 117.7 126.7 136.9 145.9 139.3 148.3
12CAM/CRM 37 37 37 — — — 48 — — —
12HRM 50.4 50.4 50.4 — — — 61.4 — — —
14CAM/CRM 45.5 45.5 45.5 — — — 60.7 — — —
17CAM/CRM 51 51 51 54 53.4 56.4 66.2 69.2 67.4 70.4
SHW
21CA/CR 59 59 59 64 63.2 68.2 75.6 80.6 77.2 82.2
27CA/CR 72.8 72.8 72.8 78.6 77.8 83.6 89.4 95.2 91.8 97.6
35CA/CR 107 107 107 114.4 112 119.4 129 136.4 131.4 138.8
50CA/CR 141 141 141 149.2 147.4 155.6 166 174.2 168.4 176.6
Note) The standard overall length may include the dimension of the end seal depending on the model. If you are considering
using a type without an end seal, contact THK for details.
A1-484
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
UU SS DD ZZ KK SSHH DDHH ZZHH KKHH
overall length
5 16.9 16.9 — — — — — — — —
5W 22.1 22.1 — — — — — — — —
7 23.4 23.4 23.4 — — — — — — —
7W 31 31 31 — — — — — — —
LM Guide (Options)
9XS 21.5 21.5 21.5 — — — 33.1 — — —
9XM 30.8 30.8 30.8 — — — 42.4 — — —
9XN 40.8 40.8 40.8 — — — 52.4 — — —
9W 39 39 39 — — — 50.6 — — —
9WN 50.7 50.7 50.7 — — — 62.3 — — —
SRS 12 34.4 34.4 34.4 — — — 46 — — —
12N 47.1 47.1 47.1 — — — 58.7 — — —
12W 44.5 44.5 44.5 — — — 56.1 — — —
12WN 59.5 59.5 59.5 — — — 71.1 — — —
15 43 43 43 — — — 57.2 — — —
15N 60.8 60.8 60.8 — — — 75 — — —
15W 55.5 55.5 55.5 — — — 69.7 — — —
15WN 74.5 74.5 74.5 — — — 88.7 — — —
20 50 50 50 — — — 65.2 — — —
25 77 77 77 — — — 92.6 — — —
15S 64.4 64.4 64.4 69.8 66.8 72.2 78.9 84.4 79.9 85.2
20S 79 79 79 85.4 83 89.4 94 100 96 102.5
20 98 98 98 104.4 102 108.4 113 119 115 121.5
25 109 109 109 118.6 117.4 124.6 129 136.2 131.4 138.6
SCR
30 131 131 131 141 138.8 147.4 154.4 163 156.8 165.4
35 152 152 152 164.8 162.4 172.2 178 187.8 180.4 190.2
45 174 174 174 186.8 185.2 195 203 212.8 206.2 216
65 272 272 272 289.6 287.2 299.6 309 321.4 312.2 324.6
8RM 24 24 — — — — — — — —
10RM 31 31 — — — — — — — —
12RM 45 45 — — — — — — — —
15A/B/R/YR 56.6 56.6 56.6 61.8 58.2* 63.4* 76 81.2 77.2 82.4
20A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 74 74 74 80.6 76.6 83.2 92 98.6 95.2 101.8
20LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 90 90 90 96.6 92.6 99.2 108 114.6 111.2 117.8
25A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 83.1 83.1 83.1 90.7 86.7 94.3 101 108.6 105.3 112.9
25LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 102.2 102.2 102.2 109.8 105.8 113.4 120.1 127.7 124.4 132
30A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 98 98 98 105.6 101.6 109.2 119.9 127.5 124.2 131.8
30LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 120.6 120.6 120.6 128.2 124.2 131.8 142.5 150.1 146.8 154.4
35A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 109.4 109.4 109.4 117 113 120.6 132.4 140 135.6 143.2
HSR 35LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 134.8 134.8 134.8 142.4 138.4 146 157.8 165.4 161 168.6
45A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 139 139 139 146.2 144.2 151.4 — — — —
45LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 170.8 170.8 170.8 178 176 183.2 — — — —
55A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 163 163 163 170.2 168.2 175.4 — — — —
55LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 201.1 201.1 201.1 208.3 206.3 213.5 — — — —
65A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 186 186 186 193.2 191.2 198.4 — — — —
65LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 245.5 245.5 245.5 252.7 250.7 257.9 — — — —
85A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 245.6 245.6 245.6 252.8 252.4 259.6 — — — —
85LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 303 303 303 310.2 309.8 317 — — — —
100HA/HB/HR 334 334 334 — — — — — — —
120HA/HB/HR 365 365 365 — — — — — — —
150HA/HB/HR 396 396 396 — — — — — — —
*A grease nipple cannot be attached. Contact THK for details.
Note) The standard overall length may include the dimension of the end seal depending on the model. If you are considering
using a type without an end seal, contact THK for details.
A1-485
506E
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
UU SS DD ZZ KK SSHH DDHH ZZHH KKHH
overall length
15W/TB 57 57 57 62.2 58.4* 63.6* — — — —
15V/SB 40.4 40.4 40.4 45.6 41.8* 47* — — — —
20W/TB 66.2 66.2 66.2 72.8 70.6* 77.2* — — — —
20V/SB 47.3 47.3 47.3 53.9 51.7* 58.3* — — — —
25WY/TBY 83 83 83 90.6 87.4 95 — — — —
25VY/SBY 59.2 59.2 59.2 66.8 63.6 71.2 — — — —
30W/TB 96.8 96.8 96.8 104.4 99.4 107 — — — —
30V/SB 67.9 67.9 67.9 75.5 70.5 78.1 — — — —
SR 35W/TB 111 111 111 118.6 113.6 121.2 — — — —
35V/SB 77.6 77.6 77.6 85.2 80.2 87.8 — — — —
45W/TB 126 126 126 134.6 129.4 138 — — — —
55W/TB 156 156 156 164.6 159.4 168 — — — —
70T 194.6 194.6 194.6 201.8 200.8 208 — — — —
85T 180 180 180 — — — — — — —
100T 200 200 200 — — — — — — —
120T 235 235 235 — — — — — — —
150T 280 280 280 — — — — — — —
25XR/XA/XB 82.8 82.8 82.8 90.4 89.2 96.8 100.1 107.7 102.5 110.1
25XLR/XLA/XLB 102 102 102 109.6 108.4 116 119.3 126.9 121.7 129.3
30R/A/B 98 98 98 107 104.4 113.4 119.3 128.3 121.7 130.7
30LR/LA/LB 120.5 120.5 120.5 129.5 126.9 135.9 141.8 150.8 144.2 153.2
35R/A/B 109.5 109.5 109.5 119.7 117.1 127.3 131.1 141.3 133.5 143.7
35LR/LA/LB 135 135 135 145.2 142.6 152.8 156.6 166.8 159 169.2
45R/A/B 139 139 139 149.2 147.4 157.6 164.4 174.6 167.6 177.8
45LR/LA/LB 171 171 171 181.2 179.4 189.6 196.4 206.6 199.6 209.8
NR/ 55R/A/B 162.8 162.8 162.8 173 171.4 181.6 188.1 198.3 191.3 201.5
NRS 55LR/LA/LB 200 200 200 210.2 208.6 218.8 225.3 235.5 228.5 238.7
65R/A/B 185.6 185.6 185.6 196.2 194.2 204.8 214.9 225.5 218.1 228.7
65LR/LA/LB 245.6 245.6 245.6 256.2 254.2 264.8 274.9 285.5 278.1 288.7
75R/A/B 218 218 218 229 226.6 237.6 — — — —
75LR/LA/LB 274 274 274 285 282.6 293.6 — — — —
85R/A/B 246.7 246.7 246.7 257.7 256.1 267.1 — — — —
85LR/LA/LB 302.8 302.8 302.8 313.8 312.2 323.2 — — — —
100R/A/B 286.2 286.2 286.2 297.8 295.6 307.2 — — — —
100LR/LA/LB 326.2 326.2 326.2 337.8 335.6 347.2 — — — —
12LRM 37 37 37 — — — — — — —
14LRM 45.5 45.5 45.5 — — — — — — —
17CA/CR 50.8 50.8 — 54 53.6 58.6 — — — —
21CA/CR 58.8 58.8 — 64.2 62.8 69 — — — —
HRW
27CA/CR 72.8 72.8 72.8 79 75.6 81.8 — — — —
35CA/CR 106.6 106.6 106.6 113.8 112 119.2 — — — —
50CA/CR 140.5 140.5 140.5 147.7 143.3 150.5 — — — —
60CA 158.9 158.9 158.9 169.7 165.1 175.9 — — — —
*A grease nipple cannot be attached. Contact THK for details.
Note) The standard overall length may include the dimension of the end seal depending on the model. If you are considering
using a type without an end seal, contact THK for details.
A1-486
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
UU SS DD ZZ KK SSHH DDHH ZZHH KKHH
overall length
3M — — — — — — — — — —
3N — — — — — — — — — —
3WM 14.9 14.9 — — — — — — — —
3WN 19.9 19.9 — — — — — — — —
LM Guide (Options)
5M 16.9 16.9 — — — — — — — —
5N/TN 20.1 20.1 — — — — — — — —
5WM/WTM 22.1 22.1 — — — — — — — —
5WN/WTN 28.1 28.1 — — — — — — — —
7M 23.4 23.4 — — — — — — — —
7N 33 33 — — — — — — — —
7WM/WTM 31 31 — — — — — — — —
7WN/WTN 40.9 40.9 — — — — — — — —
9KM 30.8 30.8 — — — — — — — —
9N 40.8 40.8 — — — — — — — —
RSR/ 9WV 39 39 — — — — — — — —
RSR-W 9WVM 39 39 — — — — — — — —
9WN 50.7 50.7 — — — — — — — —
12VM 35 35 — — — — — — — —
12N 47.7 47.7 — — — — — — — —
12WV 44.5 44.5 — — — — — — — —
12WVM 44.5 44.5 — — — — — — — —
12WN 59.5 59.5 — — — — — — — —
14WV 50 50 — — — — — — — —
15VM 42.9 42.9 — — — — — — — —
15N 60.7 60.7 — — — — — — — —
15WV 55.5 55.5 — — — — — — — —
15WVM 55.5 55.5 — — — — — — — —
15WN 74.5 74.5 — — — — — — — —
20VN 66.5 66.5 — — — — — — — —
20N 86.3 86.3 — — — — — — — —
7ZM 23.4 23.4 — — — — — — — —
9ZM 30.8 30.8 — — — — — — — —
12ZM 35 35 35 — — — — — — —
RSR-Z/ 15ZM 43 43 43 — — — — — — —
WZ 7WZM 31.5 31.5 — — — — — — — —
9WZM 39 39 39 — — — — — — —
12WZM 44.5 44.5 44.5 — — — — — — —
15WZM 55.5 55.5 55.5 — — — — — — —
Note) The standard overall length may include the dimension of the end seal depending on the model. If you are considering
using a type without an end seal, contact THK for details.
A1-487
506E
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
UU SS DD ZZ KK SSHH DDHH ZZHH KKHH
overall length
918 45 45 — — — — — — — —
1123 52 52 — — — — — — — —
1530 69 69 — — — — — — — —
2042 91.6 91.6 — — — — — — — —
2042T 110.7 110.7 — — — — — — — —
2555 121 121 — — — — — — — —
2555T 146.4 146.4 — — — — — — — —
3065 145 145 — — — — — — — —
HR
3065T 173.5 173.5 — — — — — — — —
3575 154.8 154.8 — — — — — — — —
3575T 182.5 182.5 — — — — — — — —
4085 177.8 177.8 — — — — — — — —
4085T 215.9 215.9 — — — — — — — —
50105 227 227 — — — — — — — —
50105T 274.5 274.5 — — — — — — — —
60125 329 329 — — — — — — — —
15T 59.8 59.8 59.8 65* 65.8* 71* — — — —
15V 47.1 47.1 47.1 52.3* 53.1* 58.3* — — — —
20T 74 74 74 80.6 77.6 84.2 — — — —
20V 58.1 58.1 58.1 64.7 61.7 68.3 — — — —
GSR
25T 88 88 88 95 91.6 98.6 — — — —
25V 69 69 69 76 72.6 79.6 — — — —
30T 103 103 103 110.6 107.2 114.8 — — — —
35T 117 117 117 124.6 121.2 128.8 — — — —
25T-R 88 88 88 95 91.6 98.6 — — — —
25V-R 69 69 69 76 72.6 79.6 — — — —
GSR-R
30T-R 103 103 103 110.6 107.2 114.8 — — — —
35T-R 117 117 117 124.6 121.2 128.8 — — — —
15 56.6 56.6 56.6 61.8 58.2* 63.4* — — — —
20S 74 74 74 80.6 76.6 83.2 — — — —
20 90 90 90 96.6 92.6 99.2 — — — —
25S 83.1 83.1 83.1 90.7 86.7 94.3 — — — —
CSR 25 102.2 102.2 102.2 109.8 105.8 113.4 — — — —
30S 98 98 98 105.6 101.6 109.2 — — — —
30 120.6 120.6 120.6 128.2 124.2 131.8 — — — —
35 134.8 134.8 134.8 142.4 138.4 146 — — — —
45 170.8 170.8 170.8 178 176 183.2 — — — —
5M 23.3 23.3 — — — — — — — —
MX
7WM 40.8 40.8 — — — — — — — —
25A/B/R 83.1 83.1 83.1 90.7 89.4 97 — — — —
35A/B/R 113.6 113.6 113.6 125.6 122 134 — — — —
JR
45A/B/R 145 145 145 159 150.8 164.8 — — — —
55A/B/R 165 165 165 175.4 170.4 180.8 — — — —
*A grease nipple cannot be attached. Contact THK for details.
Note) The standard overall length may include the dimension of the end seal depending on the model. If you are considering
using a type without an end seal, contact THK for details.
A1-488
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
UU SS DD ZZ KK SSHH DDHH ZZHH KKHH
overall length
12A+60/100R 44.6 44.6 — — — — — — — —
15A+60/150R 54.5 54.5 54.5 59.7 — — — — — —
15A+60/300R 55.5 55.5 55.5 60.7 57.1* 62.3* — — — —
15A+60/400R 55.8 55.8 55.8 61 57.3* 62.5* — — — —
LM Guide (Options)
25A+60/500R 81.6 81.6 81.6 89.2 85.5 93.1 — — — —
25A+60/750R 82.3 82.3 82.3 89.9 86 93.6 — — — —
25A+60/1000R 82.5 82.5 82.5 90.1 86.2 93.8 — — — —
35A+60/600R 107.2 107.2 107.2 114.8 111.2 118.8 — — — —
35A+60/800R 107.5 107.5 107.5 115.1 111.5 119.1 — — — —
35A+60/1000R 108.2 108.2 108.2 115.8 112 119.6 — — — —
HCR
35A+60/1300R 108.5 108.5 108.5 116.1 112.3 119.8 — — — —
45A+60/800R 136.7 136.7 136.7 143.9 142.1 149.2 — — — —
45A+60/1000R 137.3 137.3 137.3 144.5 142.7 149.9 — — — —
45A+60/1200R 137.3 137.3 137.3 144.5 142.7 149.9 — — — —
45A+60/1600R 138 138 138 145.2 143.3 150.5 — — — —
65A+60/1000R 193.8 193.8 193.8 201 199.4 206.6 — — — —
65A+60/1500R 195.4 195.4 195.4 202.6 200.8 208 — — — —
65A+60/2000R 195.9 195.9 195.9 203.1 201.3 208.5 — — — —
65A+60/2500R 196.5 196.5 196.5 203.7 201.8 209 — — — —
65A+60/3000R 196.5 196.5 196.5 203.7 201.8 209 — — — —
15A 48 48 — — — — — — — —
25A 62.2 62.2 — — — — — — — —
HMG 35A 80.6 80.6 — — — — — — — —
45A 107.6 107.6 — — — — — — — —
65A 144.4 144.4 — — — — — — — —
20TBC 67 67 — — — — — — — —
25TBC 78 78 — — — — — — — —
NSR- 30TBC 90 90 — — — — — — — —
TBC 40TBC 110 110 110 — — — — — — —
50TBC 123 123 123 — — — — — — —
70TBC 150 150 150 — — — — — — —
15M1A/M1B/M1R/M1YR 59.6 59.6 59.6 — — — — — — —
20M1A/M1B/M1R/M1YR 76 76 76 — — — — — — —
20M1LA/M1LB/M1LR 92 92 92 — — — — — — —
25M1A/M1B/M1R/M1YR 83.9 83.9 83.9 — — — — — — —
HSR- M1 25M1LA/M1LB/M1LR 103 103 103 — — — — — — —
30M1A/M1B/M1R/M1YR 98.8 98.8 98.8 — — — — — — —
30M1LA/M1LB/M1LR 121.4 121.4 121.4 — — — — — — —
35M1A/M1B/M1R/M1YR 112 112 112 — — — — — — —
35M1LA/M1LB/M1LR 137.4 137.4 137.4 — — — — — — —
15M1W/M1TB 57 57 57 — — — — — — —
15M1V/M1SB 40.4 40.4 40.4 — — — — — — —
20M1W/M1TB 66.2 66.2 66.2 — — — — — — —
SR- M1
20M1V/M1SB 47.3 47.3 47.3 — — — — — — —
25M1W/M1TB 83 83 83 — — — — — — —
25M1V/M1SB 59.2 59.2 59.2 — — — — — — —
*A grease nipple cannot be attached. Contact THK for details.
Note) The standard overall length may include the dimension of the end seal depending on the model. If you are considering
using a type without an end seal, contact THK for details.
A1-489
506E
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
UU SS DD ZZ KK SSHH DDHH ZZHH KKHH
overall length
30M1W/M1TB 96.8 96.8 96.8 — — — — — — —
30M1V/M1SB 67.9 67.9 67.9 — — — — — — —
SR-M1
35M1W/M1TB 111 111 111 — — — — — — —
35M1V/M1SB 77.6 77.6 77.6 — — — — — — —
9M1K 30.8 30.8 — — — — — — — —
9M1N 41 41 — — — — — — — —
9M1WV 39 39 — — — — — — — —
9M1WN 50.7 50.7 — — — — — — — —
12M1V 35 35 — — — — — — — —
12M1N 47.7 47.7 — — — — — — — —
12M1WV 44.5 44.5 — — — — — — — —
RSR- M1
12M1WN 59.5 59.5 — — — — — — — —
15M1V 43 43 — — — — — — — —
15M1N 61 61 — — — — — — — —
15M1WV 55.5 55.5 — — — — — — — —
15M1WN 74.5 74.5 — — — — — — — —
20M1V 66.5 66.5 — — — — — — — —
20M1N 86.3 86.3 — — — — — — — —
15M2A 56.6 56.6 56.6 — — — — — — —
HSR- M2 20M2A 74 74 74 — — — — — — —
25M2A 83.1 83.1 83.1 — — — — — — —
15A/V 69.2 69.2 69.2 71.2 — — — — — —
20A/V 86.2 86.2 86.2 88.2 89.6 91.6 105.2 107.2 107.6 109.6
20LA/LV 106.2 106.2 106.2 108.2 109.6 111.6 125.2 127.2 127.6 129.6
25C/R 95.5 95.5 95.5 100.5 100.5 105.5 115.3 120.3 117.7 122.7
25LC/LR 115.1 115.1 115.1 120.1 120.1 125.1 134.9 139.9 137.3 142.3
30C/R 111 111 111 118 116 123 130.8 137.8 133.2 140.2
30LC/LR 135 135 135 142 140 147 154.8 161.8 157.2 164.2
35C/R 125 125 125 132.8 131.4 139.2 148.6 156.4 151 158.8
SRG
35LC/LR 155 155 155 162.8 161.4 169.2 178.6 186.4 181 188.8
45C/R 155 155 155 164.2 162.2 171.4 182 191.2 185.2 194.4
45LC/LR 190 190 190 199.2 197.2 206.4 217 226.2 220.2 229.4
55C/R 185 185 185 194.2 192.2 201.4 212 221.2 215.2 224.4
55LC/LR 235 235 235 244.2 242.2 251.4 262 271.2 265.2 274.4
65LC/LV 303 303 303 314.2 311.4 322.6 335.4 346.6 338.6 349.8
85LC 350 350 350 361.2 361 372.2 — — — —
100LC 395 395 395 406.2 411 422.2 — — — —
35C/R 125 125 125 132.8 131.4 139.2 148.6 156.4 151 158.8
35LC/LR 155 155 155 162.8 161.4 169.2 178.6 186.4 181 188.8
45C/R 155 155 155 164.2 162.2 171.4 182 191.2 185.2 194.4
SRN 45LC/LR 190 190 190 199.2 197.2 206.4 217 226.2 220.2 229.4
55C/R 185 185 185 194.2 192.2 201.4 212 221.2 215.2 224.4
55LC/LR 235 235 235 244.2 242.2 251.4 262 271.2 265.2 274.4
65LC/LR 303 303 303 314.2 311.4 322.6 335.4 346.6 338.6 349.8
70LR 190 190 190 199.2 197.2 206.4 217 226.2 220.2 229.4
85LR 235 235 235 244.2 242.2 251.4 262 271.2 265.2 274.4
SRW 100LR 303 303 303 314.2 311.4 322.6 335.4 346.6 338.6 349.8
130LR 350 350 350 361.2 361 372.2 — — — —
150LR 395 395 395 406.2 411 422.2 — — — —
Note) The standard overall length may include the dimension of the end seal depending on the model. If you are considering
using a type without an end seal, contact THK for details.
A1-490
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
UU SS DD ZZ KK SSHH DDHH JJHH TTHH
overall length
25R/C 82.8 82.8 82.8 88 88.5 93.7 96.8* 102.0* 102.5* 107.7*
25LR/LC 102 102 102 107.2 107.7 112.9 116.0* 121.2* 121.7* 126.9*
30R/C 98 98 98 104.6 103.7 110.3 115.2* 121.8* 120.9* 127.5*
30LR/LC 120.5 120.5 120.5 127.1 126.2 132.8 137.7* 144.3* 143.4* 150.0*
LM Guide (Options)
35R/C/RH/CH 109.5 109.5 109.5 116.5 116.3 123.3 126.7* 133.7* 133.5* 140.5*
SVR/ 35LR/LC/LRH/LCH 135 135 135 142 141.8 148.8 152.2* 159.2* 159.0* 166.0*
SVS 45R/C/RH/CH 138.2 138.2 138.2 145.2 145.8 152.8 158.2* 165.2* 165.8* 172.8*
45LR/LC/LRH/LCH 171 171 171 178 178.6 185.6 191.0* 198.0* 198.6* 205.6*
55R/C/RH/CH 163.3 163.3 163.3 168.4 169.0 176.0 182.4* 189.4* 191.1* 198.1*
55LR/LC/LRH/LCH 200.5 200.5 200.5 205.6 206.2 213.2 219.6* 226.6* 228.3* 235.3*
65R/C 186 186 186 191.8 193.1 200.5 208.8* 216.2* 217.5* 224.9*
65LR/LC 246 246 246 251.8 253.1 260.5 268.8* 276.2* 277.5* 284.9*
*The overall LM block length (L) of YY type (with side scraper) is also the same.
Note1) The standard overall length may include the dimension of the end seal depending on the model. If you are considering using
a type without an end seal, contact THK for details.
Note2) For models SVR/SVS, we recommend attaching a protector. For the dimensions of ZZHH and KKHH, contact THK.
For details of the symbols of options, see A1-510.
(*1) See A1-502. (*2) See A1-510. (*3) See A1-70. (*4) See A1-76. (*5) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
A1-491
506E
K : Reference surface E
A1-492
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
Unit: mm
Incremental dimension with grease nipple
Model No. Nipple type
H
25A/B/LA/LB — PB1021B
25R/LR 4.8 PB1021B
30A/B/LA/LB — PB1021B
30R/LR 4.5 PB1021B
35A/B/LA/LB — A-M6F
LM Guide (Options)
35R/LR 7.4 A-M6F
NR/NRS
45A/B/LA/LB — A-M6F
45R/LR 7.4 A-M6F
55A/B/LA/LB — A-M6F
55R/LR 6.9 A-M6F
65A/B/LA/LB — A-PT1/8
65R/LR 15.3 A-PT1/8
35LC — A-M6F
35LR 7.2 A-M6F
45LC — A-M6F
45LR 7.2 A-M6F
SRG
55LC — A-M6F
55LR 7.2 A-M6F
65LC — A-M6F
65LR 6.2 A-M6F
* The incremental dimension of the grease nipple when the side scraper and the protector are attached (SVR/SVS only) is
also the same.
A1-493
506E
Unit: mm
Incremental dimension with grease nipple
Model No. Nipple type
E
21CA/CR 4.2 PB1021B
27CA/CR 10.7 B-M6F
SHW
35CA/CR 10 B-M6F
50CA/CR 21 B-PT1/8
SRS 25 4 PB1021B
15A/B/R/YR 2.9 PB1021B
20A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 9.4 B-M6F
20LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 9.4 B-M6F
25A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 9 B-M6F
HSR 25LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 9 B-M6F
30A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 9 B-M6F
30LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 9 B-M6F
35A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 8 B-M6F
35LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 8 B-M6F
Note1) When desiring the mounting location for the grease nipple other than the above, contact THK.
Note2) Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple. When desiring both QZ Lubricator and a
grease nipple, contact THK.
Note3) When desiring a grease nipple for model SHW or SRS without QZ Lubricator, indicate “with grease nipple” when plac-
ing an order. (If not, a grease nipple will not be attached.)
Note4) Model HSR15 attached with ZZ or KK cannot have a grease nipple. Contact THK for details.
A1-494
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
L
Overall LM block length with LiCS attached
LM Guide (Options)
Unit: mm
L
Model No.
Standard overall length GG PP
15XVY 40.3 48.7 48.7
15XWY/XTBY 56.9 65.3 65.3
20XV 47.7 55.8 55.8
20XW/XTB 66.5 74.6 74.6
SSR
25XVY 60 67.6 67.6
25XWY/XTBY 83 90.6 90.6
30XW 97 106.7 106.7
35XW 110.9 121.7 121.7
15A 67 77 77
SRG
15V 67 77 77
SSR20 XW 2 GG C1 +600L P T -Ⅱ
Model Type of With LiCS LM rail length Symbol Symbol for No. of rails used on
number LM block (*1) (in mm) for LM rail the same plane (*4)
Radial clearance jointed use
No. of LM blocks symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P) /Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See A1-483 (*2) See A1-70 (*3) See A1-76 (*4) SeeA1-13
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
A1-495
506E
E K : Reference
surface
LiCS Endplate LiCS Endplate
Unit: mm
Incremental dimension with grease nipple
Model No. Nipple type
E H
15XVY 2.9 — PB1021B
15XWY/XTBY 2.9 — PB1021B
20XV 9 — B-M6F
20XW/XTB 9 — B-M6F
SSR
25XVY 9 — B-M6F
25XWY/XTBY 9 — B-M6F
30XW 9 — B-M6F
35XW 8 — B-M6F
15A — —* PB107
SRG
15V — 4.5 PB107
* Because this model features a flange, it projects beyond the block end surface.
SSR20 XW 2 GG C1 +600L H -Ⅱ
Model Type of With LiCS LM rail length Symbol for No. of rails
number LM block (*1) (in mm) used on the same plane (*4)
Radial clearance
No. of LM blocks symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Normal (No symbol) Normal grade (No Symbol)
used on the same rail Light preload (C1) High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
Medium preload (C0) Super precision grade (SP)/Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See A1-483 (*2) See A1-70 (*3) See A1-76 (*4) SeeA1-13
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
A1-496
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
LM Guide (Options)
15 4.5 5M 0.06
UU
20 7.0 5WM 0.08
25 10.5 7M 0.16
30 17.0 7WM 0.52
SHS SS
35 20.5 9XS 0.15
45 30.0 9XM 0.2
55 31.5 9XN 0.3
65 43.0 9WM 1.0
15X 2.0 9WN 1.0
20X 2.6 SRS 12M 0.6
SSR 25X UU 3.5 12N SS 0.6
30X 4.9 12WM 1.3
35X 6.3 12WN 1.4
25 10 15M 1.0
30 14 15N 1.1
35 18 15WM 1.6
SVR/SVS SS
45 22 15WN 1.6
55 26 20M 1.3
65 31 25M 1.6
12CA/CR 1.0 15 2.5
12HR 1.0 20 3
14 1.2 25 5
17 1.4 SCR 30 UU 10
UU
21 4.9 35 12
27 4.9 45 20
35 9.8 65 30
50 14.7
SHW
12CA/CR 1.4
12HR 1.8
14 1.8
17 2.2
SS
21 6.9
27 8.9
35 15.8
50 22.7
A1-497
506E
Unit: N Unit: N
Seal Maximum Seal Seal Maximum Seal
Model No. Model No.
symbol Resistance symbol Resistance
8 0.5 5 0.06
10 0.8 7 0.08
12 1.2 9 0.1
15 2.0 12 0.4
20 2.5 15 0.8
25 3.9 20 1.0
HSR UU
30 7.8 3W 0.2
35 11.8 5W 0.3
45 19.6 7W 0.4
55 19.6 9W 0.8
65 34.3 RSR 12W UU 1.1
85 34.3 14W 1.2
15 2.5 15W 1.3
20 3.4 7Z 0.08
25 4.4 9Z 0.1
30 8.8 12Z 0.4
SR UU
35 11.8 15Z 0.8
45 12.7 7WZ 0.4
55 15.7 9WZ 0.8
70 19.6 12WZ 1.1
25X 15 15WZ 1.3
30 17 918 0.5
35 23 1123 0.7
45 24 1530 1.0
NR/NRS 55 UU 29 2042 2.0
65 42 2555 2.9
HR UU
75 42 3065 3.4
85 42 3575 3.9
100 51 4085 4.4
12 0.2 50105 5.9
14 0.3 60125 9.8
17 2.9
21 4.9
HRW UU
27 4.9
35 9.8
50 14.7
60 19.6
A1-498
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
Unit: N Unit: N
Seal Maximum Seal Seal Maximum Seal
Model No. Model No.
symbol Resistance symbol Resistance
15 2.5 15M1 2.5
20 3.1 20M1 3.4
25 4.4 SR 25M1 UU 4.4
30 6.3 30M1 8.8
LM Guide (Options)
GSR UU
35 7.6 35M1 11.8
25-R 4.4 9M1 0.1
30-R 6.3 12M1 0.4
35-R 7.6 15M1 0.8
15 2.0 RSR 20M1 UU 1.0
20 2.5 9M1W 0.8
25 3.9 12M1W 1.1
CSR UU
30 7.8 15M1W 1.3
35 11.8 15M2 2.0
45 19.6 HSR 20M2 UU 2.5
5 0.06 25M2 3.9
MX UU
7W 0.4 15 13
25 3.9 20 18
35 11.8 25 19
JR UU
45 19.6 30 22
55 19.6 35 30
SRG SS
12 1.2 45 30
15 2.0 55 34
25 3.9 65 40
HCR UU
35 11.8 85 47
45 19.6 100 53
65 34.3 35 30
15 3 45 30
SRN SS
25 6 55 35
HMG 35 UU 8 65 40
45 12 70 32
65 40 85 37
20TBC 4.9 SRW 100 SS 43
25TBC 4.9 130 50
30TBC 6.9 150 57
NSR UU
40TBC 9.8
50TBC 14.7
70TBC 24.5
15M1 2.0
20M1 2.5
HSR 25M1 UU 3.9
30M1 7.8
35M1 11.8
A1-499
506E
A1-500
506E
Options
Dimensions of Each Model with an Option Attached
LM Guide (Options)
20X 1.1
SSR 25X 1.6
30X 1.6
35X 2
SRG 15 0.7
Note) The value indicates the sliding resistance of two LiCS
units per LM block and does not include the sliding
resistances of the LM block and the side seals.
A1-501
506E
QZ Lubricator
●For the supported models, see the table of options by model number on A1-474.
●For the LM block dimension with QZ attached, see A1-505 to A1-508.
●For notes regarding how to handle the QZ, see A1-546.
QZ Lubricator feeds the right amount of lubricant to the raceway on the LM rail. This allows an oil
film to continuously be formed between the rolling element and the raceway, and drastically extends
the lubrication and maintenance intervals.
The structure of QZ Lubricator consists of three major components: (1) a heavy oil-impregnated fiber
net (function to store lubricant), (2) a high-density fiber net (function to apply lubricant to the race-
way) and (3) an oil-control plate (function to adjust oil flow). The lubricant contained in QZ Lubricator
is fed by the capillary phenomenon, which is used also in felt pens and many other products, as the
fundamental principle.
Case (2) High-density fiber net
(1) Heavy oil-impregnated fiber net
(End seal) Ball
QZ Lubricator
[Features]
● Since it supplements an oil loss, the lubrication maintenance interval can be significantly extended.
● Eco-friendly lubrication system that does not contaminate the surrounding area since it feeds the
right amount of lubricant to the ball raceway.
A1-502
506E
Options
QZ Lubricator
LM Guide: HSR35R1SS
Calculated service life of heavy load = 400 km
Condition Heavy load Medium load Light load
Grease lubrication only 465km Load 18.6kN 9.3kN 1.4kN
Heavy load
LM Guide (Options)
Speed 50m/min 50m/min 300m/min
Grease + QZ Lubricator 962km Calculated service life 400km 3200km
Grease: 2cc/1 LM block - initial lubrication only
QZ Lubricator: 5cc ×2/1 LM block - initial lubrication only
Light Medium
load
Grease + QZ Lubricator
Comparison of 0.332
SHW21QZ
lubricant
consumption
after traveling
5,000 km Forced lubrication 83.3
0 20 40 60 80 100
A1-503
506E
A1-504
506E
Options
QZ Lubricator
L
Overall LM block length with QZ attached
LM Guide (Options)
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
QZUU QZSS QZDD QZZZ QZKK QZSSHH QZDDHH QZZZHH QZKKHH
overall length
15C/V/R 64.4 84.4 84.4 89.8 86.8 92.2 100 105.4 101.2 106.6
15LC/LV 79.4 99.4 99.4 104.8 101.8 107.2 115 120.4 116.2 121.6
20C/V 79 99 99 105.4 103 109.4 115.4 121.8 117.8 124.2
20LC/LV 98 118 118 124.4 122 128.4 134.4 140.8 136.8 143.2
25C/V/R 92 114.4 114.4 121.6 120.4 127.6 132 139.2 134.4 141.6
25LC/LV/LR 109 131.4 131.4 138.6 137.4 144.6 149 156.2 151.4 158.6
30C/V/R 106 127.4 127.4 136 133.8 142.4 149.4 158 151.8 160.4
30LC/LV/LR 131 152.4 152.4 161 158.8 167.4 174.4 183 176.8 185.4
SHS
35C/V/R 122 145 145 154.8 152.4 162.2 168 177.8 170.4 180.2
35LC/LV/LR 152 175 175 184.8 182.4 192.2 198 207.8 200.4 210.2
45C/V/R 140 173 173 182.8 181.2 191 199 208.8 202.2 212
45LC/LV/LR 174 207 207 216.8 215.2 225 233 242.8 236.2 246
55C/V/R 171 205.4 205.4 216.6 214.2 225.4 232 243.2 235.2 246.4
55LC/LV/LR 213 247.4 247.4 258.6 256.2 267.4 274 285.2 277.2 288.4
65C/V 221 256.2 256.2 268.6 266.2 278.6 288 300.4 291.2 303.6
65LC/LV 272 307.2 307.2 319.6 317.2 329.6 339 351.4 342.2 354.6
15XVY 40.3 59.3 59.3 65.1 62.7 68.5 75.5 81.3 76.7 82.5
15XWY/XTBY 56.9 75.9 75.9 81.7 79.3 85.1 92.1 97.9 93.3 99.1
20XV 47.7 66.2 66.2 73.1 72.1 79 83.7 90.6 86.1 93
20XW/XTB 66.5 85 85 91.9 90.9 97.8 102.5 109.4 104.9 111.8
SSR
25XVY 60 82.6 82.6 90 88.4 95.8 100 107.4 102.4 109.8
25XWY/XTBY 83 105.6 105.6 113 111.4 118.8 123 130.4 125.4 132.8
30XW 97 119.7 119.7 127.8 125.4 133.5 141 149.1 143.4 151.5
35XW 110.9 134.3 134.3 143.3 141.3 150.3 156.9 165.9 159.3 168.3
12CAM/CRM 37 47 47 — — — 58 — — —
12HRM 50.4 60.4 60.4 — — — 71.4 — — —
14CAM/CRM 45.5 55.5 55.5 — — — 70.7 — — —
17CAM/CRM 51 63 63 66 65.4 68.4 78.2 81.2 79.4 82.4
SHW
21CA/CR 59 75 75 80 78.6 83.6 91.6 96.6 93.2 98.2
27CA/CR 72.8 92.8 92.8 98.6 97.2 103 109.4 115.2 111.8 117.6
35CA/CR 107 127 127 134.4 132 139.4 149 156.4 151.4 158.8
50CA/CR 141 161 161 169.2 167.4 175.6 186 194.2 188.4 196.6
A1-505
506E
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
QZUU QZSS QZDD QZZZ QZKK QZSSHH QZDDHH QZZZHH QZKKHH
overall length
7 23.4 33.4 33.4 — — — — — — —
7W 31 41 41 — — — — — — —
9XS 21.5 31.5 31.5 — — — 43.1 — — —
9XM 30.8 40.8 40.8 — — — 52.4 — — —
9XN 40.8 50.8 50.8 — — — 62.4 — — —
9W 39 49 49 — — — 60.6 — — —
9WN 50.7 60.7 60.7 — — — 72.3 — — —
12 34.4 44.4 44.4 — — — 56 — — —
SRS 12N 47.1 57.1 57.1 — — — 69.1 — — —
12W 44.5 54.5 54.5 — — — 66.1 — — —
12WN 59.5 69.5 69.5 — — — 81.1 — — —
15 43 55 55 — — — 69.2 — — —
15N 60.8 72.8 72.8 — — — 87 — — —
15W 55.5 67.5 67.5 — — — 81.7 — — —
15WN 74.5 86.5 86.5 — — — 100.9 — — —
20 50 66 66 — — — 81.2 — — —
25 77 97 97 — — — 112.6 — — —
15S 64.4 84.4 84.4 89.8 86.8 92.2 100.4 105.4 101.4 106.9
20S 79 99 99 105.4 103 109.4 115.5 122 118 124.5
20 98 118 118 124.4 122 128.4 134.5 141 137 143.5
25 109 131.4 131.4 138.6 137.4 144.6 149 156.2 151.4 158.6
SCR
30 131 152.4 152.4 161 158.8 167.4 174.4 183 176.8 185.4
35 152 175 175 184.8 182.4 192.2 198 207.8 200.4 210.2
45 174 207 207 216.8 215.2 225 233 242.8 236.2 246
65 272 307.2 307.2 319.6 317.2 329.6 339 351.4 342.2 354.6
15A/B/R/YR 56.6 79.6 79.6 87.6 84.2 92.2 98.8 106.8 100 108
20A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 74 96.2 96.2 104.4 102 110.2 113.6 121.8 116 124.2
20LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 90 112.2 112.2 120.4 118 126.2 129.6 137.8 132 140.2
25A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 83.1 104.1 104.1 112.1 109.8 117.8 121.4 129.4 123.8 131.8
25LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 102.2 123.2 123.2 131.2 128.9 136.9 140.5 148.5 142.9 150.9
30A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 98 119 119 127 124.7 132.7 140.3 148.3 142.7 150.7
30LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 120.6 141.6 141.6 149.6 147.3 155.3 162.9 170.9 165.3 173.3
HSR 35A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 109.4 132.2 132.2 142 139 148.8 154.6 164.4 157 166.8
35LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 134.8 157.6 157.6 167.4 164.4 174.2 180 189.8 182.4 192.2
45A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 139 174.8 174.8 181.6 176.6 186.4 — — — —
45LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 170.8 206.6 206.6 213.4 208.4 218.2 — — — —
55A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 163 197.2 197.2 208.4 202 213.2 — — — —
55LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 201.1 235.3 235.3 246.5 240.1 251.3 — — — —
65A/B/R/CA/CB/YR 186 221.4 221.4 233.8 226.6 239 — — — —
65LA/LB/LR/HA/HB 245.5 280.9 280.9 293.3 286.1 298.5 — — — —
25XR/XA/XB 82.8 105.2 105.2 112.8 110.9 118.5 122.5 130.1 124.9 132.5
25XLR/XLA/XLB 102 124.4 124.4 132 130.1 137.7 141.7 149.3 144.1 151.7
30R/A/B 98 120.4 120.4 129.4 126.1 135.1 141.7 150.7 144.1 153.1
30LR/LA/LB 120.5 142.9 142.9 151.9 148.6 157.6 164.2 173.2 166.6 175.6
35R/A/B 109.5 142.7 142.7 152.9 149.5 159.7 164.3 174.5 166.7 176.9
NR/ 35LR/LA/LB 135 168.2 168.2 178.4 175 185.2 189.8 200 192.2 202.4
NRS 45R/A/B 139 172.2 172.2 182.4 179.8 190 197.6 207.8 200.8 211
45LR/LA/LB 171 204.2 204.2 214.4 211.8 222 229.6 239.8 232.8 243
55R/A/B 162.8 204.8 204.8 215 213.5 223.7 231.3 241.5 234.5 244.7
55LR/LA/LB 200 242 242 252.2 250.7 260.9 268.5 278.7 271.7 281.9
65R/A/B 185.6 227.6 227.6 238.2 236.3 246.9 258.1 268.7 261.3 271.9
65LR/LA/LB 245.6 287.6 287.6 298.2 296.3 306.9 318.1 328.7 321.3 331.9
A1-506
506E
Options
QZ Lubricator
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
QZUU QZSS QZDD QZZZ QZKK QZSSHH QZDDHH QZZZHH QZKKHH
overall length
9KM 30.8 40.8 — — — — — — — —
9N 40.8 50.8 — — — — — — — —
9WVM 39 49 — — — — — — — —
9WN 50.7 60.7 — — — — — — — —
LM Guide (Options)
12VM 35 45 — — — — — — — —
12N 47.7 57.7 — — — — — — — —
RSR
12WV/WVM 44.5 54.5 — — — — — — — —
12WN 59.5 69.5 — — — — — — — —
15VM 42.9 54.9 — — — — — — — —
15N 60.7 72.7 — — — — — — — —
15WV/VM 55.5 67.5 — — — — — — — —
15WN 74.5 86.5 — — — — — — — —
15A/V 69.2 90.6 90.6 92.6 — — — — — —
20A/V 86.2 107.6 107.6 109.6 111 113 125.2 127.2 127.6 129.6
20LA/LV 106.2 127.6 127.6 129.6 131 133 145.2 147.2 147.6 149.6
25C/R 95.5 125.5 125.5 130.5 130.5 135.5 145.3 151.7 147.7 154.1
25LC/LR 115.1 145.1 145.1 150.1 150.1 155.1 164.9 171.3 167.3 173.7
30C/R 111 141 141 148 146 153 160.8 169.2 164.6 171.6
30LC/LR 135 165 165 172 170 177 184.8 193.2 188.6 195.6
SRG
35C/R 125 155 155 162.8 163.4 171.2 178.6 186.4 181 188.8
35LC/LR 155 185 185 192.8 193.4 201.2 208.6 216.4 211 218.8
45C/R 155 185 185 194.2 194.2 203.4 212 221.2 215.2 224.4
45LC/LR 190 220 220 229.2 229.2 238.4 247 256.2 250.2 259.4
55C/R 185 225 225 234.2 234.2 243.4 252 261.2 255.2 264.4
55LC/LR 235 275 275 284.2 284.2 293.4 302 311.2 305.2 314.4
65LC/LV 303 343 343 354.2 354.2 370.4 380.4 391.6 378.6 389.8
35C/R 125 155 155 162.8 163.4 171.2 178.6 186.4 181 188.8
35LC/LR 155 185 185 192.8 193.4 201.2 208.6 216.4 211 218.8
45C/R 155 185 185 194.2 194.2 203.4 212 221.2 215.2 224.5
SRN 45LC/LR 190 220 220 229.2 229.2 238.4 247 256.2 250.2 259.4
55C/R 185 225 225 234.2 234.2 243.4 252 261.2 255.2 264.4
55LC/LR 235 275 275 284.2 284.2 293.4 302 311.2 305.2 314.4
65LC/LR 303 343 343 354.2 354.2 370.4 380.4 391.6 378.6 389.8
70 190 220 220 229.2 229.2 238.4 247 256.2 250.2 259.4
SRW 85 235 275 275 284.2 284.2 293.4 302 311.2 305.2 314.4
100 303 343 343 354.2 354.2 370.4 380.4 391.6 378.6 389.8
A1-507
506E
Unit: mm
L
Model No. Standard
QZUU QZSS QZDD QZZZ QZKK QZSSHH QZDDHH QZJJHH QZTTHH
overall length
25R/C 82.8 102.8 102.8 108 108.5 113.7 116.8 122.0 122.5* 127.7*
25LR/LC 102 122 122 127.2 127.7 132.9 136.0 141.2 141.7* 146.9*
30R/C 98 118 118 124.6 123.7 130.3 135.2 141.8 140.9* 147.5*
30LR/LC 120.5 140.5 140.5 147.1 146.2 152.8 157.7 164.3 163.4* 170.0*
35R/C/RH/CH 109.5 139.5 139.5 146.5 146.3 153.3 156.7 163.7 163.5* 170.5*
SVR/ 35LR/LC/LRH/LCH 135 165 165 172 171.8 178.8 182.2 189.2 189.0* 196.0*
SVS 45R/C/RH/CH 138.2 168.2 168.2 175.2 175.8 182.8 188.2 195.2 195.8* 202.8*
45LR/LC/LRH/LCH 171 201 201 208 208.6 215.6 221.0 228.0 228.6* 235.6*
55R/C/RH/CH 163.3 201.4 201.4 208.4 209.0 216.0 222.4 229.4 231.1* 238.1*
55LR/LC/LRH/LCH 200.5 238.6 238.6 245.6 246.2 253.2 259.6 266.6 268.3* 275.3*
65R/C 186 224.4 224.4 231.8 233.1 240.5 248.8 256.2 257.5* 264.9*
65LR/LC 246 284.4 284.4 291.8 293.1 300.5 308.8 316.2 317.5* 324.9*
* The overall LM block length (L) of YY type (with side scraper) is also the same.
Note) For models SVR/SVS, we recommend attaching a protector. For the dimensions of QZZZHH and QZKKHH, contact
THK. For details of the symbols of options, see A1-510.
(*1) See A1-502. (*2) See A1-510. (*3) See A1-70. (*4) See A1-76. (*5) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
A1-508
506E
Options
QZ Lubricator
LM Guide (Options)
A1-509
506E
A1-510
506E
Options
List of Parts Symbols
QZZZHH
Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS
(see A1-479 )
LM Guide (Options)
(see A1-478 ) Inner seal (see A1-478 )
QZ Lubricator (see A1-502 )
End seal (see A1-478 )
Double seal (see A1-478 )
UU SS DD
ZZ KK
QZPP QZTTHHYY
A1-511
506E
Dedicated Bellows
●For the supported models, see the table of options by model number on A1-474.
●For the dedicated bellows dimensions, see A1-513 to A1-524.
Bellows
A1-512
506E
Options
Dedicated Bellows
Bellows
[Dedicated Bellows JSH for Model SHS]
The table below shows the dimensions of dedicated bellows JSH for model SHS. Specify the corre-
sponding model number of the desired bellows from the table.
W Lmax W W
Lmin
LM Guide (Options)
b b1 S Rubber seat Intermediate plate
a
P t1
H H1 H1
t4 t2
t3
P Mounting plate Mounting plate S1 S1 b2
Models SHS15 to 30 Models SHS35 to 65
Unit: mm
Main dimensions Supported
Model No. t1 model
W H H1 P b1 C V R b2 t2 t3 t4 numbers
15 53 26 26 15 22.4 4 4 8 — — 8 — 15
20 60 30 30 17 27.6 7.5 7.5 — — — 8 6 20
25 75 36 36 20 38 9.1 9.1 13.1 — — 9 7 25
30 80 38 38 20 44 11 11 14 — — 11 8 30
JSH SHS
35 86 40.5 40.5 20 50 11 11 18 20 21.5 — — 35
45 97 46 46 20 64.6 13.5 13.5 23.5 26 26.5 — — 45
55 105 48 48 20 68 13 13 23 30 31.5 — — 55
65 126 63 63 25 80 18 18 — 34 45 — — 65
Unit: mm
A1-513
506E
a
P t1
H H1 H1
t4 t2
t3
P S
b2
A1-514
506E
Options
Dedicated Bellows
LM Guide (Options)
P1
H t1 H1
t2
P2 S1 b2
Unit: mm
Main dimensions Supported
Model No. model
W H H1 P1 P2 b1 t1 b2 t2 numbers
17 68 22 23 15 15.4 39 2.6 18 6 17
21 75 25 26 17 17 35.8 2.9 22 7 21
JSHW 27 85 33.5 33.5 20 20 25 3.5 20 10 SHW 27
35 120 35 35 20 20 75 7.5 40 13 35
50 164 42 42 20 20 89.4 14 50 16 50
Unit: mm
Other dimensions
A
Mounting bolt a b Lmax
Model No.
* Model Model Lmin
S S1
CA CR
17 M2×4 ℓ M3×6 ℓ 8 4 9 5
21 M2×5 ℓ M3×6 ℓ 8 3.5 10.5 6
JSHW 27 M2.6×6 ℓ M3×6 ℓ 10 2.5 11.5 7
35 M3×8 ℓ M3×6 ℓ 6 0 10 7
50 M4×12 ℓ M4×8 ℓ — 1 17 7
Note1) When desiring to use the dedicated bellows other than in horizontal mount (i.e., vertical, wall and inverted mount), or
when desiring a heat-resistant type of bellows, contact THK.
Note2) For lubrication when using the dedicated bellows, contact THK.
Note3) For the mounting bolts marked with “*”, use tapping screws.
Note4) When using the dedicated bellows, the LM block and LM rail need to be machined so that the bellows can be mount-
ed. Be sure to indicate that the dedicated bellows is required when ordering the LM Guide.
A1-515
506E
A1-516
506E
Options
Dedicated Bellows
Features
(1) Has a width and height smaller than the conventional product so that any part of the bellows
LM Guide (Options)
does not stick out of the top face of the LM block. The extension rate is equal to or greater than
that of the conventional type.
(2) Has an intermediate plate for each crest so that it will not easily lift and the bellows can be used
with vertical mount, wall mount and slant mount.
(3) Operable at high speed, at up to 120 m/min.
(4) Since a Velcro tape can be used to install the bellows, a regular-size model can be cut to the de-
sired length, or two or more regular-size bellows can be taped together.
(5) Can be installed using screws just as bellows JH.
In this case, a plate (thickness: 1.6 mm) must be placed between the bellows and the LM bock.
Contact THK for details.
W Velcro ℓmax Velcro W
b b1 d ℓmin S
a
P t1
H H
t4
t3
P
Intermediate plate Secured with an adhesive or screw
Unit: mm
Main dimensions
Exten- Supported
Model
t1 a b
sion Factor model
No.
rate numbers
W H P b1 A/B R t3 t4 d s A/B R A/B R ℓmax ℓmin A E k
15 35 19.5 8.5 25 2.5 6.5 10 — 2.5 5 0 4 6 –0.5 10 2.5 4 2 1.2 15
DH 20 45 25 10 34 5 5 6 8 4 4 0 0 9 –0.5 13 2.5 5 2 1.3 HSR 20
25 52 29.5 12 30 7 11 10 8 3.5 3.5 0 4 9 –2 15 3 5 2 1.3 25
Note1) For lubrication when using the dedicated bellows, contact THK.
Note2) When using the dedicated bellows, the LM block and LM rail need to be machined so that the bellows can be mount-
ed. Be sure to indicate that the dedicated bellows is required when ordering the LM Guide.
Model number coding Note) The maximum length of the bellows itself
is calculated as follows.
DH20 - 50/250 Lmax(Lmin)= ℓmax(ℓmim)×200
Example of calculating bellows dimensions:
Model number of Dimensions of the bellows
bellows for HSR20 (length when compressed When the stroke of model HSR20 is: ℓs=530mm
/ length when extended) ℓs 530
Lmin = = = 132.5 ≒ 135
(A– 1) 4
Lmax = A•Lmin = 5× 135 = 675
Number of required crests n
Lmax 675
n = = = 51.9 ≒ 52 crests
P•k 10×1.3
Lmin = n•ℓmin+E = 52×2.5+2 =132
A1-517
506E
b W Lmax W W
S b1 a Lmin
P
H t1
H1 H1
t4 t2
P t3
S S b2
A1-518
506E
Options
Dedicated Bellows
Features
(1) Has a width and height smaller than the conventional product so that any part of the bellows
LM Guide (Options)
does not stick out of the top face of the LM block. The extension rate is equal to or greater than
that of the conventional type.
(2) Has an intermediate plate for each crest so that it will not easily lift and the bellows can be used
with vertical mount, wall mount and slant mount.
(3) Operable at high speed, at up to 120 m/min.
(4) Since a Velcro tape can be used to install the bellows, a regular-size model can be cut to the de-
sired length, or two or more regular-size bellows can be taped together.
(5) Can be installed using screws just as the conventional type.
In this case, a plate (thickness: 1.6 mm) must be placed between the bellows and the LM bock.
Contact THK for details.
W W
b b1 d a Velcro ℓmax Velcro
ℓmin d
P t1
H H
t4
t3
P Intermediate plate Secured with an adhesive or screw
Unit: mm
Main dimensions
Supported
Model Extension
b Factor model
No. rate
numbers
W H P b1 t1 t3 t4 d a W/V TB/SB ℓmax ℓmin A E k
15 38 19 10 22 3.4 8 — 3.5 0 7 2 13 2.5 5 2 1.3 15
DS 20 49 22 10 25 4.2 6 6 4 0 5 3.5 13 2.5 5 2 1.3 SR 20
25 56 26 12 29 5 6 7 4 0 8.5 4 15 3 5 2 1.3 25
Note1) For lubrication when using the dedicated bellows, contact THK.
Note2) When using the dedicated bellows, the LM block and LM rail need to be machined so that the bellows can be mount-
ed. Be sure to indicate that the dedicated bellows is required when ordering the LM Guide.
Model number coding Note) The maximum length of the bellows itself is
calculated as follows.
DS20 - 50/250 Lmax(Lmin)= ℓmax(ℓmin)×200
Model number of Dimensions of the bellows Example of calculating bellows dimensions:
bellows for SR20 (length when compressed When the stroke of model SR20 is: ℓs=530mm
/ length when extended) ℓs 530
Lmin = = = 132.5 ≒ 135
(A– 1) 4
Lmax = A•Lmin = 5× 135 = 675
Number of required crests n
Lmax 675
n = = = 51.9 ≒ 52 crests
P•k 10×1.3
Lmin = n•ℓmin+E = 52×2.5+2 =132
(E indicates the plate thickness of 2)
Therefore, the model number of the required
bellows is DS20-132/675.
A1-519
506E
Main dimensions
A Supported
Model b Lmax
Mounting bolt model
No. A,LA Lmin numbers
W H H1 P b1 t1 t2 t3 S S1 B,LB T
25 48 25.5 25.5 10 26.6 4.6 13 — M3×5 ℓ M4×4 ℓ 11 1.5 7 25X
30 60 31 31 14 34 5.5 17 — M4×8 ℓ M4×4 ℓ 15 1.5 9 30
35 70 35 35 15 36 6 20.5 — M4×8 ℓ M5×4 ℓ 15 2 10 35
45 86 40.5 40.5 17 47 6.5 24 — M5×10 ℓ M5×4 ℓ 17 2 10 45
NR/
JN 55 100 49 49 20 54 10 29.5 18 M5×10 ℓ M5×4 ℓ 20 2 13 55
NRS
65 126 57.5 57.5 20 64 13.5 36.2 20 M6×12 ℓ M6×5 ℓ 22 3.2 13 65
75 145 64 64 30 80 10.5 34.2 26 M6×12 ℓ M6×5 ℓ 25 3.2 20 75
85 156 70.5 70.5 30 110 15.5 39.5 28 M6×12 ℓ M6×5 ℓ 39.5 3.2 20 85
100 200 82 82 30 140 15 40 34 M8×16 ℓ M6×5 ℓ 30 3.2 20 100
Note1) When desiring to use the bellows other than in horizontal mount (i.e., vertical, wall and inverted mount), or when desir-
ing a heat-resistant type of bellows, contact THK.
Note2) For lubrication when using the bellows, contact THK.
Note3) When using the bellows, the LM block and LM rail need to be machined so that the bellows can be mounted. Be sure
to indicate that the bellows is required when ordering the LM Guide.
Base
A1-520
506E
Options
Dedicated Bellows
LM Guide (Options)
H H1
t2
S b2
P
Unit: mm
Main dimensions
A Supported
Model No. Mounting b Lmax model
bolt Model Model Lmin numbers
W H H1 P b1 t1 b2 t2 a
S CA CR
17 68 22 23 15 43 3 18 6 *
M3×6 ℓ 8 4 9 5 17
21 75 25 26 17 48 3 22 7 M3×6ℓ 8 3.5 10.5 6 21
JHRW 27 85 33.5 33.5 20 48 3 20 10 M3×6ℓ 10 2.5 11.5 7 HRW 27
35 120 35 35 20 75 3.5 40 13 M3×6ℓ 6 0 10 7 35
50 164 42 42 20 100 9 50 16 M4×8ℓ –3 1 17 7 50
Note1) For model JHRW17’s location marked with “*”, mounting bolts are used only on the LM rail side while the LM block
side uses M2.5 x 8 (nominal) tapping screws.
Note2) When desiring to use the dedicated bellows other than in horizontal mount (i.e., vertical, wall and inverted mount), or
when desiring a heat-resistant type of bellows, contact THK.
Note3) For lubrication when using the dedicated bellows, contact THK.
Note4) When using the dedicated bellows, the LM block and LM rail need to be machined so that the bellows can be mount-
ed. Be sure to indicate that the dedicated bellows is required when ordering the LM Guide.
A1-521
506E
W Lmax W W
b1 Lmin
S
a
t1 b2 S S
P
H H1 H1
t4
t2 t3
P
A1-522
506E
Options
Dedicated Bellows
b W Lmax W W
b1 S a Lmin
t1
p
LM Guide (Options)
H H1 H1
t4
t3 t2
P S1 b2 S1
Models SRG15 and 30 Models SRG35 to 100
Unit: mm
Main dimensions
A Supported
Model Screw Mounting Lmax
t1 a b model
No. size bolt Lmin numbers
W H H1 P p b1 A/C R/V b2 t2 t3 t4 S S1 A/C R/V A/C R/V
15 55 27 27 14.2 12.7 28 10.3 10.3 — — 10.6 — M2 M4 7 7 4 10.5 5 15
20 66 32 32 17 15 38.5 9.6 9.6 — — 7.4 8 M2 M3 6.6 6.6 1.5 11 6 20
25 78 38 38 23 18 27.6 3.9 7.9 — — 10 8 M2 M3×6ℓ –6.5 –2.5 4 15 6 25
30 84 42 42 22 19 37.4 10.4 13.4 — — 11 10 M3 M4×8ℓ –5 –2 3 12 7 30
35 88 42 42 22 15 35 5 12 13 23 — — M3 M4×4ℓ 0 7 6 –9 5 35
JSRG SRG
45 100 51 51 20 20 32 7 17 15 29 — — M3 M5×4ℓ 0 10 10 –7 7 45
55 108 57 57 20 20 36 10 20 25 35 — — M3 M5×4ℓ 3 13 16 –4 7 55
65 132 75.5 75.5 28.5 25 46 9 9 28 42 — — M4 M6×5ℓ 3 3 19 –3 9 65
85 168 91 91 35.5 30 120 15 — 30 55 — — M6 M6×8ℓ 3 — 23.5 — 9 85
100 198 100 100 43 33 152 13.3 — 36 60 — — M6 M6×8ℓ 4 — 26 — 9 100
Note1) When desiring to use the dedicated bellows other than in horizontal mount (i.e., vertical, wall and inverted mount), or
when desiring a heat-resistant type of bellows, contact THK.
Note2) For lubrication when using the dedicated bellows, contact THK.
Note3) When using the dedicated bellows, the LM block and LM rail need to be machined so that the bellows can be mount-
ed. Be sure to indicate that the dedicated bellows is required when ordering the LM Guide.
Note4) In case of oil lubrication, be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block
where the piping joint should be attached.
For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see A1-12 and A24-2, respectively.
A1-523
506E
P b2 S1
Unit: mm
Main dimensions
A Supported
Model No. Mounting Lmax model
Screw size
bolt Lmin numbers
W H H1 P p b1 t1 b2 t2 S S1 a b
70 125 51 51 20 20 57 17 35 32 M3 M5×4L 10 5 7 70
85 138 57 57 20 20 68 20 42 36 M3 M5×4L 13 13.5 7 85
JSRW 100 169 75.5 75.5 28.5 25 83 19 50 46 M4 M6×5L 13 15.5 9 SRW 100
130 220 96 96 36.5 35 165 35 60 55 M6 M6×8L 18 20 9 130
150 260 114 114 49 47 200 43.3 70 60 M6 M6×8L 20 20 9 150
Note1) For lubrication when using the dedicated bellows, contact THK.
Note2) When desiring to use the dedicated bellows other than in horizontal mount (i.e., vertical, wall and inverted mount), or
when desiring a heat-resistant type of bellows, contact THK.
JSRW70 - 60/420
Model number of Dimensions of the bellows
bellows for SRW70 (length when compressed
/ length when extended)
A1-524
506E
Options
Dedicated LM Cover
Dedicated LM Cover
●For the supported models, see the table of options by model number on A1-474.
●For the dedicated LM cover dimensions, see A1-526.
LM Guide (Options)
Item name Schematic diagram / mounting location Purpose/location of use
LM cover
A1-525
506E
LM Cover
[Dedicated LM Cover TPH for Model HSR]
The tables below show the dimensions of dedicated LM cover TPH for model HSR. Specify the cor-
responding model number of the desired bellows from the table.
Lmax W
Lmin D S
b1
t1
H
t4
t2
t3
S b2 S
Models HSR25 and 30
Unit: mm
TPH55 - 400/1460
Model number of Lmax
LM cover for HSR55 (cover length when extended)
A1-526
506E
Options
Cap C
Cap C
LM Guide (Options)
If any of the LM rail mounting holes of an LM Guide is filled with cutting chips or foreign material, they
may enter the LM block structure. Entrance of such foreign material can be prevented by covering each
LM rail mounting hole with the dedicated cap.
Since the dedicated cap C for LM rail mounting holes uses a special synthetic resin with high oil re-
sistance and high wear resistance, it is highly durable.
To attach the dedicated cap to the mounting hole, place a flat metal piece like one shown in Fig.1 on
the cap and gradually hammer in the cap until it is on the same level as the top face of the LM rail.
When attaching the dedicated cap C for LM rail mounting holes, do not remove any of the LM blocks
from the LM rail.
Plastic hammer
D
H Flat metal piece
Fig.1 Cap C
Table1 List of Model Numbers Supported for the Dedicated Cap C for LM Rail Mounting Holes
Main dimen-
Supported model number
sions (mm)
Model Bolt SHS
No. used HSR
D H SSR SR SVR NR SCR HMG SHW SRG SRW GSR HR SRS SRS-W NSR-
SVS NRS CSR HRW SRN RSR RSR-W TBC
HCR
1123 12
C3 M3 6.3 1.2 — 15 — — 12 — — — — — 9 —
1530 15
12, 14,
C4 M4 7.8 1.0 15Y — — — 15 15 17, 21, 15 — 15 — — 14 —
27
C5 M5 9.8 2.4 20 20 25 25X 20 — — 20 — 20 2042 20 — 20
25Y 25Y 25
C6 M6 11.4 2.7 30 30 25 25 35 25 — 25 — 25 —
30 30 30
30 30 2555
C8 M8 14.4 3.7 35 35 35 35 35 50 — 30 — — 40
35 35 3065
C10 M10 18.0 3.7 — 45 — — — — 60 — 70 35 3575 — — 50
C12 M12 20.5 4.7 — 55 45 45 45 45 — 45 85 — 4085 — — 70
C14 M14 23.5 5.7 — — 55 55 55 — — 55 100 — — — — —
70
C16 M16 26.5 5.7 — 65 65 65 65 — 65 130 — 50105 — — —
85
C20 M20 32.3 5.7 — — — 75 — — — — — — — — — —
C22 M22 35.5 5.7 — — — 85 85 — — 85 150 — — — — —
C24 M24 39.5 7.7 — — — 100 100 — — 100 — — — — — —
Note) The dedicated cap for the LM rail mounting hole can be made of other materials (e.g., metal). Contact THK for details.
A1-527
506E
Cap GC
●For notes regarding how to handle the GC cap, see A1-547.
LM rail Cap GC
Cap GC
LM rail LM rail
mounting bolt
GC caps are metal caps designed to cover the mounting holes in LM rails (in compliance with RoHS
directives).
In harsh environments, preventing any influx of coolant or foreign material from the top face of the
LM rail, coupled with the use of seals, will dramatically improve the contamination protection perfor-
mance for the LM guide.
[Features]
Eliminating gaps around the mounting Eliminates gaps
holes (countersunk holes)
The GC caps press into the mounting holes
(countersunk holes) so that there are no gaps.
LM Guide
Service environment Example of Using the Spring Pad
Standard C cap fitted GC cap fitted
Metal powder, sputtering ○ ◎ Welding machines, robots
Foreign mat-
Wood shavings, coolant Woodworking machinery,
ter concen- ○ ◎
(Environments that strip away oils) washers
Poor tration: Low
Metal powder + coolant ○ ◎ Lathes, machining centers
environ-
ment Foreign mat- Metal powder, sputtering △ ◎ Welding machines, robots
Wood shavings, coolant Woodworking machinery,
ter concen- △ ◎
(Environments that strip away oils) washers
tration: High
Metal powder + coolant △ ◎ Lathes, machining centers
◎Particularly effective ○: Effective △:Not particularly effective
A1-528
506E
Options
Cap GC
LM Guide (Options)
H GC12 20.36 4.6
GC14 23.36 5.0
GC16 26.36 5.0
GC22 35.36 5.0
GC24 39.36 5.0
A1-529
506E
Mounting method
The procedure for inserting a GC cap into a
mounting hole consists of using a flat aligning
fitting to gradually punch the cap into the hole Plastic hammer
until it is level with the upper surface of the LM Metal piece
rail, as shown in the figure. Fit GC caps without
removing the LM rail from the LM block.
A1-530
506E
Options
Plate Cover SV Steel Tape SP
LM Guide (Options)
Item name Schematic diagram / mounting location Purpose/location of use
Steel tape: SP
For the LM Guide, steel tapes are
available as a means of contamina-
Setscrew tion protection for machine tools.
By covering the LM rail mounting
holes with an ultra-thin stainless
steel (SUS304) plate, the steel tape
End piece: EP SP drastically increases sealability,
thus to prevent the penetration of a
Tap for attaching bellows coolant or cutting chips from the top
Steel Tape SP face of the LM rail. (When mounting
the steel tape, end piece EP can
LM block be used as a means to secure the
cover.)
For the mounting method, see
LM block mounting/
removing jig A1-533.
Note) When mounting the steel tape,
the LM rail needs to be machined.
Indicate that the steel tape is
required when ordering the LM
Guide.
A1-531
506E
A1-532
506E
Options
Plate Cover SV Steel Tape SP
LM Guide (Options)
(3) Carefully adhere the steel tape from the
end with care not to let it bend or sag, while
Fig.6
gradually peeling the release paper from the
steel tape.
(4) Have the steel tape settle on the rail by LM block
rubbing the tape. The adhesive strength in- LM block mounting/removing jig
creases with time. The adhering tape can be
peeled off by pulling its end upward.
(5) Mount the LM block onto the LM rail using
the LM block mounting/removing jig. Fig.7
(6) Attach the end pieces on both ends of the
LM rail and further secure the steel tape.
When securing the end pieces, fasten only Mounting surface
the setscrew on the top face of each end
piece.
(The tap on the end face of the end piece is
used for mounting bellows.)
Note1) The setscrew on the side face is used to lightly se- Fig.8
cure the bent steel tape. Be sure to stop fastening
the screw as soon as it hits the end face, and do not
force the screw further.
Note2) Since the steel tape is a thin steel plate, mishandling Steel tape
it may cause an accident such as cutting your finger. Release paper
When handling it, take an effective safety measure
such as wearing rubber gloves.
Fig.9
Steel tape
Do not make an acute angle
LM block
LM block mounting/removing jig
Fig.10
Steel tape: SP
Setscrew
End piece: EP
Tap for attaching a bellows
Fig.11
A1-533
506E
Lubrication Adapter
[Features]
The dedicated lubrication adapter for models
NR-NRS is built in with a constant quantity dis- Lubrication plate
tributor. Therefore, the adapter can accurately
feed a constant quantity of lubricant to each
raceway regardless of the mounting orientation.
To lubrication
The adapter is economical since it is capable of pump
Lubrication plate
constantly feeding the optimum amount of lubri-
cant and helping eliminate the supply of surplus
lubricant. Constant quantity
To provide pipe arrangement, simply connect an distributor
intermittent lubrication pump widely used for ordi- To lubrication pump
nary machine tools to the greasing holes (M8) on Fig.1 Structural Drawing
the front and the side of the lubrication adapter.
[Specifications]
M×ℓ 2-M1×ℓ1
Viscosity range W T
32 to 64 mm2/s recommended 2-d through hole
of lubricant used B T1
N
Discharge 0.03×4, 0.06×4cc/1shot N
M1 E
Diameter of pipe M
4, 6
connected
Material Aluminum alloy W1
Fig.2
A1-534
506E
Options
Removing/mounting Jig
Removing/mounting Jig
LM Guide (Options)
When assembling the guide, do not remove the LM block from the LM rail whenever possible. If it is
inevitable to remove the LM block due to the plate cover type or the assembly procedure, be sure to
use the removing/mounting jig.
Mounting the LM block without using the removing/mounting jig may cause rolling elements to fall
from the LM block due to contamination by foreign material, damage to internal components or slight
inclination. Mounting the LM block with some of the rolling elements missing may also cause dam-
age to the LM block at an early stage.
When using the removing/mounting jig, do not incline the jig and match the ends of both LM rails.
The removing/mounting jig may not be available, depending on model. If this is the case, use a
spare LM rail. Contact THK for details.
If any of the rolling elements falls from the LM block, contact THK instead of using the product.
Note that the removing/mounting jig is not included in the LM Guide package as standard. When
desiring to use it, contact THK.
LM block
LM rail
Removing/mounting Jig
Removing/mounting Jig
(Material: ABS resin)
A1-535
506E
End Piece EP
For those models whose balls may fall if the LM rail is pulled out of the LM block, an end piece is at-
tached to the product to prevent the LM block from being removed from the LM rail.
For models that can use the end piece, see the table below.
If removing the end piece when using the LM Guide, be sure that the LM block will not overshoot.
The end piece can also be used as a fixing jig for a steel tape, and is available also for the LM rail of
models SSR, SR and HSR.
Table1 Dimension Table for End Piece EP for Models NR/NRS
Unit: mm
Model No. A B C T
A B
NR/NRS 25X 26 14 25 1.5
NR/NRS 30 31 14 31 1.5
NR/NRS 35 38 16 32.5 2
C NR/NRS 45 49 18 41 2
T NR/NRS 55 57 20 46.5 2
NR/NRS 65 69.4 22 59 3.2
NR/NRS 75 81.7 28 56 3.2
NR/NRS 85 91.4 22 68 3.2
Fig.1 End Piece EP for Models NR/NRS NR/NRS 100 106.4 25 73 3.2
A1-536
506E
LM Guide
[LM Guide]
Models SHS, SSR, SVR/SVS, SHW, HSR, SR, NR/NRS, HRW, JR, NSR-TBC, HSR-M1,
SR-M1 and HSR-M2.
SHS25 LC 2 QZ KKHH C0 +1200L P Z T -Ⅱ
Model No. Type of With QZ Contamination protection LM rail length Symbol for LM Symbol for No. of
LM block Lubricator accessory symbol (*1) (in mm) rail jointed use rails used on
With steel the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) tape
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
Medium preload (C0) Super precision grade (SP)/Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-76. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Guaranteed stroke
(in mm) Accuracy symbol (*1)
(*1) See A1-86.
Note) *: Stainless steel is the standard material used for LM blocks.
This model number denotes one set consists of an LM block and LM rail.
A1-537
506E
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-76. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Those models equipped with QZ Lubricator cannot have a grease nipple.
[Cross LM Guide]
Models SCR, CSR and MX
A1-538
506E
Model No.
[Separate LM Guides]
Model HR
2 HR2555 UU M +1000L P T M
Model No. Contamination protection LM rail length Symbol for Stainless steel
accessory symbol (*1) (in mm) LM rail LM rail
jointed use
No. of LM blocks Stainless steel Accuracy symbol (*2)
LM Guide
used on the same rail LM block Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
Super precision grade (SP)/Ultra precision grade (UP)
Model GSR
● LM block ● LM rail
GSR25 T 2 UU +1060L H T K
Model No. Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol Symbol for
LM block protection (in mm) for LM rail tapped-hole LM rail type
accessory symbol (*1) jointed use
No. of LM blocks used Accuracy symbol (*2)
on the same rail Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-76.
Note) One set of model GSR: This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set.
[R Guide]
Model HCR
HCR25A 2 UU C1 +60 / 1000R H 6 T
Model No. Contamination protection R-Guide LM rail radius Symbol for LM rail
accessory symbol (*1) center angle (in mm) jointed use
Number of LM rail joints
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3) used on one axis (*4)
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol)/Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
(*1) See A1-510 (contamination protection accessories). (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-76.
(*4) Number of LM rails used on one arc. For details, contact THK.
A1-539
506E
[Straight-Curved Guide]
Model HMG
When 2 rails are used
HSR15M1R 1 VV C1 +400L P -Ⅱ
Model No. Radial clearance Symbol for No. of rails used
symbol (*1) on the same plane (*4)
Labyrinth seal Accuracy symbol (*3)
symbol (*2)
No. of LM blocks used LM rail length (in mm)
on one rail
(*1) See A1-70 (*2) See A1-397 (*3) See A1-76 (*4) See A1-13.
Note1) The radial clearance, maximum LM rail length and accuracy class are equal to that of model HSR.
Note2) With this model, a single-rail unit constitutes one set (i.e., the required number of sets when 2 rails are used in parallel
is 2).
A1-540
506E
Model No.
Notes on Ordering
[Order units]
Note that the number of items that constitute one set differs depending on the type of LM guide.
Check the sample model number configurations and the accompanying notes.
LM Guide
SHS25C2SSC1+640L 1 set SHS25C2SSC1+640L-Ⅱ2 sets
A1-541
506E
[Supported options]
The supported options differ depending on the model number. Check the available options when or-
dering.
See A1-474.
A1-542
506E
LM Guide
or more people or moving equipment. Doing so may cause injury or damage.
(2) Do not disassemble the parts. This will result in loss of functionality.
(3) Tilting an LM block or LM rail may cause them to fall by their own weight.
(4) Take care not to drop or strike the LM Guide. Doing so may cause injury or damage. Giving an
impact to it could also cause damage to its function even if the product looks intact.
(5) Do not remove the LM block from the LM rail during setup.
(6) Do not insert hands or fingers into the mounting holes on the LM rail, as they could get caught
between the rail and the LM block, resulting in injury.
(7) To ensure personal safety, wear gloves and protective footwear when handling this product.
[Precautions on Use]
(1) Prevent foreign material, such as cutting chips or coolant, from entering the product. Failure to
do so may cause damage.
(2) If the product is used in an environment where cutting chips, coolant, corrosive solvents, water,
etc., may enter the product, use bellows, covers, etc., to prevent them from entering the product.
(3) Do not use this product if the external temperature exceeds 80℃. Unless the unit is specially de-
signed to be heat-resistant, exposure to such temperatures may deform or damage plastic and
rubber parts.
(4) If foreign material such as cutting chips adheres to the product, replenish the lubricant after
cleaning the product.
(5) Micro-strokes tend to obstruct oil film to form on the raceway in contact with the rolling element,
and may lead to fretting corrosion. Take consideration using grease offering excellent fretting pre-
vention. It is also recommended that a stroke movement corresponding to the length of the LM
block be made on a regular basis to make sure oil film is formed between the raceway and rolling
element.
(6) Do not use undue force when fitting parts (pin, key, etc.) to the product. This may generate per-
manent deformation on the raceway, leading to loss of functionality.
(7) If, for operational reasons, it becomes absolutely necessary to remove the LM block from the LM
rail and reattach it, a special mounting jig must be used for this purpose. (The mounting jig is not
included with standard versions of the product. To obtain one, please contact THK.)
(8) Position the mounting jig so that one end abuts the end of the LM rail. When the rail and the jig
are exactly aligned, the LM block can be loaded onto the rail.
(9) Take care to keep the LM block straight. Loading the block at an angle can introduce foreign
matter, damage internal components, or cause balls to fall out.
(10) The LM block must contain all its internal rolling elements (balls) when mounted on the LM rail.
Using a block with any balls removed may result in premature damage.
(11) Please contact THK if any balls fall out of the LM block; do not use the block if any balls are
missing.
A1-543
506E
(12) If the end plate is damaged due to an accident, etc., balls may fall out or the LM block may
become detached from the LM rail and drop. If the LM Guide will be used hanging upside
down, take preventive measures such as adding a safety mechanism to prevent falls.
(13) Insufficient rigidity or accuracy of mounting members causes the bearing load to concentrate on
one point and the bearing performance will drop significantly. Accordingly, give sufficient consid-
eration to the rigidity/accuracy of the housing and base and strength of the fixing bolts.
(14) When removing the LM block from the LM rail and then replacing the block, an LM block mount-
ing/removing jig that facilitates such installation is available. Contact THK for details.
[Lubrication]
(1) Thoroughly remove anti-rust oil and feed lubricant before using the product.
(2) Do not mix different lubricants. Mixing greases using the same type of thickening agent may still
cause adverse interaction between the two greases if they use different additives, etc.
(3) When using the product in locations exposed to constant vibrations or in special environments such
as clean rooms, vacuum and low/high temperature, use the grease appropriate for the specification/
environment.
(4) When lubricating the product having no grease nipple or oil hole, apply grease directly on the
raceway and stroke the product several times to let the grease spread inside.
(5) The consistency of grease changes according to the temperature. Take note that the slide resistance
of the LM Guide also changes as the consistency of grease changes.
(6) After lubrication, the slide resistance of the LM Guide may increase due to the agitation resistance of
grease. Be sure to perform a break-in to let the grease spread fully, before operating the machine.
(7) Excess grease may scatter immediately after lubrication, so wipe off scattered grease as necessary.
(8) The properties of grease deteriorate and its lubrication performance drops over time, so grease must
be checked and added properly according to the use frequency of the machine.
(9) Although the lubrication interval may vary according to use conditions and the service environment,
lubrication should be performed approximately every 100 km in travel distance (three to six months).
Set the final lubrication interval/amount based on the actual machine.
(10)If the mounting orientation is other than horizontal use, the lubricant may not reach the race-
way completely. For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see B1-28 and
B24-2, respectively.
(11)When adopting oil lubrication, the lubricant may not be distributed throughout the LM block depending
on the mounting orientation of the block. Contact THK in advance for details.
[Storage]
When storing the LM Guide, enclose it in a package designated by THK and store it in a room in a
horizontal orientation while avoiding high temperature, low temperature and high humidity.
After the product has been in storage for an extended period of time, lubricant inside may have de-
teriorated, so add new lubricant before use.
[Disposal]
Dispose of the product properly as industrial waste.
A1-544
506E
Precautions on Use
Precautions on Handling the LM Guide for Special Environment
LM Guide
(1) This product has been thoroughly cleaned and degreased and then sealed in moisture-proof
packaging. If possible, open the package immediately prior to using the product.
(2) Once the packaging has been opened, store the product inside a clean, dry receptacle accom-
panied by silica gel or another drying agent. Do not use anti-rust oil or corrosion- or tarnish-
preventive paper or fluid with this product.
(3) Wear protective rubber or vinyl gloves while handling this product and make sure the surround-
ing environment is relatively clean.
Oil-Free LM Guide
[Handling]
(1) The Oil-Free LM Guide is suitable for use at high temperatures, under atmospheric pressure or
in a high-vacuum environment of 10-6 Pa, and is designed for ultra-low dust emission. It is not
intended for use in locations requiring rigidity. Because a preload would affect the strength of its
Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film, it does not support preloads.
(2) The product can be used in temperatures ranging from ‒20 to 150℃.
(3) To ensure proper function of the Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film, use this product in an envi-
ronment free from condensation, at a humidity level of 40% or less.
(4) This product is not intended for joint use.
(5) Great care must be taken in the installation of the Oil-Free LM Guide, which requires greater
precision compared to standard LM Guides.
(6) If the LM block is removed from the LM rail, balls may fall out, and the Dry Lubrication S-Com-
pound Film can be damaged when the block is remounted. If it becomes necessary to remove
the LM block from the LM rail, please contact THK.
(7) This product should be stored in a horizontal position, in its original wrapping and package, in
a controlled, stable environment free from abnormal high or low temperatures or high humidity.
THK recommends storing it at room temperature (255℃), with a humidity level of 40% RH or
lower and an air-purity level of 10,000 or lower.
(8) This product has been thoroughly cleaned and degreased and then sealed in moisture-proof
packaging. If possible, open the package immediately prior to using the product.
(9) Once the packaging has been opened, store the product inside a clean, dry receptacle accom-
panied by silica gel or another drying agent. Do not use anti-rust oil or corrosion- or tarnish-
preventive paper or fluid with this product.
(10)Wear protective rubber or vinyl gloves while handling this product and make sure the surround-
ing environment is relatively clean.
A1-545
506E
[Handling]
Take care not to drop or strike this product. This could cause injury or product damage.
Do not block the vent hole with grease or the like.
The QZ device supplies oil only to the raceway, so use it in combination with regular greasing/lubri-
cation. If the product is used in an environment exposed to coolant, cutting chips or other foreign
material, oil on the raceway is lost easily. Accordingly, be sure to also use covers, bellows, etc.
[Service environment]
Be sure the service temperature of this product is between ‒10 to 50℃, and do not clean the prod-
uct by immersing it in an organic solvent or white kerosene, or leave it unpacked.
[Service environment]
Be sure the service temperature of this product is between -20 to +80℃, and do not clean the prod-
uct by immersing it in an organic solvent or white kerosene, or leave it unpacked.
A1-546
506E
Precautions on Use
Precautions on Using Options for the LM Guide
LM Guide
[Service environment]
Be sure the service temperature of this product is between -20 to +80℃, and do not clean the prod-
uct by immersing it in an organic solvent or white kerosene, or leave it unpacked.
It contacts only with the LM rail raceway. Do not use it in harsh environments.
Cap GC
For details regarding the GC cap, see A1-528.
[Handling]
If GC caps are specified for the product, the edges of the LM rail mounting hole openings will be
sharp. Take great care not to injure your fingers or hands while working.
When fitting GC caps, use a flat aligning tool to gradually punch the cap into the hole until it is level
with the upper surface of the LM rail. Then run an oil stone over the rail until the upper surface of the
rail and the GC caps are completely flat.
A1-547
506E
A1-548
506E
LM Guide
General Catalog
B1-1
506E
LM Guide
General Catalog
B Support Book
Features and Types ............................. B1-8 • Methods for Measuring Accuracy after Installation .. B1-101
Features of the LM Guide ...................... B1-8 • Recommended Tightening Torque for LM Rails .. B1-101
• Large Permissible Load and High Rigidity .. B1-9
• High Precision of Motion ....................... B1-11 Options ................................................. B1-103
• Accuracy Averaging Effect by Absorbing Mounting Surface Error .. B1-14 Seal and Metal scraper.......................... B1-104
• Easy Maintenance ............................... B1-16 Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS ......... B1-105
• Substantial Energy Savings ................... B1-17 Side Scraper .......................................... B1-107
• Low Total Cost ..................................... B1-18 Protector ................................................ B1-108
• Ideal Four Raceway, Circular-Arc Groove, Two-Point Contact Structure .. B1-19 Light-Resistance Contact Seal LiCS ..... B1-109
• Superb Error-Absorbing Capability with the DF Design .. B1-23 Dedicated bellows ................................. B1-110
Classification Table of the LM Guides ... B1-24 Dedicated LM Cover .............................. B1-110
Cap C .................................................... B1-111
Point of Selection ................................ B1-26 Cap GC.................................................. B1-112
Flowchart for Selecting an LM Guide .... B1-26 Plate Cover SV Steel Tape SP ............. B1-114
Setting Conditions ................................. B1-28 QZ Lubricator......................................... B1-117
• Conditions of the LM Guide ................... B1-28 Lubrication Adapter................................ B1-120
Selecting a Type .................................... B1-44 Removing/mounting Jig ......................... B1-121
• Types of LM Guides ............................. B1-44 End Piece EP ........................................ B1-122
Calculating the Applied Load ................. B1-56
• Calculating an Applied Load .................. B1-56 Model No. ............................................. B1-123
• Example of calculation .......................... B1-59 • Model Number Coding .......................... B1-123
Calculating the Equivalent Load ............ B1-66 • Notes on Ordering................................ B1-127
• Rated Load of an LM Guide in Each Direction .. B1-66
Calculating the Static Safety Factor ...... B1-68 Precautions on Use ............................. B1-129
Calculating the Average Load................ B1-69 Precautions on Using the LM Guide ...... B1-129
• Example of Calculating the Average Load (1) Precautions on Handling the LM Guide for Special Environment .. B1-131
- with Horizontal Mount and Acceleration/Deceleration Considered - .. B1-71 • LM Guide for Medium-to-Low Vacuum .... B1-131
• Example of Calculating the Average Load (2) • Oil-Free LM Guide ............................... B1-131
- When the Rails are Movable................... B1-72 Precautions on Using Options for the LM Guide .. B1-132
Calculating the Nominal Life .................. B1-73 • QZ Lubricator for the LM Guide .............. B1-132
• Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Balls .. B1-73 • Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS, Side Scraper for LM Guides .. B1-132
• Nominal Life Equation for the Oil-Free LM Guide .. B1-73 • Light Contact Seal LiCS for LM Guides ... B1-133
• Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Rollers .. B1-74 • Cap GC .............................................. B1-133
• Example of Calculating the Nominal Life (1)
- with Horizontal Mount and High-speed Acceleration .. B1-77
• Example of Calculating the Nominal Life (2)
- with Vertical Mount .............................. B1-82
Predicting the Rigidity ............................ B1-85
• Selecting a Radial Clearance (Preload) ... B1-85
• Service Life with a Preload Considered ... B1-86
• Rigidity ............................................... B1-86
Determining the Accuracy...................... B1-87
• Accuracy Standards ............................. B1-87
• Guidelines for Accuracy Grades by Machine Type .. B1-88
B1-2
506E
Classification Table of the LM Guides ... A1-8 Models SSR-XV and SSR-XVM ........... A1-112
Model SSR-XTB .................................... A1-114
Point of Selection ................................ A1-10 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-116
Flowchart for Selecting an LM Guide .... A1-10 • Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model SSR .. A1-117
Setting Conditions ................................. A1-12
• Conditions of the LM Guide ................... A1-12 Caged Ball LM Guide Ultra-heavy Load Type for Machine Tools Model SVR/SVS ... A1-118
Selecting a Type .................................... A1-28 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-119
• Types of LM Guides ............................. A1-28 • Types and Features ............................. A1-121
Calculating the Applied Load ................. A1-40
• Calculating an Applied Load .................. A1-40 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Calculating the Equivalent Load ............ A1-57 Models SVR-R and SVR-LR.................. A1-124
• Rated Load of an LM Guide in Each Direction .. A1-57 Models SVS-R and SVS-LR .................. A1-126
Calculating the Static Safety Factor ...... A1-61 Models SVR-C and SVR-LC.................. A1-128
Calculating the Average Load................ A1-62 Models SVS-C and SVS-LC .................. A1-130
Calculating the Nominal Life .................. A1-64 Models SVR-RH (Build to Order), SVR-LRH (Build to Order),
• Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Balls .. A1-64 SVS-RH (Build to Order), and SVS-LRH (Build to Order) ..... A1-132
• Nominal Life Equation for the Oil-Free LM Guide .. A1-64 Models SVR-CH (Build to Order), SVR-LCH (Build to Order),
• Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Rollers .. A1-65 SVS-CH (Build to Order), and SVS-LCH (Build to Order).... A1-134
Predicting the Rigidity ............................ A1-68 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-136
• Selecting a Radial Clearance (Preload) ... A1-68
• Service Life with a Preload Considered ... A1-69 Caged Ball LM Guide Wide Rail Model SHW ... A1-138
• Rigidity ............................................... A1-69 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-139
• Radial Clearance Standard for Each Model .. A1-70 • Types and Features ............................. A1-140
Determining the Accuracy...................... A1-74
• Accuracy Standards ............................. A1-74 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Guidelines for Accuracy Grades by Machine Type .. A1-75 Model SHW-CA ..................................... A1-142
• Accuracy Standard for Each Model......... A1-76 Models SHW-CR and SHW-HR ............ A1-144
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-146
Features and Dimensions of Each Model .. A1-87 • Greasing Hole ..................................... A1-147
Structure and Features of the Caged Ball LM Guide .. A1-88
• Advantages of the Ball Cage Technology .. A1-89 Caged Ball LM Guide Miniature Type Model SRS.... A1-148
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-149
Caged Ball LM Guide Global Standard Size Model SHS ... A1-94 • Types and Features ............................. A1-150
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-95 • Flatness of the LM Rail and the LM Block Mounting Surface .. A1-152
• Types and Features ............................. A1-96
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table Models SRS5M, SRS5WM .................... A1-154
Models SHS-C and SHS-LC.................. A1-98 Models SRS-M and SRS-N ................... A1-156
Models SHS-V and SHS-LV .................. A1-100 Models SRS-WM and SRS-WN ............ A1-158
Models SHS-R and SHS-LR.................. A1-102 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-160
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-104 • Greasing Hole ..................................... A1-161
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model SHS .. A1-105
Caged Ball LM Guide Cross LM Guide Model SCR .. A1-162
Caged Ball LM Guide Radial Type Model SSR ... A1-106 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-163
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-107 • Types and Features ............................. A1-164
• Types and Features ............................. A1-108
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table Model SCR ............................................ A1-166
Models SSR-XW and SSR-XWM .......... A1-110
B1-3
506E
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-168 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model SCR .. A1-169 Models NR-R and NR-LR ...................... A1-226
Models NRS-R and NRS-LR ................. A1-228
Caged Ball LM Guide Finite stroke Model EPF ... A1-170 Models NR-A and NR-LA....................... A1-230
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-171 Models NRS-A and NRS-LA .................. A1-232
• Types and Features ............................. A1-172 Models NR-B and NR-LB ...................... A1-234
• Accuracy of the Mounting Surface .......... A1-173 Models NRS-B and NRS-LB.................. A1-236
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-238
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Model EPF ............................................. A1-174 LM Guide Wide Rail Model HRW ........ A1-240
• Standard Length of the LM Rail .............. A1-176 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-241
• Types and Features ............................. A1-242
LM Guide Global Standard Size Model HSR .... A1-178
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-179 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Types ................................................. A1-180 Models HRW-CA and HRW-CAM .......... A1-244
Models HRW-CR, HRW-CRM and HRW-LRM .. A1-246
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-248
Models HSR-A and HSR-AM, Models HSR-LA and HSR-LAM .. A1-184 • Stopper .............................................. A1-248
Models HSR-B, HSR-BM, HSR-LB and HSR-LBM .. A1-186
Model HSR-C Grade Ct ......................... A1-188 LM Guide Miniature Types Model RSR .. A1-250
Model HSR-RM ..................................... A1-190 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-251
Models HSR-R, HSR-RM, HSR-LR and HSR-LRM .. A1-192 • Types and Features ............................. A1-252
Model HSR-R Grade Ct ......................... A1-194 • Comparison of Model RSR-W with Other Model Numbers .. A1-254
Models HSR-YR and HSR-YRM ........... A1-196 • Accuracy of the Mounting Surface .......... A1-255
Models HSR-CA, HSR-CAM, HSR-HA and HSR-HAM... A1-198
Models HSR-CB, HSR-CBM, HSR-HB and HSR-HBM .. A1-200 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Models HSR-HA, HSR-HB and HSR-HR .. A1-202 Models RSR-M, RSR-N and RSR-TN .. A1-256
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-204 Models RSR-M, RSR-KM, RSR-VM and RSR-N .. A1-258
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model HSR .. A1-205 Models RSR-WM(WTM) and RSR-WN(WTN) .. A1-260
• Stopper .............................................. A1-206 Models RSR-WV, RSR-WVM and RSR-WN .. A1-262
• Greasing Hole ..................................... A1-206 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-264
• Stopper .............................................. A1-264
LM Guide Radial Type Model SR ........ A1-208
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-209 LM Guide Miniature Type (Low Cost Type) Model RSR-Z ... A1-266
• Types and Features ............................. A1-210 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-267
• Characteristics of Model SR .................. A1-212 • Types and Features ............................. A1-268
• Accuracy of the Mounting Surface .......... A1-269
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Models SR-W, SR-WM, SR-V and SR-VM .. A1-214 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Models SR-TB, SR-TBM, SR-SB and SR-SBM .. A1-216 Model RSR-ZM ...................................... A1-270
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-218 Model RSR-WZM .................................. A1-272
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model SR... A1-219 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-274
• Stopper .............................................. A1-274
LM Guide Ultra-heavy Load Type for Machine Tools Model NR/NRS ... A1-220
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-221 LM Guide Separate Type (4-way Equal Load) Model HR .... A1-276
• Types and Features ............................. A1-222 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-277
• Characteristics of Models NR and NRS ... A1-224 • Types and Features ............................. A1-278
• Example of Clearance Adjustment .......... A1-279
• Comparison of Model Numbers with Cross-roller Guides .. A1-280
B1-4
506E
LM Guide Separate Type (Radial) Model GSR ... A1-290 LM Guide R Guide Model HCR ........... A1-332
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-291 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-333
• Types and Features ............................. A1-292 • Types and Features ............................. A1-334
• Example of Clearance Adjustment .......... A1-293
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table R Guide Model HCR .............................. A1-336
Models GSR-T and GSR-V ................... A1-294
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-296 LM Guide Straight-Curved Guide Model HMG.... A1-338
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model GSR .. A1-296 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-339
• Types and Features ............................. A1-341
LM Guide Separate Type (Radial) Model GSR-R ... A1-298 • Examples of Table Mechanisms ............. A1-342
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-299
• Types and Features ............................. A1-300 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
Model HMG ........................................... A1-344
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table • Jointed LM rail ..................................... A1-346
Model GSR-R ........................................ A1-302
• Standard Length of the LM Rail .............. A1-304 LM Guide Self-aligning Type Model NSR-TBC ... A1-348
• Rack and Pinion .................................. A1-305 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-349
• Rack and Pinion Dimensional Drawing .... A1-308 • Types and Features ............................. A1-349
LM Guide Cross LM Guide Model CSR .. A1-310 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-311 Model NSR-TBC .................................... A1-350
• Types and Features ............................. A1-312 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-352
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table LM Guide High Temperature Type Model HSR-M1 ... A1-354
Model CSR ............................................ A1-314 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-355
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-316 • Types and Features ............................. A1-357
• Tapped-hole LM Rail Type of Model CSR .. A1-317 • Service Life ......................................... A1-358
LM Guide Miniature Cross Guide Model MX .... A1-318 Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-319 Models HSR-M1A and HSR-M1LA ........ A1-360
• Types and Features ............................. A1-319 Models HSR-M1B and HSR-M1LB........ A1-362
Models HSR-M1R and HSR-M1LR ....... A1-364
Dimensional Drawing, Dimensional Table Model HSR-M1YR ................................. A1-366
Model MX .............................................. A1-320 • Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-368
• Standard Length and Maximum Length of the LM Rail .. A1-322
LM Guide High Temperature Type Model SR-M1 .... A1-370
LM Guide Structural Member Rail Model JR.... A1-324 • Structure and Features ......................... A1-371
• Structure and Features ......................... A1-325 • Thermal Characteristics of LM Rail and LM Block Materials .. A1-371
• Second Moment of Inertia of the LM Rail .. A1-325 • Types and Features ............................. A1-372
• Types and Features ............................. A1-326 • Service Life ......................................... A1-373
B1-5
506E
B1-6
506E
B1-7
506E
Wide array of options (QZ lubricator, Laminated contact scraper LaCS, etc.)
Easy maintenance
Improved productivity of the machine
Substantial energy savings
Low total cost
Higher accuracy of the machine
Higher efficiency in machine design
B1-8
506E
LM Guide
The reason for this space saving is the greater difference in permissible load between the R-groove
contact structure and the surface contact structure. The R-groove contact structure (radius: 52% of
the ball radius) can bear a load per ball 13 times greater than the surface contact structure. Since
service life is proportional to the cube of the permissible load, this increased ball-bearing load trans-
lates into a service life that is approximately 2,200 longer than the linear bushing.
Housing 170
Shaft
Linear bushing
Mounting base
165
LM block
34
LM rail
24
B1-9
506E
[High Rigidity]
The LM Guide is capable of bearing vertical and horizontal loads. Additionally, due to the circular-arc
groove design, it is capable of carrying a preload as necessary to increase its rigidity.
When compared with a feed screw shaft system and a spindle in rigidity, the guide surface using an
LM Guide has higher rigidity.
Example of comparing static rigidity between the LM Guide, a feed screw shaft sys-
tem and a spindle
(vertical machining center with the main shaft motor of 7.5 kW)
Table2 Comparison of Static Rigidity
Unit: N/m
[Components]
LM Guide: SVR45LC/C0 X-axis Y-axis
Components Z-axis direction
direction direction
(C0 clearance: preload = 11.11kN)
Ball Screw: BNFN4010-5/G0 9400 (radial)
LM Guide — 2400
7400 (reverse radial)
(G0 clearance: preload = 2.64kN)
Spindle: general-purpose cutting spindle Ball screw 330 — —
Spindle 250 250 280
Note) The rigidity of the feed screw shaft system includes
rigidity of the shaft end support bearing.
Spindle
Z
X Y
LM Guide
Ball Screw
Fig.3
B1-10
506E
Position
LM Guide
30 30
20 20
(μm) (μ m)
14μm
10 10
1μm
20 20
30 30
(Measurements are taken with the single-axis table loaded with a 500-kg weight)
Fig.4 Comparison of Lost Motion between the LM Guide and a Slide Guide
Test method
Type Clearance As per JIS B 6330 Based on minimum
10mm/min 500mm/min 4000mm/min unit feeding
Symbol C1 C0
Radial clearance –25 to –10 –40 to –25
B1-11
506E
200
SHS25LC
m t m
KR4610A
250 200
640
Pitching accuracy
(μm)
0.6
0.4
0.2
0.0
−0.2
−0.4
−0.6
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160
(mm)
Yawing accuracy
(μm)
0.6
0.4
0.2
0.0
−0.2
−0.4
−0.6
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160
(mm)
Fig.5 Dynamic Accuracy of a Single-axis Table
B1-12
506E
800 1000
LM Guide
1000
W W
Fig.6 Condition
[Conditions]
Model No. : HSR65LA3SSC0 + 2565LP-Ⅱ
Radial clearance
Remaining Preload (%)
B1-13
506E
Fig.8
0.02 0.02
Rail 2
Misalignment (mm)
Misalignment (mm)
Rail 2
0.01 0.01
0 0
0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700
−0.01 −0.01
Rail 1 Rail 1
−0.02 −0.02
Rail length (mm) Rail length (mm)
Misalignment curve (vertical) Misalignment curve (horizontal)
Straightness accuracy (mm)
0.002 0.002
0.001 0.001
0.368μ m 0.601μ m
0 0
0 50 100 150 200 250 0 50 100 150 200 250
−0.001 −0.001
−0.002 −0.002
Stroke (mm) Stroke (mm)
Displacement of the table (vertical) Displacement of the table (horizontal)
Fig.9
B1-14
506E
Even on a roughly milled mounting surface, the LM Guide drastically increases running accuracy of
the top face of the table.
[Example of Installation]
When comparing the mounting surface accu- Table4 Actual Measurement of Mounting-Surface Accuracy
Unit: m
racy (a) and the table running accuracy (b), the
results are : Mounting Average
Direction Straightness
LM Guide
surface (a)
Vertical 92.5µm → 15µm = 1/6 A 80
Vertical Horizontal 92.5
Horizontal 28µm → 4µm = 1/7 B 105
Bottom C 40
Side surface 28
surface D 16
16μm
40μm
105μ m
Bottom surface B
80μm
Side surface D
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Table5 Actual Measurement of Running Accuracy on the Table (Based on Measurement in Fig.10 and Fig.11)
Unit: m
Measurement point
Direction
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Straightness (b)
Vertical 0 +2 +8 +13 +15 +9 +5 0 15
Horizontal 0 +1 +2 +3 +2 +2 −1 0 4
B1-15
506E
Easy Maintenance
Unlike with sliding guides, the LM Guide does not incur abnormal wear. As a result, sliding surfaces
do not need to be reconditioned, and precision needs not be altered. Regarding lubrication, sliding
guides require forced circulation of a large amount of lubricant so as to maintain an oil film on the
sliding surfaces, whereas the LM Guide only needs periodical replenishing of a small amount of
grease or lubricant. Maintenance is that simple. This also helps keep the work environment clean.
B1-16
506E
Machine Specifications
LM Guide
Single-axis surface grinding machine Three-axis surface grinding machine
Type of machine
(sliding guide) (rolling guide)
Overall length
13m×3.2m 12.6m×2.6m
× overall width
Total mass 17000kg 16000kg
Table mass 5000kg 5000kg
Grinding area 0.7m×5m 0.7m×5m
Table guide Rolling through V-V guide Rolling through LM Guide installation
Three axes (5.5 kW + 3.7 kW x 2)
No. of grinding stone axes Single axis (5.5 kW)
Grinding capacity: 3 times greater
B1-17
506E
Accuracy measurement
When extremely high precision is not required (e.g., running accuracy), the LM Guide can be at-
tached to the steel plate even if the black scale on it is not removed.
B1-18
506E
LM Guide
Two-point Contact Structure Four Point Contact Structure
Rotation axis
Rotation axis
Rotation axis
Contact width d1
d2
Contact width
th
id
w
ct
ta
A
on
B
d2 d1 Ball rotation axis d2 d1 R R
R
R: Radius of
curvature Contact t angle
angle Contac
B A R: Radius of
curvature
B’ B’
B B
d1 π×d1 d1 π×d1
A A’ A A’
d2 π×d2 d2 π×d2
Fig.12 Fig.13
As indicated in Fig.12 and Fig.13, when the ball rotates one revolution, the ball slips by the differ-
ence between the circumference of the diameter of inner surface (d1) and that of the outer contact
diameter (d2). (This slip is called differential slip.) If the difference is large, the ball rotates while
slipping, the friction coefficient increases more than 10 times and the friction resistance steeply in-
creases.
B1-19
506E
Rigidity
With the two-point contact, even if a relatively large Since differential slip occurs due to the four-point con-
preload is applied, the rolling resistance does not ab- tact, a sufficient preload cannot be applied and high
normally increase and high rigidity is obtained. rigidity cannot be obtained.
Load Rating
Since the curvature radius of the ball raceway is 51 Since the curvature radius of the gothic arch groove
to 52% of the ball diameter, a large rated load can be has to be 55 to 60% of the ball diameter, the rated
obtained. load is reduced to approx. 50% of that of the circular
arc groove.
Difference in Rigidity
As shown in Fig.14, the rigidity widely varies according to the difference in curvature radius or difference in pre-
load.
0 clearance
.6Da
a
2D
a
8
5D
0.5
R=0
0.5
40
R=
6
R=
4
20 Magnitude of the preload: 5kN
2
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 10 20
Rigidity (N/μm) Applied load (kN)
Fig.14
B1-20
506E
[Accuracy Error of the Mounting Surface and Test Data on Rolling Resistance]
The difference between the contact structures translates into a rolling resistance.
In the gothic arch groove contact structure, each ball contacts at four points and differential slip or spinning
occurs if a preload is applied to increase rigidity or an error in the mounting precision is large. This sharply in-
creases the rolling resistance and causes abnormal wear in an early stage.
The following are test data obtained by comparing an LM Guide having the four raceway, circular-arc groove
two-point contact structure and a product having the two-row, Gothic-arch, four-point contact structure.
LM Guide
[Sample] [Conditions]
(1) LM Guide Radial clearance: 0m
SR30W (radial type) 2 sets Without seal
HSR35A (4-way equal-load type) 2 sets Without lubrication
(2) Two-row Gothic-arch groove product Load: table mass of 30 kg
Type with dimensions similar to HSR30 2 sets
80
70
Rolling resistance (N)
60
Gothic-arch groove product
50
40
30
0 W
20 A•SR3
HSR35
10
0
-5 -10 -15 -20 -25 -30 -35 -40 -45
Magnitude of the preload (μ m)
B1-21
506E
60
Rolling resistance (N)
50
Gothic-arch groove product
40
30
5A
20 HSR3
S R 3 0 W
10
Data 3: Difference between the levels of the top and bottom rails and rolling resistance
Displace the bottom of either rail vertically by S and create the height difference between the two axes. Then,
measure the rolling resistance. If there is a height difference between the rails, moment will act on the LM
block. If the LM Guide’s groove is the Gothic-arc groove, this will cause spinning. The LM Guide with the circu-
lar-arc groove is capable of absorbing the error caused by the height difference between rails as great as 0.3/200
mm, where its rolling resistance will not increase significantly.
200
60
Gothic-arch groove product
Rolling resistance (N)
50
40
30 5A
R3
HS
20
10 SR30W
0
0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5
Height displacement: S (mm)
(Level displacement)
B1-22
506E
LM Guide
Angular Ball Bearings Mounted Front-to-front (DF type) DF Type Four-row Angular Contact (LM Guide)
Angular Ball Bearings Mounted Back-to-back (DB type) Four-row Gothic-arch Contact
An LM ball guide mounted on a plane receives a moment (M) due to an error in flatness or in level
or a deflection of the table. Therefore, it is essential for the guide to have self-adjusting capability.
Table Block
M M
M M
Since the distance from the application point of the Since the distance from the application point of the bear-
bearing is small, the internal load generated from a ing is large, the internal load generated from a mounting
mounting error is small and the self-adjusting capability error is large and the self-adjusting capability is small.
is large. With an LM ball guide having angular ball bearings
mounted back-to-back, if there is an error in flatness or
a deflection in the table, the internal load applied to the
block is approx. 6 times greater than that of the front-
to-front mount structure and the service life is much
shorter. In addition, the fluctuation in sliding resistance
is greater.
B1-23
506E
Ball Guide
Model NSR-TBC
Self-aligning
Wide Type
Model SHW Miniature Type
Low Center of Gravity
Model RSR Model RSR-Z
Ultra Compact Ultra Compact
High Corrosion Resistance
Miniature Type
Model SRS Model EPF Wide Type
Lightweight and Compact Finite stroke
Model HRW
Wide Rail
4-way Equal Load
Cross Type
Model SCR
4-way Equal Load
B1-24
506E
LM Guide
Roller Guide
Standard Type
Model HCR
Model JR Type
Straight-Curved Type
Model JR
Structural Member Rail
Model HMG
4-way Equal Load
B1-25
506E
Selection Starts
1 Setting Conditions Set conditions necessary for designing load on the LM Guide.
Change span, number
of LM blocks and Mounting orientation B1-28 Symbol for number of axes B1-29
number of LM rails
3 Calculating the Applied Load Calculate the applied load on the LM block.
Calculating the applied load B1-56 Load rating of the LM Guide in all directions B1-66
Judgment on the
static safety factor
NO
YES
Average the applied load fluctuating during operation
6 Calculating the Average Load to convert the value to an average load. B1-69
Selection Completed
B1-26
506E
Point of Selection
Flowchart for Selecting an LM Guide
LM Guide
•Space in the guide section
•Dimensions (span, number of LM blocks, number of LM rails, thrust)
•Installation direction (horizontal, vertical, slant mount, wall mount, suspended)
•Magnitude, direction and position of the working load
•Operating frequency (duty cycle)
•Speed (acceleration)
•Stroke length
•Required service life
•Precision of motion
•Environment
•In a special environment (vacuum, clean room, high temperature, environment exposed to
contaminated environment, etc.), it is necessary to take into account material, surface treatment,
lubrication and contamination protection.
B1-27
506E
Setting Conditions
Conditions of the LM Guide
[Mounting Orientation]
The LM Guide can be mounted in the following five orientations.
If the mounting orientation is other than horizontal use, the lubricant may not reach the raceway
completely.
Be sure to let THK know the installation direction and the exact position in each LM block where the
grease nipple or the piping joint should be attached.
For the lubrication, see A24-2.
[Mounting Orientation]
Horizontal (symbol: H) Inverted (symbol: R) Wall mount (symbol: K)
Up Up Up
Up Up
Down
Down
B1-28
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
SHS25C2SSCO+1000LP -Ⅱ
Model number (details are given on the Symbol for number of axes
corresponding page of the model) ("II" indicates 2 axes. No symbol for a single axis)
Note: Note:
When placing an order, specify When placing an order, specify
the number in multiple of 2 axes. the number in multiple of 2 axes.
Note:
When placing an order, specify
the number in multiple of 3 axes.
Using 2 axes opposed
to each other
Note:
When placing an order, specify
the number in multiple of 4 axes.
B1-29
506E
[Service environment]
Lubrication
When using an LM system, it is necessary to provide effective lubrication. Without lubrication, the
rolling elements or the raceway may be worn faster and the service life may be shortened.
A lubricant has effects such as the following.
(1) Minimizes friction in moving elements to prevent seizure and reduce wear.
(2) Forms an oil film on the raceway to decrease stress acting on the surface and extend rolling fa-
tigue life.
(3) Covers the metal surface to prevent rust formation.
To fully bring out the LM Guide’s functions, it is necessary to provide lubrication according to the
conditions.
If the mounting orientation is other than horizontal use, the lubricant may not reach the raceway
completely.
Be sure to let THK know the mounting orientation and the exact position in each LM block where the
grease nipple or the piping joint should be attached. For the mounting orientation and the lubrica-
tion, see B1-28 and B24-2, respectively.
Even with an LM Guide with seals, the internal lubricant gradually seeps out during operation.
Therefore, the system needs to be lubricated at an appropriate interval according to the conditions.
Corrosion Prevention
Determining a Material
Any LM system requires a material that meets the environments. For use in environments where
corrosion resistance is required, some LM system models can use martensite stainless steel.
(Martensite stainless steel can be used for LM Guide models SSR, SHW, SRS, HSR, SR, HRW,
RSR, RSR-Z and HR.)
The HSR series includes HSR-M2, a highly corrosion resistant LM Guide using austenite stainless
steel, which has high anti-corrosive effect. For details, see A1-390.
Surface Treatment
The surfaces of the rails and shafts of LM systems can be treated for anti-corrosive or aesthetic pur-
poses.
THK offers THK-AP treatment, which is the optimum surface treatment for LM systems.
There are roughly three types of THK-AP treatment: AP-HC, AP-C and AP-CF. (See B0-20.)
B1-30
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
Contamination Protection
When foreign material enters an LM system, it will cause abnormal wear or shorten the service life,
and it is necessary to prevent foreign material from entering the system. When entrance of foreign
material is predicted, it is important to select an effective sealing device or dust-control device that
meets the environment conditions.
THK offers contamination protection accessories for LM Guides by model number, such as end
seals made of special synthetic rubber with high wear resistance, and side seals and inner seals for
LM Guide
further increasing dust-prevention effect.
In addition, for locations with adverse environment, Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS and dedicated
bellows are available by model number. Also, THK offers dedicated caps for LM rail mounting holes,
designed to prevent cutting chips from entering the LM rail mounting holes.
When it is required to provide contamination protection for a Ball Screw in an environment exposed
to cutting chips and moisture, we recommend using a telescopic cover that protects the whole sys-
tem or a large bellows.
For the options, see B1-103.
B1-31
506E
[Special environments]
Clean Room
In a clean environment generation of dust
from the LM system has to be reduced
Caged Ball LM Guide
and anti-rust oil cannot be used.
Therefore, it is necessary to increase the SHS SSR SVR/SVS
Supported
corrosion resistance of the LM system. In models
SHW SRS SCR EPF
addition, depending on the level of
cleanliness, a dust collector is required.
Corrosion Prevention
■Material-based Measure LM Guides for Special Environment
Stainless Steel LM Guide
This LM Guide uses martensite stainless Supported
High Corrosion Resistance HSR-M2
steel, which has corrosion resistant effect.
models
Oil-Free SR-MS
Highly Corrosion Resistant LM Guide
It uses austenite stainless steel, which has
a high corrosion resistant effect, in its LM
rail.
Surface Treatment
■Measure Through Surface Treatment
THK AP-HC, AP-C and AP-CF Treatment
The LM system is surface treated to
increase corrosion resistance.
Grease
B1-32
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
SRS SCR EPF
HSR-M2 SR-MS
A1-390 A1-404
B0-20
A24-12 A24-14
B1-33
506E
High Temperature
Vacuum
LM Guide
In a vacuum environment, measures are required
to prevent gas from being emitted from a resin
and the scattering of grease. Anti-rust oil cannot Supported HSR-M1 SR-M1
models
be used, therefore, it is necessary to select a RSR-M1
product with high corrosion resistance.
■Corrosion Prevention
Stainless Steel LM Guide
In a vacuum environment, use a stainless
steel LM Guide, which is highly corrosion
resistant.
Stainless Steel
High Temperature LM Guide LM Guide
If high temperature is predicted due to
baking, use a High Temperature LM Guide,
which is highly resistant to heat and
corrosion.
■Highly Corrosion Resistant LM Guide
Supported
models
HSR SR HRW HR RSR
This LM Guide uses austenite stainless
steel, which has a high anti-corrosion
effect, in the LM rail.
Vacuum Grease
Oil-Free
In environments susceptible to liquid lubricants, a
lubrication method other than grease or oil is required.
■Dry Lubricant
Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film
Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film is a fully dry lubricant developed
Oil-Free LM Guide
for use under atmospheric to high-vacuum environments.
It has superior characteristics in load carrying capacity, wear
resistance and sealability to other lubrication systems.
B1-34
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-354 A1-370 A1-380
HSR-M1VV SR-MS
A1-396 A1-404
HSR-M2
A1-390
HSR SR HRW
A1-276 A1-250
SR-MS
A1-404
B1-35
506E
Corrosion
Prevention
As with clean room applications, it is
necessary to increase corrosion
resistance through material selection and Stainless Steel
surface treatment. LM Guide
Surface Treatment
B1-36
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-106 A1-138 A1-148
HSR SR HRW
A1-276 A1-250
HSR-M2
A1-390
THK AP-HC
Treatment
B0-20
THK AP-C
Treatment
B0-20
THK AP-CF
Treatment
B0-20
B1-37
506E
High Speed
In a high speed environment, it is
necessary to apply an optimum Caged Ball LM Guide
lubrication method that reduces
heat generation during high speed
operation and increases grease Supported SHS SSR SVR/SVS
retention.
models
SHW SRS SCR EPF
Grease
B1-38
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-94 A1-106 A1-118 A1-138
SRS SCR EPF
QZ Lubricator
for the LM Guide
A1-502
A24-7 A24-20
B1-39
506E
Supported
SSR SHW SRS HSR SR
■Impact of Low Temperature on Resin Components models
HRW HR RSR
Stainless Steel LM Guide
The endplate (ball circulation path normally
made of resin) of the LM block is made of
stainless steel.
■Grease
Use THK AFC Grease, with which the rolling
resistance of the system little is consistent
even at low temperature.
Low Temperature
Grease
Micro Motion
Micro strokes cause the oil film to break, resulting in
poor lubrication and early wear. In such cases, select a
grease with which the oil film strength is high and an oil
film can easily be formed.
■Grease Grease
THK AFC Grease
AFC Grease is a urea-based grease that excels
in oil film strength and wear resistance.
B1-40
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-354 A1-370 A1-380 A1-396
A1-276 A1-250
B0-20
A24-10
A24-10
B1-41
506E
LM Guide
Foreign Matter
If foreign matter enters the LM system, it will
+Metal scraper
cause abnormal wear and shorten the service
life. Therefore, it is necessary to prevent such +Contact scraper LaCS
entrance of foreign matter.
Especially in an environment containing +Cap GC, etc.
small foreign matter or a water-soluble
coolant that a telescopic cover or a bellows
cannot remove, it is necessary to attach a
contamination protection accessory capable
of efficiently removing foreign matter.
QZ Lubricator
LaCS
■QZ Lubricator
Caged Roller LM Guide
QZ Lubricator is a lubrication system that
feeds the right amount of lubricant by +Metal scraper
closely contacting its highly oil-impregnated
fiber net to the ball raceway. +Contact scraper LaCS
■Metal Cap Dedicated for LM Rail Mounting Holes GC Cap +Cap GC, etc.
GC cap is a metallic cap that plugs the LM
rail mounting hole (article compliant with the
RoHS Directives). It prevents the entrance of
foreign material and coolant from the LM rail QZ Lubricator
■Protector
The protector minimizes the entrance of B1-103
foreign material even in harsh environ-
ments where foreign material such as fine Supported
SRG
models
particles and liquids are present.
B1-42
506E
Point of Selection
Setting Conditions
LM Guide
A1-94 A1-106 A1-138
SRS SVR/SVS
A1-178 A1-220
A1-416
B1-43
506E
Selecting a Type
Types of LM Guides
THK offers a wide array of types and dimensions with LM Guides as standard so that you can select
the optimal product for any application. With the unit structure of each model, you can easily obtain
high running accuracy with no clearance simply by mounting the product on a plane surface with
bolts. We have a proven track record and know-how in extensive applications with LM Guides.
* For specification tables for each model, please see “A Product Descriptions.”
B1-44
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
LM Guide
External dimensions (mm)
Features Major application
Height Width
● Long service life, long-term ● Thin, compact design, large ● Surface grinder table
24 to 48 34 to 70 maintenance-free operation radial load capacity ● Tool grinder table
● Low dust generation, low noise, ● Superb in planar running accuracy ● Electric discharge machine
24 to 33 34 to 48 acceptable running sound ● Superb capability of ● Printed circuit board
● Superbly high speed absorbing mounting error drilling machine
● Smooth motion in all ● Stainless steel type also ● Chip mounter
24 to 33 52 to 73 mounting orientations available as standard ● High-speed transfer
equipment
24 to 135 34 to 250 ● Traveling unit of robots
● Machining center
● NC lathe
24 to 48 34 to 70 ● Five axis milling machine
● Conveyance system
24 to 48 34 to 70 ● Mold guide of pressing
● Thin, compact design, large radial load capacity machines
● Superb in planar running accuracy ● Inspection equipment
24 to 48 34 to 70 ● Testing machine
● Superb capability of absorbing mounting error
● Stainless steel type also available as standard ● Food-related machine
24 to 68 52 to 140 ● Type M1, achieving max service temperature of 150℃, also ● Medical equipment
available ● 3D measuring instrument
● Packaging machine
24 to 48 52 to 100 ● Injection molding machine
● Woodworking machine
24 to 48 52 to 100 ● Ultra precision table
● Semiconductor/liquid
crystal manufacturing
24 to 48 52 to 100 equipment
24 to 28 34 to 42 ● Photolithography machine
● Minimum generation of outgases (water, organic matter)
● Organic EL display
● Small amount of particles generated
manufacturing machine
24 to 28 34 to 42 ● Can be used at high temperature (up to 150℃)
● Ion implantation equipment
B1-45
506E
* For specification tables for each model, please see “A Product Descriptions.”
B1-46
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
31 to 105 72 to 260
31 to 105 72 to 260
● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
LM Guide
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● High vibration resistance and impact resistance due to
improved damping characteristics
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Thin, compact design, large radial load capacity
● Superb in planar running accuracy ● Machining center
● NC lathe
31 to 105 50 to 200 ● Grinding machine
● Five axis milling
machine
31 to 105 50 to 200 ● Jig borer
● Drilling machine
31 to 75 72 to 170 ● NC milling machine
● Long service life, long-term maintenance-free operation
● Horizontal milling
● Low dust generation, low noise, acceptable running sound
machine
31 to 75 72 to 170 ● Superbly high speed
● Mold processing
● Smooth motion in all mounting orientations
machine
● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
31 to 75 50 to 126 ● Graphite working
● Low profile, compact 4-way type
machine
● High vibration resistance and impact resistance due to
● Electric discharge
31 to 75 50 to 126 improved damping characteristics
machine
● Wire-cut electric
● Long service life, long-term ● 4-way type discharge machine
48 to 70 100 to 140 maintenance-free operation ● High vibration resistance
● Low dust generation, low and impact resistance
48 to 70 100 to 140 noise, acceptable running due to improved damping
sound characteristics
● Superbly high speed ● Has dimensions almost the
55 to 80 70 to 100 ● Smooth motion in all same as that of the full-ball
mounting orientations type LM Guide model HSR,
55 to 80 70 to 100 ● Ultra-heavy load capacity which is practically a global
optimal for machine tools standard size
B1-47
506E
* For specification tables for each model, please see “A Product Descriptions.”
B1-48
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
24 to 70 47 to 140
● Long service life, long-term maintenance-free operation
30 to 120 63 to 250 ● Low noise, acceptable running sound
● Superbly high speed
LM Guide
24 to 80 34 to 100 ● Smooth motion due to prevention of rollers from skewing
● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
30 to 90 44 to 126
● Machining center
44 to 63 100 to 140 ● NC lathe
● Grinding machine
44 to 75 100 to 170 ● Long service life, long-term maintenance-free operation ● Five axis milling
machine
● Low noise, acceptable running sound
● Jig borer
44 to 63 70 to 100 ● Superbly high speed
● Drilling machine
● Smooth motion due to prevention of rollers from skewing
● NC milling machine
● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
44 to 75 70 to 126 ● Horizontal milling
● Low center of gravity, ultra-high rigidity
machine
● Mold processing
70 to 150 135 to 300 machine
● Graphite working
machine
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Electric discharge
machine
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Wire-cut electric
discharge machine
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Ultra-heavy load capacity optimal for machine tools
● High vibration resistance and impact resistance due to
improved damping characteristics
31 to 105 72 to 260 ● Low-Profile compact design, 4-way equal load
31 to 105 50 to 200
31 to 105 50 to 200
● Machining center
● NC lathe
24 to 90 47 to 170 ● XYZ axes of heavy
cutting machine tools
● Grinding head feeding
axis of grinding
machines
24 to 90 47 to 170 ● Components requiring a
heavy moment and high
accuracy
● NC milling machine
● Long service life, long-term maintenance-free operation ● Horizontal milling
24 to 90 34 to 126 ● Low dust generation, low noise, acceptable running sound machine
● Superbly high speed ● Gantry five axis milling
● Smooth motion in all mounting orientations machine
● Heavy load, high rigidity ● Z axis of electric
● Has dimensions almost the same as that of the full-ball type discharge machines
LM Guide model HSR, which is practically a global standard ● Wire-cut electric
24 to 90 34 to 126 size discharge machine
● Superb capability of absorbing mounting error ● Car elevator
● Food-related machine
● Testing machine
● Vehicle doors
28 to 80 34 to 100 ● Printed circuit board
drilling machine
● ATC
● Construction equipment
● Shield machine
28 to 80 34 to 100 ● Semiconductor/liquid
crystal manufacturing
equipment
B1-49
506E
LM Guide for
Medium-to-Low HSR-M1VV ▶A1-400 8.33 13.5
Vacuum
Full-Complement
LM Guides -
JR-B ▶A1-328 19.9 to 88.5 34.4 to 137
special LM rail
types
* For specification tables for each model, please see “A Product Descriptions.”
B1-50
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
24 to 110 47 to 215
24 to 48 47 to 100
● Machining center
LM Guide
● NC lathe
30 to 110 63 to 215
● XYZ axes of heavy cutting ma-
chine tools
30 to 48 63 to 100
● Grinding head feeding axis
of grinding machines
30 to 110 63 to 215
● Components requiring a
heavy moment and high ac-
30 to 145 63 to 350
curacy
● NC milling machine
24 to 110 47 to 215
● Heavy load, high rigidity ● Horizontal milling machine
● Practically a global standard size ● Gantry five axis milling ma-
24 to 48 47 to 100 ● Superb capability of absorbing mounting error chine
● Stainless steel type also available as standard ● Z axis of electric discharge
30 to 110 63 to 215 ● Type M1, achieving max service temperature of 150℃,
also available machines
● Type M2, with high corrosion resistance, also available ● Wire-cut electric discharge
30 to 48 63 to 100 (Basic dynamic load rating: 2.33 to 5.57 kN) machine
(Basic static load rating: 2.03 to 5.16 kN) ● Car elevator
30 to 110 63 to 215
● Food-related machine
● Testing machine
30 to 145 63 to 350
● Vehicle doors
● Printed circuit board drilling
11 to 110 16 to 156
machine
● ATC
28 to 55 34 to 70 ● Construction equipment
● Shield machine
30 to 110 44 to 156 ● Semiconductor/liquid crystal
manufacturing equipment
30 to 55 44 to 70
B1-51
506E
Full-Complement
LM Guide CSR ▶A1-314 8.33 to 80.4 13.5 to 127.5
orthogonal type
Straight sec-
tion
Full-ball Straight - 4.23 to 66.7
HMG ▶A1-344 2.56 to 66.2
Curved Guide Curved sec-
tion
0.44 to 36.2
Caged Ball LM
Guides EPF ▶A1-174 0.90 to 3.71 1.60 to 5.88
Finite stroke
Full-Complement
Ball LM Guide -
separate types GSR-T ▶A1-294 5.69 to 25.1 8.43 to 33.8
Interchangeable
Full-Complement Ball
LM Guides -
GSR-R ▶A1-302 10.29 to 25.1 12.65 to 33.8
LM rail-rack intergrated
type
* For specification tables for each model, please see “A Product Descriptions.”
B1-52
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
LM Guide
● Optical measuring ● Printed circuit board
maintenance-free operation instrument assembler
● Low dust generation, low noise, ● Automatic lathe ● Machine tool table
acceptable running sound ● Inspection equipment ● Electric discharge
● Superbly high speed ● Cartesian coordinate machine
● A compact XY structure is allowed due to robot ● XY axes of horizontal
an XY orthogonal, single-piece LM block ● Bonding machine machining center
47 to 118 38.8 to 129.8 ● Since a saddle-less structure
is allowed, the machine can be
lightweighted and compactly designed
● Long service life, long-term
12 to 50 40 to 162 maintenance-free operation
● Low dust generation, low noise,
acceptable running sound ● Z axis of IC printed ● APC
● Superbly high speed circuit board drilling ● Semiconductor/liquid
● Smooth motion in all mounting orientationsmachine crystal manufacturing
12 to 50 30 to 130 ● Wide, low center of gravity, space saving structure
● Z axis of small electric equipment
discharge machine
● Stainless steel type also available as standard ● Measuring instrument
● Loader ● Wafer transfer
● Machining center equipment
17 to 60 60 to 200 ● 4-way equal load, thin and highly ● NC lathe ● Construction equipment
rigid ● Robot ● Railroad vehicle
● Wide, low center of gravity, space ● Wire-cut electric
saving structure discharge machine
● Stainless steel type also available
12 to 50 30 to 130 as standard
B1-53
506E
Full Complement
Ball LM Guide - MX ▶A1-320 0.59 to 2.04 1.1 to 3.21
orthogonal type
Circular arc types
Full-Complement
HCR ▶A1-336 4.7 to 141 8.53 to 215
Ball LM Guides
Self-aligning
types
Full-Complement
NSR-TBC ▶A1-350 9.41 to 90.8 18.6 to 152
Ball LM Guides
* For specification tables for each model, please see “A Product Descriptions.”
B1-54
506E
Point of Selection
Selecting a Type
LM Guide
9 to 16 25 to 60 ● Smooth motion in all mounting orientations ● Wafer transfer ● Plotting machine
● Stainless steel type also available equipment ● Feed mechanism of IC
as standard ● Printed circuit board bonding machine
12 to 16 30 to 60 ● Lightweight and compact assembly table ● Inspection equipment
4 to 25 8 to 46
● Stainless steel type also available
10 to 25 20 to 46 as standard
● Long type with increased load
4 to 25 8 to 46 capacity also offered as standard
● Type M1, achieving max service ● IC/LSI manufacturing machine
temperature of 150℃, also ● Hard disc drive
10 to 25 20 to 46 available ● Slide unit of OA equipment
● Wafer transfer equipment
8 to 16 17 to 32 ● Printed circuit board assembly table
● Medical equipment
● Electronic components of electron microscope
4.5 to 16 12 to 60 ● Optical stage
● Stepper
● Stainless steel type also available ● Plotting machine
12 to 16 30 to 60 as standard ● Feed mechanism of IC bonding machine
● Long type with increased load ● Inspection equipment
4.5 to 16 12 to 60 capacity also offered as standard
● Type M1, achieving max service
temperature of 150℃, also
12 to 16 30 to 60 available
9 to 16 25 to 60
● IC/LSI manufacturing ● Feed mechanism of IC
machine bonding machine
● A compact XY structure is allowed ● Inspection equipment
● Printed circuit board
due to an XY orthogonal, ● Slide unit of OA assembly table
10 to 14.5 15.2 to 30.2 single-piece LM block equipment ● Medical equipment
● Stainless steel type also available ● Wafer transfer
● Electronic components
as standard equipment of electron microscope
● Optical stage
● Circular motion guide in a 4-way ● Large swivel base ● X-Ray machine
equal load design ● Pendulum vehicle for ● CT scanner
● Highly accurate circular motion railroad ● Medical equipment
without play ● Pantagraph ● Stage setting
18 to 90 39 to 170 ● Allows an efficient design with the ● Control unit ● Car elevator
LM block placed in the loading ● Optical measuring ● Amusement machine
point machine ● Turntable
● Large circular motion easily achieved ● Tool grinder ● Tool changer
● Can be used in rough mount due ● XY axes of ordinary industrial machinery
to self-aligning on the fit surface of ● Various conveyance systems
the case ● Automated warehouse
40 to 105 70 to 175 ● Preload can be adjusted ● Palette changer
● Can be mounted on a black steel ● Automatic coating machine
sheet ● Various welding machines
B1-55
506E
LM rail
Maximum applied load on a ball
Ball
displacement line Load distribution curve
Load distribution curve
B1-56
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
Equivalent Factor
Since the rated load is equivalent to the permissible moment, the equivalent factor to be multiplied
when equalizing the MA, MB and MC moments to the applied load per block is obtained by dividing
the rated loads in the corresponding directions.
With those models other than 4-way equal load types, however, the load ratings in the 4 directions
differ from each other. Therefore, the equivalent factor values for the MA and MC moments also differ
depending on whether the direction is radial or reverse radial.
LM Guide
Equivalent Factors for the MA Moment
PR=KAR•MA
Equivalent in the radial direction
PL=KAL•MA
Equivalent in the reverse-radial direction
C0 C0L
= =1
KAR•MA KAL•MA
PT=KB•MB
Equivalent in the lateral direction
PT=KB•MB
Equivalent in the lateral direction
Fig.4 Equivalent Factors for the MB Moment
C0T
=1
KB•MB
B1-57
506E
PR=KCR•MC
Equivalent in the radial direction
PL=KCL•MC
Equivalent in the reverse-radial direction
C0 C0L
= =1
KCR•MC KCL•MC
B1-58
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
Example of calculation
When one LM block is used
Model No.: SSR20XV1
No.3 No.4
Gravitational acceleration g=9.8 (m/s2)
Mass m=10 (kg)
LM Guide
ℓ1=200(mm)
ℓ2=100(mm) No.2 No.1
ℓ1 ℓ2
m m
When two LM blocks are used in close contact with each other
Model No.: SVS25R2
Gravitational acceleration g=9.8 (m/s2) No.3 No.4
Mass m=5 (kg)
ℓ1=200(mm)
ℓ2=150(mm) No.2 No.1
ℓ1 ℓ2
m m
Fig.7 When Two LM Blocks are Used in Close Contact with Each Other
mg mg•ℓ2 49 49×150
No.1 P1= +KAR2•mg•ℓ1+KCR• = +0.0188×49×200+0.0814× =507.9 (N)
2 2 2 2
mg mg•ℓ2 49 49×150
No.2 P2= –KAL2•mg•ℓ1+KCR• = –0.0158×49×200+0.0814× =168.8 (N)
2 2 2 2
mg mg•ℓ2 49 49×150
No.3 P3= –KAL2•mg•ℓ1–KCL• = –0.0158×49×200–0.0684× =–381.7 (N)
2 2 2 2
mg mg•ℓ2 49 49×150
No.4 P4= +KAR2•mg•ℓ1–KCL• = +0.0188×49×200–0.0684× =–42.6 (N)
2 2 2 2
Note1) Since an LM Guide used in vertical installation receives only a moment load, there is no need to apply a load force
(mg).
B1-59
506E
[Double-axis Use]
Setting Conditions
Set the conditions needed to calculate the LM system’s applied load and service life in hours.
The conditions consist of the following items.
(1) Mass: m (kg)
(2) Direction of the working load
(3) Position of the working point (e.g., center of gravity): ℓ2, ℓ3, h1(mm)
(4) Thrust position: ℓ4, h2(mm)
(5) LM system arrangement: ℓ0, ℓ1(mm)
(No. of units and axes)
(6) Velocity diagram
Speed: V (mm/s)
Time constant: tn (s)
Acceleration: n(mm/s2)
V
(αn = tn )
Duty cycle
ℓ1
ℓ2
Speed (mm/s)
mg
V
h 1 ℓ0
h2
ℓ3 tn t1 tn (s)
ℓ4 ℓS (mm)
Velocity diagram
Fig.8 Condition
B1-60
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
LM Guide
Calculate the load applied to the LM Guide in each of the examples 1 to 10 shown below.
m : Mass (kg)
ℓn : Distance (mm)
Fn : External force (N)
Pn : Applied load (radial/reverse radial direction) (N)
PnT : Applied load (lateral directions) (N)
g : Gravitational acceleration (m/s2)
(g =9.8m/s2)
V : Speed (m/s)
tn : Time constant (s)
n : Acceleration (m/s2)
V
(αn = tn )
[Example]
Condition Applied Load Equation
Horizontal mount
(with the block traveling) mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P1 = + –
Uniform motion or dwell 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
P3 ℓ1
ℓ2 mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
mg P2 = – –
P2 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
P4
1
mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P3 = – +
P1 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
ℓ0
ℓ3 mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P4 = + +
4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P2 P2 = – +
P4 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
2
P1 mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
P3 = – –
ℓ0 4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
mg ℓ2 mg mg•ℓ2 mg•ℓ3
ℓ3 P4 = + –
4 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ1
B1-61
506E
Vertical mount
Uniform motion or dwell
ℓ2
P4 mg•ℓ2
mg P1 = P4 = –
2•ℓ0
P1T
mg•ℓ2
P1 P2 = P3 =
ℓ0 2•ℓ0
3 F
mg•ℓ3
ℓ3 P1T = P4T =
2•ℓ0
P2 mg•ℓ3
P2T = P3T = –
2•ℓ0
P2T
ℓ1
E.g.: Vertical axis of industrial
robot, automatic coating
machine, lifter
Wall mount
Uniform motion or dwell
ℓ0
P2T
mg•ℓ3
ℓ2 P2 ℓ1 P1 = P2 = –
2•ℓ1
P1T
ℓ3 mg•ℓ3
P3 = P4 =
P1 2•ℓ1
4
mg mg•ℓ2
P1T = P4T = +
4 2•ℓ0
P3
mg mg•ℓ2
P3T P2T = P3T = –
4 2•ℓ0
mg
P4
P4T
B1-62
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
LM Guide
ℓ1
–ℓ1
P2
mg
P3 mg mg•ℓ1
P1 to P4 (max) = +
P1 4 2•ℓ0
5 mg mg•ℓ1
P4 P1 to P4 (min) = –
4 2•ℓ0
ℓ0
ℓ2
E.g.: XY table
sliding fork
B1-63
506E
tn P1 = P4 = +
4 2•ℓ0
mg m•α 3•ℓ2
P2 = P3 = –
4 2•ℓ0
t1 t2 t3 Time (s) m•α 3•ℓ3
P1T = P4T = –
2•ℓ0
Velocity diagram E.g.: Conveyance truck
m•α 3•ℓ3
P2T = P3T =
2•ℓ0
B1-64
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Applied Load
LM Guide
P1T P1T = P4T =
2•ℓ0
ℓ0 P1 m (g+α 1) ℓ3
P2T = P3T = –
F 2•ℓ0
ℓ3 During uniform motion
P2 mg•ℓ2
V P1 = P4 = –
P2T αn = 2•ℓ0
tn mg•ℓ2
9 P2 = P3 =
ℓ1 2•ℓ0
mg•ℓ3
P1T = P4T =
2•ℓ0
Speed V (m/s)
mg•ℓ3
P2T = P3T = –
2•ℓ0
t1 t2 t3 Time (s) During deceleration
Velocity diagram m (g – α 3) ℓ2
P1 = P4 = –
E.g.: Conveyance lift 2•ℓ0
m (g – α 3) ℓ2
P2 = P3 =
2•ℓ0
m (g – α 3) ℓ3
P1T = P4T =
2•ℓ0
m (g – α 3) ℓ3
P2T = P3T = –
2•ℓ0
B1-65
506E
– 1/2π 1/2π
0
Radial Type
– 1/2π 1/2π
B1-66
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Equivalent Load
PE=X•PR(L)+Y•PT
LM Guide
PE : Equivalent load (N) PL PR
·Radial direction
·Reverse radial direction PT PT
PL : Reverse radial load (N)
PT : Lateral load (N)
X,Y : Equivalent factor
(see Table9 on A1-60)
Fig.9 Equivalent of Load of the LM Guide
B1-67
506E
B1-68
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Average Load
LM Guide
under varying loads applied to the LM blocks.
Pm
Load (P)
P2
Pn
L1 L2 Ln
B1-69
506E
1
Pm (Pmin + 2•Pmax) …………(3)
3
Pmin : Minimum load (N)
Pmax : Maximum load (N)
Pmax
Pm
Load (P)
Pmin
Pmax Pmax
Pm Pm
Load (P)
Load (P)
B1-70
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Average Load
LM Guide
(m/s)
V
mg
ℓ1
No.1 No.2
v ℓ0
α1 = (m/s
t1
2
)
t1 t2 t1 mg
(S)
S1 S2 S1
(mm) ℓ2
ℓS
(mm)
Ball screw
[Average load]
3
1
(Pa1 •s1 + P1 •s2 + Pd1 •s3)
3 3 3
Pm1 =
ℓS
3
1
(Pa2 •s1 + P2 •s2 + Pd2 •s3)
3 3 3
Pm2 =
ℓS
3
1
(Pa3 •s1 + P3 •s2 + Pd3 •s3)
3 3 3
Pm3 =
ℓS
3
1 Note) Pan and Pdn represent loads applied to each LM block.
(Pa4 •s1 + P4 •s2 + Pd4 •s3)
3 3 3
Pm4 =
ℓS The suffix “n” indicates the block number in the dia-
gram above.
B1-71
506E
Example of Calculating the Average Load (2) - When the Rails are Movable
No.1 No.2
ℓ1 ℓ2
mg
ℓ0
[Average load]
1
Pm1 = (2•|P ℓ1|+| Pr1|)
3
1
Pm2 = (2•|P ℓ2|+| Pr2|)
3
1
Pm3 = (2•|P ℓ3|+| Pr3|)
3
1
Pm4 = (2•|P ℓ4|+| Pr4|)
3
Note) Pℓn and Prn represent loads applied to each LM block.
The suffix “n” indicates the block number in the dia-
gram above.
B1-72
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Nominal Life
LM Guide
Nominal Life Equation for an LM Guide Using Balls
L = ( f •ff • f
H T
W
C
•
C
PC ) 50
1.57
L = ( F0
fW •PC
) 50
B1-73
506E
10
f H • fT • fC
L = ( fW
•
C
PC
)3
100
L 106
Lh =
2 ℓS n1 60
Lh : Service life time (h)
ℓs : Stroke length (mm)
n1 : Number of reciprocations per minute
(min-1)
B1-74
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Nominal Life
Hardness factor fH
sic dynamic load rating and the basic static load 0.7
rating decrease. Therefore, it is necessary to 0.6
LM Guide
multiply each rating by the respective hardness 0.5
factor (fH). 0.4
Since the LM Guide has sufficient hardness, the 0.3
fH value for the LM Guide is normally 1.0 unless 0.2
otherwise specified. 0.1
60 50 40 30 20 10
Raceway hardness (HRC)
Fig.10 Hardness Factor (fH)
[fT:Temperature Factor]
If the temperature of the environment surround-
ing the operating LM Guide exceeds 100℃, 1.0
Temperature factor fT
B1-75
506E
B1-76
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Nominal Life
Example of Calculating the Nominal Life (1) - with Horizontal Mount and
High-speed Acceleration
[Conditions]
Model No. : HSR35LA2SS+2500LP-Ⅱ
(basic dynamic load rating: C =50.2 kN)
LM Guide
(basic static load rating: C0=81.5 kN)
Mass : m1 =800 kg Distance: ℓ0=600 mm
m2 =500 kg ℓ1=400 mm
Speed : V =0.5 m/s ℓ2=120 mm
Time : t1 =0.05 s ℓ3=50 mm
t2 =2.8 s ℓ4=200 mm
t3 =0.15 s ℓ5=350 mm
Acceleration : 1 =10 m/s2
3 =3.333 m/s2
Stroke : ℓS =1450 mm
Gravitational acceleration g=9.8 (m/s2)
ℓ2
No.4 No.3
m2g
ℓ1
ℓ3 m1g
No.1 No.2
V ℓ0
(m/s)
m1g
t1 t2 t3 (s)
s1 s2 s3 (mm)
ℓS (mm) m2g ℓ5
ℓ4
Ball screw
Fig.12 Condition
B1-77
506E
B1-78
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Nominal Life
LM Guide
m1• α3•ℓ3
Ptℓd4 = + = + 111.1 N
2•ℓ0
B1-79
506E
B1-80
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Nominal Life
LM Guide
= 2940.1N
3
1
Pm2 = (PEℓ a23•S1 + PE23•S2 + PEℓ d23•S3 + PEra23•S1 + PE23•S2 + PErd23•S3)
2•ℓS
3
1
= (7958.93×12.5+44593×1400+3514.53×37.5+1625.73×12.5+44593×1400+5625.73×37.5)
2×1450
= 4492.2N
3
1
Pm3 = (PEℓ a33•S1 + PE33•S2 + PEℓ d33•S3 + PEra33•S1 + PE33•S2 + PErd33•S3)
2•ℓS
3
1
= (6978.93×12.5+34793×1400+2534.53×37.5+645.73×12.5+34793×1400+4645.73×37.5)
2×1450
= 3520.4N
3
1
Pm4 = (PEℓ a43•S1 + PE43•S2 + PEℓ d43•S3 + PEra43•S1 + PE43•S2 + PErd43•S3)
2•ℓS
3
1
= (1588.93×12.5+19113×1400+3077.73×37.5+5410.93×12.5+19113×1400+966.53×37.5)
2×1450
= 1985.5N
(where f w = 1.5)
Therefore, the service life of the LM Guide used in a machine or equipment under the conditions
stated above is equivalent to the nominal life of the second LM block, which is 20,600 km.
B1-81
506E
Ball screw
No.3 No.2
m1g m1g
ℓ0
m 0g m 0g
m2g
m2g
No.4 No.1
ℓ2 ℓ4
ℓ5
Fig.13 Condition
B1-82
506E
Point of Selection
Calculating the Nominal Life
LM Guide
m1g•ℓ4 m2g•ℓ5 m0g•ℓ3
Pu3 = – – – = – 1355.6 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ4 m2g•ℓ5 m0g•ℓ3
Pu4 = + + + = + 1355.6 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
Load applied to each LM block in the lateral direction Ptun during ascent
m1g•ℓ2 m2g•ℓ2 m0g•ℓ1
Ptu1 = + + + = + 375.7 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ2 m2g•ℓ2 m0g•ℓ1
Ptu2 = – – – = – 375.7 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ2 m2g•ℓ2 m0g•ℓ1
Ptu3 = – – – = – 375.7 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ2 m2g•ℓ2 m0g•ℓ1
Ptu4 = + + + = + 375.7 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
During Descent
Load applied to each LM block in the radial direction Pdn during descent
m1g•ℓ4 m2g•ℓ5
Pd1 = + + = + 898.3 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ4 m2g•ℓ5
Pd2 = – – = – 898.3 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ4 m2g•ℓ5
Pd3 = – – = – 898.3 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ4 m2g•ℓ5
Pd4 = + + = + 898.3 N
2•ℓ0 2•ℓ0
Load applied to each LM block in the lateral direction Ptdn during descent
m1g•ℓ2 m2g•ℓ2
Ptd1 = +
2•ℓ0
+
2•ℓ0 = + 245 N
m1g•ℓ2 m2g•ℓ2
Ptd2 = – 2•ℓ0 – = – 245 N
2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ2 m2g•ℓ2
Ptd3 = – 2•ℓ0 – = – 245 N
2•ℓ0
m1g•ℓ2 m2g•ℓ2
Ptd4 = + 2•ℓ0 + = + 245 N
2•ℓ0
B1-83
506E
Therefore, the service life of the LM Guide used in a machine or equipment under the conditions
stated above is 68,200 km.
B1-84
506E
Point of Selection
Predicting the Rigidity
LM Guide
application. In general, selecting a negative clearance (i.e., a preload* is applied) while taking into
account possible vibrations and impact generated from reciprocating motion favorably affects the
service life and the accuracy.
For specific radial clearances, contact THK. We will help you select the optimal clearance according
to the conditions.
The clearances of all LM Guide models (except model HR, GSR and GSR-R, which are separate
types) are adjusted as specified before shipment, and therefore they do not need further preload ad-
justment.
*Preload is an internal load applied to the rolling elements (balls, rollers, etc.) of an LM block in advance in order to increase
its rigidity.
Table4 Types of Radial Clearance
• Automatic packaging machine • Automatic coating machine • Grinding stone feed axis of
• XY axes of general industrial • Industrial robot grinding machine
machinery • various kinds of material high • Milling machine
• Automatic sash-manufacturing speed feeder • Vertical/horizontal boring ma-
machine • NC drilling machine chine
• Welding machine • Vertical axis of general indus- • Tool rest guide
• Flame cutting machine trial machinery • Vertical axis of machine tool
• Tool changer • Printed circuit board drilling
• Various kinds of material feeder machine
• Electric discharge machine
• Measuring instrument
• Precision XY table
B1-85
506E
Rigidity
When the LM Guide receives a load, its rolling element, LM blocks and LM rails are elastically de-
formed within a permissible load range. The ratio between the displacement and the load is called
rigidity value. (Rigidity values are obtained using the equation shown below.) The LM Guide’s rigidity
increases according to the magnitude of the preload. Fig.14 shows rigidity difference between nor-
mal, C1 and C0 clearances.
The effect of a preload for a 4-way equal load type is translated into the calculated load approx. 2.8
times greater than the magnitude of the preload.
2δ 0 Normal clearance
Clearance C1
Deflection
δ0 Clearance C0
P0 Load 2.8P0
P0 : Magnitude of clearance C0
P
K=
δ
B1-86
506E
Point of Selection
Determining the Accuracy
LM Guide
used on one rail or when 2 or more rails are mounted on the same plane.
For details, see “Accuracy Standard for Each Model” on A1-76 to A1-86.
[Running of Parallelism]
It refers to the tolerance for parallelism between the LM block and the LM rail reference surface
when the LM block travels the whole length of the LM rail with the LM rail secured on the reference
reference surface using bolts.
[Difference in Height M]
Indicates a difference between the minimum and maximum values of height (M) of each of the LM
blocks used on the same plane in combination.
Serial number
Note2) Accuracy measurements each represent the average value of the central point or the central area of the LM block.
Note3) The LM rail is smoothly curved so that the required accuracy is easily achieved by pressing the rail to the reference
surface of the machine.
If it is mounted on a less rigid base such as an aluminum base, the curve of the rail will affect the accuracy of the ma-
chine. Therefore, it is necessary to define straightness of the rail in advance.
B1-87
506E
● ● ●
Punching press ● ●
Laser beam machine ● ● ●
Woodworking machine ● ● ● ● ●
NC drilling machine ● ●
Tapping center ● ●
Palette changer ●
ATC ● ● ●
Wire cutting machine ● ●
Dressing machine ● ●
Industrial
Cartesian coordinate ● ● ●
robot
Cylindrical coordinate ● ●
Wire bonding machine ● ●
Semiconductor
manufacturing
equipment
Prober ● ●
Electronic component inserter ● ●
Printed circuit board drilling ● ● ●
machine
Injection molding machine ● ●
3D measuring instrument ● ●
Office equipment ● ● ● ●
Other equipment
Conveyance system ● ● ● ●
XY table ● ● ●
Coating machine ● ● ● ●
Welding machine ● ● ● ●
Medical equipment ● ●
Digitizer ● ● ●
Inspection equipment ● ● ●
Ct7 : Grade Ct7 P : Precision grade
Ct5 : Grade Ct5 SP : Super precision grade
Normal : Normal grade UP : Ultra precision grade
H : High accuracy grade
B1-88
506E
LM Guide
[Marking on the Master LM Guide]
All LM rails mounted on the same plane are
marked with the same serial number. Of those
LM rails, the one marked with “KB” after the se-
rial number is the master LM rail. The LM block
on the master LM rail has its reference surface
Master LM Guide
finished to a designated accuracy, allowing it to
serve as the positioning reference for the table.
(See Fig.1.)
LM Guides of normal grade are not marked with
“KB.” Therefore, any one of the LM rails hav-
ing the same serial number can be used as the
master LM rail.
Subsidiary LM Guide
Y2F123 KB
Master mark
Serial number
Fig.1 Master LM Guide and Subsidiary LM Guide
THK logo
Reference surface
Line marking
Subsidiary LM Guide
Fig.2 Markings on the Reference Surface
B1-89
506E
Fig.3 Serial Number Marking and Combined Use of an LM Rail and LM Blocks
Subsidiary-rail axis
Reference surface Reference surface
Subsidiary-rail side
B
Rail datum plane
L
B Method for Securing
Master rail side the LM Rails at the Joint
B1-90
506E
Mounting Procedure
[Example of Mounting the LM Guide When an Impact Load is Applied to the Machine and therefore
Rigidity and High Accuracy are Required]
LM block set screw
Table
LM Guide
LM rail set screw
Base
Subsidiary-rail side Master rail side
B1-91
506E
B1-92
506E
[Example of Mounting the LM Guide When the Master LM Rail is not Provided with Set screws]
Table
LM Guide
Master rail side Base Subsidiary-rail side
Fig.12 When the Master LM Rail is not Provided with Set screws
Fig.13
Using a Straight-edge
Place straight-edges between the two rails, and
arrange the straight-edges in parallel with the
side reference surface of the master LM rail
using a dial gauge. Then, secure the mounting
bolts in order while achieving straightness of
the subsidiary rail with the straight edge as the
reference by using the dial gauge. (Fig.14)
Fig.14
B1-93
506E
Fig.15
Fig.16
Using a Jig
Use a jig like the one shown in Fig.17 to achieve
parallelism of the reference surface on the sub-
sidiary side against the side reference surface
of the master side from one end of the rail by
the mounting pitch, and at the same time, fully
fasten the mounting bolts in order. (Fig.17)
(a) (b)
Fig.17
B1-94
506E
[Example of Mounting the LM Guide When the Master LM Rail Does not Have a Reference Sur-
face]
Table
LM Guide
Base
Fig.18
Fig.19
Using a Straight-edge
After temporarily fastening the mounting bolts,
use a dial gauge to check the straightness of
the side reference surface of the LM rail from
the rail end, and at the same time, fully fasten
the mounting bolts.(Fig.20)
To mount the subsidiary LM rail, follow the pro-
cedure described on B1-93.
Fig.20
B1-95
506E
Torque wrench
Tension gauge
Fig.24
B1-96
506E
LM Guide
b. Using tapered gibs
When high accuracy and high rigidity are required, use tapered gibs 1) and 2).
1 2
B1-97
506E
Torque
wrench
LM rail A
Fig.28
Mounting jig
Base
LM rail
Fig.29
B1-98
506E
LM Guide
side face and top face of the other LM rail to
simultaneously adjust the parallelism and the
level, thus to complete mounting the LM rails.
Fig.30
Jointing LM Rails
When two or more LM rails are to be jointed, a
a side b side
special metal fitting as shown in Fig.31 is avail-
Dial gauge
able. For such applications, specify this fitting
when ordering the LM Guide (the rail will be Rail
tapped for attaching a joint fitting). G
Installation Procedure
(1) Temporarily fasten the rail presser bolt. Rail presser Bolt
(2) Secure rail A and the joint fitting with bolts C Rail A Rail B G
and D. a side
(3) Apply a dial gauge to side G of the joint be-
tween rails A and B. Adjust the left and right
level differences using bolt E and set screw b side
F on rail B. Nut
If bolt E is tightened, rail B will move toward Bolt C Bolt D Setscrew F
Rail presser Rail presser
b side. Joint fitting Bolt E
If set screw F is tightened, rail B will move Fig.31
toward a side.
(4) When the adjustment using set screw F is
finished, secure set screw F with the nut.
(5) Adjust and secure the vertical direction us-
ing the rail presser.
B1-99
506E
[Welding conditions]
Preheating temperature:200℃
Postheating temperature:350℃
Note) If the temperature exceeds 750℃, the LM rail may be
hardened again.
Joint
Fig.33 Method for Securing the LM Rails at the Joint Fig.34 Method for Securing the LM Rail Using a Pin as a Datum
Point
B1-100
506E
LM Guide
1) Measurement method using an auto-collimator 2) Measurement method using a dial gauge
B1-101
506E
B1-102
506E
LM Guide
Options
B1-103
506E
B1-104
506E
Options
Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS
LM Guide (Options)
For locations with adverse environment, Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS is available.
LaCS removes minute foreign material adhering to the LM rail in multiple stages and prevents it
from entering the LM block with laminated contact structure (3-layer scraper).
[Features]
● Since the 3 layers of scrapers fully contact the LM rail, LaCS is highly capable of removing minute
foreign material.
● Since it uses oil-impregnated, foam synthetic rubber with a self-lubricating function, low friction
resistance is achieved.
B1-105
506E
No.2
with
LaCS Not fractured at 5,000 km
0 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 Lip has not been fractured
B1-106
506E
Options
Side Scraper
Side Scraper
●For the supported models: models SVR/SVS
●For the resistance of side scraper, see A1-501.
●For the LM block dimension (dimension L) with side scraper attached, see A1-484.
●For notes regarding how to handle the side scraper, see B1-132.
LM Guide (Options)
Side scraper case Foreign
Route of entrance by foreign material material
from the side face of the LM block
Side scraper
Foreign material
Foreign material
Outline view
(Ex: in case of QZTTHHYY type)
[Features]
● Minimizes foreign material entering from the side of the LM Guide in a harsh environment.
● Demonstrates a dust protection effect in inverted or wall mount.
* The side scraper can accommodate various options of dust control accessories and lubrication accessories. For details,
contact THK.
B1-107
506E
Protector
●For the supported models: models SVR/SVS
●HH type (with LaCS) of models SVR/SVS is provided with the protector.
●For the LM block dimension (dimension L) with protector attached, see A1-484.
Outline view
(Ex: in case of QZTTHHYY type)
End plate LaCS
QZ Lubricator End seal
[Features]
● The protector minimizes the entrance of foreign material even in harsh environments where for-
eign material such as fine particles and liquids are present.
Note) Contact THK if you want to use the protector with other options.
B1-108
506E
Options
Light-Resistance Contact Seal LiCS
LM Guide (Options)
LiCS is a light sliding resistance contact seal. It is effective in removing dust on the raceway and re-
taining a lubricant such as grease. It achieves extremely low drag and smooth, stable motion.
LiCS
[Features]
Light-Resistance Contact Seal LiCS is a seal that uses a light-resistance material in its sealing ele-
ment and contacts the LM rail raceway to achieve low drag resistance. It is optimal for applications
where low drag resistance is required, such as semiconductor-related devices, inspection devices
and OA equipment all of which are used in favorable environments.
• Since the sealing element contacts the LM rail raceway, it is effective in removing dust on the
raceway.
• Use of oil-impregnated, expanded synthetic rubber, which has excellent self-lubricating property,
achieves low drag resistance.
SSR20 XW 2 GG C1 +600L P -Ⅱ
LM Guide Type of With LiCS seal LM rail length Symbol for No. of rails used
model LM block on both ends (in mm) on the same plane
number Radial clearance symbol Accuracy symbol
No. of LM blocks Normal grade (No Symbol) / High accuracy grade (H)
Normal (No symbol)
used on the same rail Light preload (C1) Precision grade (P) / Super precision grade (SP)
Medium preload (C0) Ultra precision grade (UP)
B1-109
506E
Dedicated bellows
●For the supported models, see the table of options by model number on A1-474.
●For the dedicated bellows dimensions, see A1-513 to A1-524.
Bellows
Dedicated LM Cover
●For the supported models, see the table of options by model number on A1-474.
●For the dedicated LM cover dimensions, see A1-526.
LM cover
B1-110
506E
Options
Cap C
Cap C
LM Guide (Options)
If any of the LM rail mounting holes of an LM Guide is filled with cutting chips or foreign material, they
may enter the LM block structure. Entrance of such foreign material can be prevented by covering each
LM rail mounting hole with the dedicated cap.
Since the dedicated cap C for LM rail mounting holes uses a special synthetic resin with high oil re-
sistance and high wear resistance, it is highly durable.
To attach the dedicated cap to the mounting hole, place a flat metal piece like one shown in Fig.1 on
the cap and gradually hammer in the cap until it is on the same level as the top face of the LM rail.
When attaching the dedicated cap C for LM rail mounting holes, do not remove any of the LM blocks
from the LM rail.
Plastic hammer
D
H Flat metal piece
Fig.1 Cap C
B1-111
506E
Cap GC
●For notes regarding how to handle the GC cap, see B1-133.
LM rail Cap GC
Cap GC
LM rail LM rail
mounting bolt
GC caps are metal caps designed to cover the mounting holes in LM rails (in compliance with RoHS di-
rectives).
In harsh environments, preventing any influx of coolant or foreign material from the top face of the
LM rail, coupled with the use of seals, will dramatically improve the contamination protection perfor-
mance for the LM guide.
[Features]
Eliminating gaps around the mounting Eliminates gaps
holes (countersunk holes)
The GC caps press into the mounting holes
(countersunk holes) so that there are no gaps.
B1-112
506E
Options
Cap GC
LM Guide (Options)
Normal (No symbol) Accuracy symbol
No. of LM blocks Contamination Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
used on the same rail protection accessory Medium preload (C0) Precision grade (P)/Super precision grade (SP)
Ultra precision grade (UP)
symbol
Note1) LM guides with GC caps are special rails.
Note2) They cannot be mounted on stainless steel LM rails or LM rails that have undergone surface treatment.
Note3) If this product will be used in special environments, such as in a vacuum or at very low or high temperatures, contact
THK.
Note4) GC caps are not sold individually. They are sold as a set with LM guides.
Note5) The openings of LM rail mounting holes are not chamfered. Take care not to injure your hands while working.
Note6) After fitting GC caps, the upper surface of the LM rail must be flattened and cleaned (wiped).
Note7) If you wish to fit GC caps for a single rail, use the sample model number configuration shown below.
(Example) SVR45LR2QZTTHHC0+1200LPGC With GC cap
* Add the symbol (GC) to the end of the model number.
Mounting method
The procedure for inserting a GC cap into a
mounting hole consists of using a flat aligning Plastic hammer
fitting to gradually punch the cap into the hole
until it is level with the upper surface of the LM Metal piece
rail, as shown in the figure. Fit GC caps without
removing the LM rail from the LM block.
B1-113
506E
Steel tape: SP
For the LM Guide, steel tapes are
available as a means of contamina-
Setscrew tion protection for machine tools.
By covering the LM rail mounting
holes with an ultra-thin stainless
steel (SUS304) plate, the steel tape
SP drastically increases sealability,
End piece: EP
thus to prevent the penetration of a
Tap for attaching bellows coolant or cutting chips from the top
Steel Tape SP face of the LM rail. (When mounting
the steel tape, end piece EP can
LM block be used as a means to secure the
cover.)
For the mounting method, see
LM block mounting/ B1-116.
removing jig Note) When mounting the steel tape,
the LM rail needs to be machined.
Indicate that the steel tape is
required when ordering the LM
Guide.
B1-114
506E
Options
Plate Cover SV Steel Tape SP
LM Guide (Options)
(2) Use an LM block mounting/removing jig to Fig.1
remove the LM block from the LM rail, and
then mount the fixing-jigs onto the LM rail.
(3) Temporarily secure either slide piece.
Insert either slide piece into one of the
fixing-jigs, then attach the slide piece to the LM rail
LM rail’s end face using the tension adjust-
ment bolt and gently secure the bolt until the Fig.2
bolt head is inside the fixing-jig.
(4) Temporarily secure the other slide piece.
Tension adjustment bolt
Temporarily secure the other slide piece in
the same manner as above.
(5) Apply tension to the plate cover.
Apply tension to the plate cover by evenly
securing the tension adjustment bolts on both Fig.3
ends of the LM rail. Make sure there is only a
small difference between the H and H’ dimen-
sions in Fig.5. If the difference is too large,
there may be no interference left on either
end.
(6) Mount the LM block on the LM rail.
Identity the reference surface of the LM rail
Fig.4
and the LM block, then insert the LM rail into
the LM block using the LM block mounting /
removing jig. H H’
Note1) When removing or the mounting the LM block, use
much care not to let the balls fall off.
Note2) The plate cover is an ultra-thin stainless steel
(SUS304) plate. When handing it, use much care
not to bend it.
Note3) The plate cover is available for models NR/NRS35
to 100. Fig.5
B1-115
506E
Fig.9
Steel tape
Do not make an acute angle
LM block
LM block mounting/removing jig
Fig.10
Steel tape: SP
Setscrew
End piece: EP
Tap for attaching a bellows
Fig.11
B1-116
506E
Options
QZ Lubricator
QZ Lubricator
●For the supported models, see the table of options by model number on A1-474.
●For the LM block dimension with QZ attached, see A1-505 to A1-508.
●For notes regarding how to handle the QZ, see B1-132.
LM Guide (Options)
QZ Lubricator feeds the right amount of lubricant to the raceway on the LM rail. This allows an oil
film to continuously be formed between the rolling element and the raceway, and drastically extends
the lubrication and maintenance intervals.
The structure of QZ Lubricator consists of three major components: (1) a heavy oil-impregnated fiber
net (function to store lubricant), (2) a high-density fiber net (function to apply lubricant to the race-
way) and (3) an oil-control plate (function to adjust oil flow). The lubricant contained in QZ Lubricator
is fed by the capillary phenomenon, which is used also in felt pens and many other products, as the
fundamental principle.
Case (2) High-density fiber net
(1) Heavy oil-impregnated fiber net
(End seal) Ball
QZ Lubricator
[Features]
● Since it supplements an oil loss, the lubrication maintenance interval can be significantly extended.
● Eco-friendly lubrication system that does not contaminate the surrounding area since it feeds the
right amount of lubricant to the ball raceway.
B1-117
506E
LM Guide: HSR35R1SS
Calculated service life of heavy load = 400 km
Condition Heavy load Medium load Light load
Grease lubrication only 465km Load 18.6kN 9.3kN 1.4kN
Heavy load
Grease + QZ Lubricator
Comparison of 0.332
SHW21QZ
lubricant
consumption
after traveling
5,000 km Forced lubrication 83.3
0 20 40 60 80 100
B1-118
506E
Options
QZ Lubricator
LM Guide (Options)
Load 8kN 6kN
Speed 60m/min
Standard Flaking occurs at 3,500km
Coolant Immersed 48 hrs, dried 96 hrs model
②
Foreign
Foundry dust (125 μm or less) 0 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 6000
material
Distance traveled (km)
Super Multi 68
Oiling cycle:
0.1cc/shot
Lubrication AFA Grease + QZ
Periodically
lubricated every
16 min
* When using the LM system under severe environment, use QZ Lubricator and Laminated Contact Scraper LaCS (see “Lam-
inated Contact Scraper LaCS” on B1-105) in combination.
B1-119
506E
Lubrication Adapter
[Features]
The dedicated lubrication adapter for models
Lubrication plate
NR-NRS is built in with a constant quantity dis-
tributor. Therefore, the adapter can accurately
feed a constant quantity of lubricant to each
raceway regardless of the mounting orientation. To lubrication
pump
The adapter is economical since it is capable of Lubrication plate
constantly feeding the optimum amount of lubri-
cant and helping eliminate the supply of surplus Constant quantity
lubricant. distributor
To provide pipe arrangement, simply connect an To lubrication pump
intermittent lubrication pump widely used for ordi-
nary machine tools to the greasing holes (M8) on Fig.1 Structural Drawing
the front and the side of the lubrication adapter.
[Specifications]
B1-120
506E
Options
Removing/mounting Jig
Removing/mounting Jig
LM Guide (Options)
When assembling the guide, do not remove the LM block from the LM rail whenever possible. If it is
inevitable to remove the LM block due to the plate cover type or the assembly procedure, be sure to
use the removing/mounting jig.
Mounting the LM block without using the removing/mounting jig may cause rolling elements to fall
from the LM block due to contamination by foreign material, damage to internal components or slight
inclination. Mounting the LM block with some of the rolling elements missing may also cause dam-
age to the LM block at an early stage.
When using the removing/mounting jig, do not incline the jig and match the ends of both LM rails.
If any of the rolling elements falls from the LM block, contact THK instead of using the product.
Note that the removing/mounting jig is not included in the LM Guide package as standard. When
desiring to use it, contact THK.
LM block
LM rail
Removing/mounting Jig
Removing/mounting Jig
(Material: ABS resin)
B1-121
506E
End Piece EP
For those models whose balls may fall if the LM rail is pulled out of the LM block, an end piece is at-
tached to the product to prevent the LM block from being removed from the LM rail.
For models that can use the end piece, see the table below.
If removing the end piece when using the LM Guide, be sure that the LM block will not overshoot.
The end piece can also be used as a fixing jig for a steel tape, and is available also for the LM rail of
models SSR, SR and HSR.
A B
C
T
B1-122
506E
LM Guide
[LM Guide]
Models SHS, SSR, SVR/SVS, SHW, HSR, SR, NR/NRS, HRW, JR, NSR-TBC, HSR-M1, SR-
M1 and HSR-M2.
SHS25 LC 2 QZ KKHH C0 +1200L P Z T -Ⅱ
Model No. Type of With QZ Contamination protection LM rail length Symbol for LM Symbol for No. of
LM block Lubricator accessory symbol (*1) (in mm) rail jointed use rails used on
With steel the same plane (*4)
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) tape
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol) Accuracy symbol (*3)
Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
Medium preload (C0) Super precision grade (SP)/Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-76. (*4) See A1-13.
Note) This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set. (i.e., required number of sets when 2 rails are
used in parallel is 2 at a minimum.)
Guaranteed stroke
(in mm) Accuracy symbol (*1)
(*1) See A1-86.
Note) *: Stainless steel is the standard material used for LM blocks.
This model number denotes one set consists of an LM block and LM rail.
B1-123
506E
[Cross LM Guide]
Models SCR, CSR and MX
B1-124
506E
Model No.
[Separate LM Guides]
Model HR
2 HR2555 UU M +1000L P T M
Model No. Contamination protection LM rail length Symbol for Stainless steel
accessory symbol (*1) (in mm) LM rail LM rail
jointed use
LM Guide
No. of LM blocks Stainless steel Accuracy symbol (*2)
used on the same rail LM block Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
Super precision grade (SP)/Ultra precision grade (UP)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-76.
Note) One set of model HR means a combination of two LM rails and an LM blocks used on the same plane.
Model GSR
● LM block ● LM rail
GSR25 T 2 UU +1060L H T K
Model No. Type of Contamination LM rail length Symbol Symbol for
LM block protection (in mm) for LM rail tapped-hole LM rail type
accessory symbol (*1) jointed use
No. of LM blocks used Accuracy symbol (*2)
on the same rail Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)/Precision grade (P)
(*1) See contamination protection accessory on A1-510. (*2) See A1-76.
Note) One set of model GSR: This model number indicates that a single-rail unit constitutes one set.
[R Guide]
Model HCR
HCR25A 2 UU C1 +60 / 1000R H 6 T
Model No. Contamination protection R-Guide LM rail radius Symbol for LM rail
accessory symbol (*1) center angle (in mm) jointed use
Number of LM rail joints
No. of LM blocks Radial clearance symbol (*2) Accuracy symbol (*3) used on one axis (*4)
used on the same rail Normal (No symbol)/Light preload (C1) Normal grade (No Symbol)/High accuracy grade (H)
(*1) See A1-510 (contamination protection accessories). (*2) See A1-70. (*3) See A1-76.
(*4) Number of LM rails used on one arc. For details, contact THK.
B1-125
506E
[Straight-Curved Guide]
Model HMG
When 2 rails are used
HSR15M1R 1 VV C1 +400L P -Ⅱ
Model No. Radial clearance Symbol for No. of rails used
symbol (*1) on the same plane (*4)
Labyrinth seal Accuracy symbol (*3)
symbol (*2)
No. of LM blocks used LM rail length (in mm)
on one rail
(*1) See A1-70 (*2) See A1-397 (*3) See A1-76 (*4) See A1-13.
Note1) The radial clearance, maximum LM rail length and accuracy class are equal to that of model HSR.
Note2) With this model, a single-rail unit constitutes one set (i.e., the required number of sets when 2 rails are used in parallel
is 2).
B1-126
506E
Model No.
Notes on Ordering
[Order units]
Note that the number of items that constitute one set differs depending on the type of LM guide.
Check the sample model number configurations and the accompanying notes.
LM Guide
SHS25C2SSC1+640L 1 set SHS25C2SSC1+640L-Ⅱ2 sets
B1-127
506E
[Supported options]
The supported options differ depending on the model number. Check the available options when or-
dering.
See A1-474.
B1-128
506E
LM Guide
or more people or moving equipment. Doing so may cause injury or damage.
(2) Do not disassemble the parts. This will result in loss of functionality.
(3) Tilting an LM block or LM rail may cause them to fall by their own weight.
(4) Take care not to drop or strike the LM Guide. Doing so may cause injury or damage. Giving an impact
to it could also cause damage to its function even if the product looks intact.
(5) Do not remove the LM block from the LM rail during setup.
(6) Do not insert hands or fingers into the mounting holes on the LM rail, as they could get caught
between the rail and the LM block, resulting in injury.
(7) To ensure personal safety, wear gloves and protective footwear when handling this product.
[Precautions on Use]
(1) Prevent foreign material, such as cutting chips or coolant, from entering the product. Failure to
do so may cause damage.
(2) If the product is used in an environment where cutting chips, coolant, corrosive solvents, water,
etc., may enter the product, use bellows, covers, etc., to prevent them from entering the product.
(3) Do not use this product if the external temperature exceeds 80℃. Unless the unit is specially de-
signed to be heat-resistant, exposure to such temperatures may deform or damage plastic and
rubber parts.
(4) If foreign material such as cutting chips adheres to the product, replenish the lubricant after
cleaning the product.
(5) Micro-strokes tend to obstruct oil film to form on the raceway in contact with the rolling element,
and may lead to fretting corrosion. Take consideration using grease offering excellent fretting pre-
vention. It is also recommended that a stroke movement corresponding to the length of the LM
block be made on a regular basis to make sure oil film is formed between the raceway and rolling
element.
(6) Do not use undue force when fitting parts (pin, key, etc.) to the product. This may generate per-
manent deformation on the raceway, leading to loss of functionality.
(7) If, for operational reasons, it becomes absolutely necessary to remove the LM block from the LM
rail and reattach it, a special mounting jig must be used for this purpose. (The mounting jig is not
included with standard versions of the product. To obtain one, please contact THK.)
(8) Position the mounting jig so that one end abuts the end of the LM rail. When the rail and the jig
are exactly aligned, the LM block can be loaded onto the rail.
(9) Take care to keep the LM block straight. Loading the block at an angle can introduce foreign
matter, damage internal components, or cause balls to fall out.
(10) The LM block must contain all its internal rolling elements (balls) when mounted on the LM rail.
Using a block with any balls removed may result in premature damage.
(11) Please contact THK if any balls fall out of the LM block; do not use the block if any balls are
missing.
B1-129
506E
(12) If the end plate is damaged due to an accident, etc., balls may fall out or the LM block may
become detached from the LM rail and drop. If the LM Guide will be used hanging upside
down, take preventive measures such as adding a safety mechanism to prevent falls.
(13) Insufficient rigidity or accuracy of mounting members causes the bearing load to concentrate on
one point and the bearing performance will drop significantly. Accordingly, give sufficient consid-
eration to the rigidity/accuracy of the housing and base and strength of the fixing bolts.
(14) When removing the LM block from the LM rail and then replacing the block, an LM block mount-
ing/removing jig that facilitates such installation is available. Contact THK for details.
[Lubrication]
(1) Thoroughly remove anti-rust oil and feed lubricant before using the product.
(2) Do not mix different lubricants. Mixing greases using the same type of thickening agent may still
cause adverse interaction between the two greases if they use different additives, etc.
(3) When using the product in locations exposed to constant vibrations or in special environments such
as clean rooms, vacuum and low/high temperature, use the grease appropriate for the specification/
environment.
(4) When lubricating the product having no grease nipple or oil hole, apply grease directly on the raceway
and stroke the product several times to let the grease spread inside.
(5) The consistency of grease changes according to the temperature. Take note that the slide resistance
of the LM Guide also changes as the consistency of grease changes.
(6) After lubrication, the slide resistance of the LM Guide may increase due to the agitation resistance of
grease. Be sure to perform a break-in to let the grease spread fully, before operating the machine.
(7) Excess grease may scatter immediately after lubrication, so wipe off scattered grease as necessary.
(8) The properties of grease deteriorate and its lubrication performance drops over time, so grease must
be checked and added properly according to the use frequency of the machine.
(9) Although the lubrication interval may vary according to use conditions and the service environment,
lubrication should be performed approximately every 100 km in travel distance (three to six months).
Set the final lubrication interval/amount based on the actual machine.
(10)If the mounting orientation is other than horizontal use, the lubricant may not reach the race-
way completely. For the mounting orientation and the lubrication, see B1-28 and
B24-2, respectively.
(11)When adopting oil lubrication, the lubricant may not be distributed throughout the LM block depending
on the mounting orientation of the block. Contact THK in advance for details.
[Storage]
When storing the LM Guide, enclose it in a package designated by THK and store it in a room in a
horizontal orientation while avoiding high temperature, low temperature and high humidity.
After the product has been in storage for an extended period of time, lubricant inside may have de-
teriorated, so add new lubricant before use.
[Disposal]
Dispose of the product properly as industrial waste.
B1-130
506E
Precautions on Use
Precautions on Handling the LM Guide for Special Environment
LM Guide
(1) This product has been thoroughly cleaned and degreased and then sealed in moisture-proof
packaging. If possible, open the package immediately prior to using the product.
(2) Once the packaging has been opened, store the product inside a clean, dry receptacle accom-
panied by silica gel or another drying agent. Do not use anti-rust oil or corrosion- or tarnish-
preventive paper or fluid with this product.
(3) Wear protective rubber or vinyl gloves while handling this product and make sure the surround-
ing environment is relatively clean.
Oil-Free LM Guide
[Handling]
(1) The Oil-Free LM Guide is suitable for use at high temperatures, under atmospheric pressure or
in a high-vacuum environment of 10-6 Pa, and is designed for ultra-low dust emission. It is not
intended for use in locations requiring rigidity. Because a preload would affect the strength of its
Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film, it does not support preloads.
(2) The product can be used in temperatures ranging from ‒20 to 150℃.
(3) To ensure proper function of the Dry Lubrication S-Compound Film, use this product in an envi-
ronment free from condensation, at a humidity level of 40% or less.
(4) This product is not intended for joint use.
(5) Great care must be taken in the installation of the Oil-Free LM Guide, which requires greater
precision compared to standard LM Guides.
(6) If the LM block is removed from the LM rail, balls may fall out, and the Dry Lubrication S-Com-
pound Film can be damaged when the block is remounted. If it becomes necessary to remove
the LM block from the LM rail, please contact THK.
(7) This product should be stored in a horizontal position, in its original wrapping and package, in
a controlled, stable environment free from abnormal high or low temperatures or high humidity.
THK recommends storing it at room temperature (255℃), with a humidity level of 40% RH or
lower and an air-purity level of 10,000 or lower.
(8) This product has been thoroughly cleaned and degreased and then sealed in moisture-proof
packaging. If possible, open the package immediately prior to using the product.
(9) Once the packaging has been opened, store the product inside a clean, dry receptacle accom-
panied by silica gel or another drying agent. Do not use anti-rust oil or corrosion- or tarnish-
preventive paper or fluid with this product.
(10)Wear protective rubber or vinyl gloves while handling this product and make sure the surround-
ing environment is relatively clean.
B1-131
506E
[Handling]
Take care not to drop or strike this product. This could cause injury or product damage.
Do not block the vent hole with grease or the like.
The QZ device supplies oil only to the raceway, so use it in combination with regular greasing/lubri-
cation. If the product is used in an environment exposed to coolant, cutting chips or other foreign
material, oil on the raceway is lost easily. Accordingly, be sure to also use covers, bellows, etc.
[Service environment]
Be sure the service temperature of this product is between ‒10 to 50℃, and do not clean the prod-
uct by immersing it in an organic solvent or white kerosene, or leave it unpacked.
[Service environment]
Be sure the service temperature of this product is between -20 to +80℃, and do not clean the prod-
uct by immersing it in an organic solvent or white kerosene, or leave it unpacked.
B1-132
506E
Precautions on Use
Precautions on Using Options for the LM Guide
LM Guide
[Service environment]
Be sure the service temperature of this product is between -20 to +80℃, and do not clean the prod-
uct by immersing it in an organic solvent or white kerosene, or leave it unpacked.
It contacts only with the LM rail raceway. Do not use it in harsh environments.
Cap GC
For details regarding the GC cap, see B1-112.
[Handling]
If GC caps are specified for the product, the edges of the LM rail mounting hole openings will be
sharp. Take great care not to injure your fingers or hands while working.
When fitting GC caps, use a flat aligning tool to gradually punch the cap into the hole until it is level
with the upper surface of the LM rail. Then run an oil stone over the rail until the upper surface of the
rail and the GC caps are completely flat.
B1-133
506E
B1-134